270 13 39MB
English Pages 901 [904] Year 1983
Peptides 1982
Peptides 1982 Proceedings of the 17th European Peptide Symposium Prague, Czechoslovakia August 29 - September 3,1982 Editors Karel Blaha • Petr Malon
W DE G Walter de Gruyter • Berlin • New York 1983
Editors Karel Bteha, Dr. Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry CS-166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Petr Malofi, Dr. Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry CS-166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia
CIP-Kurztitelaufnahme der Deutschen
Bibliothek
Peptides nineteen hundred and eighty-two Peptides 1982: proceedings of the 17th Europ. Peptide Symposium, Prague, Czechoslovakia, August 29 - September 3,1982 / ed. Karel Bläha; Petr Malofi. Berlin; New York: de Gruyter, 1983 ISBN 3-11-009574-2 NE: Bläha, Karel [Hrsg. ]; European Peptide Symposium
Library of Congress Cataloging in Publication Data
European Peptide Symposium (17th : 1982 : Prague, Czechoslovakia) Peptides 1982 Bibliography: p. Includes indexes. 1. Peptides-Congresses. 2. Peptide synthesis-Congresses. I. Bläha, Karel. II. Malofi, Petr, 1947 . III.Title. [DNLM: 1. Peptides. W3 PE528] QP552.P4E9 1982 574.19'2456 83-5268 ISBN 3-11-009574-2
Copyright © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin 30. All rights reserved, including those of translation into foreign languages. No part of this book may be reproduced in any form - by photoprint, microfilm or any other means nor transmitted nor translated into a machine language without written permission from the publisher. Printing: Gerike, Berlin. - Binding: Dieter Mikolai, Berlin. - Printed in Germany.
Preface
Nearly a quarter of a century has elapsed since the time when in Prague met a small group of chemists who decided to concentrate their scientific effort on a newly developing branch of chemistry - on the peptide synthesis. This meeting - in the original assumption rather of a private character - had an extraordinary successful course and became the base of present series of European Peptide Symposia. Professor Joseph Rudinger - spiritus agens of the first meeting - found many followers and the following meetings developed quickly in prestigious series of symposia of very high scientific reputation. The European Peptide Symposia are probably the oldest among specialized scientific meetings in chemistry and without doubt, the pioneering in peptide chemistry. We are proud of the fact that they also became a model for similar actions of our North American and Far East colleagues. The number of participants and the extent of the scientific programme of the first Prague Symposium reflected the situation in peptide chemistry of that time. These parameters of today's symposia are much greater and are not comparable with those of 1958. However, in one respect there is no change the European Peptide Symposia rely just on the initiative of peptide laboratories in the European region and are in a way their representative forum. The last, already the 17th European Peptide Symposium which was held again in Prague from 29th August to 3rd September 1982, retained these characteristics, and we trust that it had at least a part of the atmosphere and spirit which ruled during the first symposium 1958. The Proceedings volume you have in your hands contains all contributions really presented at the 17th EPS and the manuscripts of which reached the editors before the end of October, 1982. The arrangement of contributions in the volume is
VI
based on the four days scientific programme accepted by the Programme Committee. However, oral contributions and posters are not separate. The two main topics - synthesis of peptides and structure-activity relationships - have been privileged in ordering of contributions. Therefore, the contributions dealing with conformational aspects are only partly collected in the last section. We tried to unify as much as possible the presentation form and the lay-out of all manuscripts, unfortunately, with only limited success. We have to apologize for some inconsistencies due to our weakness. Cooperation with the publisher of these Proceedings, Walter de Gruyter, was excellent, and we would like to extend our thanks namely to Mrs. Evelyne Glowka for her enduring interest. The Organizing Committee found great understanding at all leading institutions and personalities representing the scientific life in Czechoslovakia. We appreciate very much that the 17th EPS was again sponsored by the Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences We acknowledge also with pleasure the permanent help of all members of the European Peptide Committee and, especially, of the Programme Committee. The symposium would not have been possible without great effort from all the members of the Organizing Committee and many other coworkers from the Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences not listed under the heading. They performed efficiently and beyond the call of duty. Many thanks.
Karel Blaha and Petr Malon
January 1983
Contents
European Peptide Committee and Programme Committee .... XXVII Honorary Committee and Organizing Committee
XXVIII
Previous European Peptide Symposia
XXIX
List of Participants
XXXI
In Memoriam, Emil Taschner
XLIII
In Memoriam, Dieter Marquarding
XLVII
In Memoriam, Erhard Gross
XLIX
Plenary Lectures Recent Developments in the Chemistry and Biology of Cyclic Peptides Y. Ovchinnikov, G. Chipens, V. Ivanov
1
Conformational Considerations in the Design of Highly Potent and Long-Acting Peptide Hormone Agonists and Antagonists V.J. Hruby, H.J. Knittel, H.I. Mosberg, T.W. Rockway, B.C. Wilkes, M.E. Hadley
19
Semisynthesis of Proteins and Peptides R.E. Offord
31
Further Application of the Aqueous-Organic Two-Phase Approach to Enzyme-Catalyzed Peptide-Synthesis H.-D. Jakubke, P. Kuhl, A. Könnecke, G. Döring, J. Walpuski, A. Wilsdorf, N.P. Zapevalova
43
VIII Interactions of Lipid Bilayers with Corticotropin, Dynorphin, and Enkephalin Peptides R. Schwyzer, H.U. Gremiich, B. Gysin, U.-P. Fringeli
55
Gramicidin A: From Structure Towards the Molecular Mechanism of Action V. Ivanov
73
Structural Comparisons of Retroenantiomeric Cyclic Hexapeptides D. van der Helm, M.B. Hossain
91
Circular Dichroism and Conformation of Peptides Related to Oxytocin I. Fric, P. Malon, K. Jost, K. Bläha
103
Synthesis of Peptides Methods of Protection Adaptation of Side Reactions for Peptide Synthesis M. Bodanszky, M.A. Bednarek, Ai-xue Ji, A. Bodanszky
117
A New Type of Reagents for the Liberation of free Amino Components J. Izdebski, S. Drabarek
121
The Application of Recently Developed Amino Protecting Groups in Peptide Synthesis W. Voelter, J. Müller, C. Beni, W. Heinzel, H. Kalbacher, A. Morel, H. Wollman
125
Preparation of 4-Sulfobenzyl Esters and their Use in Peptide Synthesis R. Bindewald, E.E. Büllesbach, H. Zahn, M. Bodanszky, W. Danho
129
The 2-Chloroethy1 Group for Carboxyl Protection in Peptide Synthesis M.J.S.A. Amaral Trigo, M.I.M.R.E. Barbedo
133
IX
Some Properties of Amino Acid and Peptide Phenacyl Esters 0. Popova, R. Jung. Y. Mitin
137
Temporary Substitution of Asparagine by Aspartic Acid in the Synthesis of Peptide Segments of Vasoactive Intestinal Peptide (VIP) W.M.M. Schaaper, D. Voskamp
141
Methods of Coupling Recycling of Excess Peptides from Fragment Condensations with Carbonyldiimidazole/1-Hydroxybenzotriazole Activation C. Birr, I. Krück, R. Pipkorn, C. Voss
145
Fatty Acids as Additives Suppressing Racemization of Amino Acid Residues in Peptide Synthesis by the DCC Method J. Przybylski, H. Miecznikowska, G. Kupryszewski, H. Jeschkeit, M. Strube
149
HPLC as a Tool for the Investigation of Peptide Bond Formation M. Slebioda, A. Kolodziejczyk, T. Sokolowska
153
Application of Phosphinic Acids to Peptide Synthesis R. Ramage, C. Ashton, B. Atrash, D. Hopton, M.J. Parrott . 157 A Reinvestigation of the Mixed Anhydride Method V.K. Naithani, A. K. Naithani
163
Do Acylamino Acid and Peptide Anhydrides Exist? N.L. Benoiton, F.M.F. Chen
167
First Results with New Reagents for Peptide Coupling P. Henklein, K. Forner, H. Niedrich, P.Y. Romanovski
171
X Peptide Syntheses without Isolation of Intermediates Using Biphasic Solvent System R. Dolling, K.-D. Kaufmann
175
Some Applications of the Curtius Rearrangement P. Moutevelis-Minakakis, I. Photaki
179
Heterodetic Bonds A New Method for the Selective Synthesis of Unsymmetrical Cystine Peptides E. Wiinsch, S. Romani, L. Moroder
183
A Controlled Synthesis of Cyclic Unsymmetrical Cystine Peptides Bearing Two S-S Bridges in the Ring I. Photaki, M. Kolovos, A. Stathaki-Ferderigos, + L. Zervas
189
Synthesis of Cysteine and Cystine Containing Peptides through 3-0- jjSI-Benzyloxycarbony 1-S-AcetamidomethylCysteinyl] -Hydroxy-2-Phenylindenone S. Minchev, N. Sofroniev
195
Method of Cyclization of Carba Analogues of Oxytocin M. Krojidlo, M. Flegel, M. Lebl
199
Synthesis of Isopeptides of Lysine as Fundamental Structural Units of Clavicepamines G. Szokan, M. Gyenes, E. Tyihak, B. Szende
203
Synthesis of Leucine Enkephalin- and Aspartame Analogs Containing Thioamide Linkages at Specific Positions K. Clausen, B. Yde, S.-O. Lawesson
207
XI
Synthesis on Polymeric Supports Synthetic Studies on the Cecropins R.B. Merrif ie Id, L.D. Vizioli, H.G. Boman
211
Improved Syntheses of Substance P and Analogues on a Phenolic Resin Support E. Escher, J.-M. Lalonde, S. Caranikas
215
Peptide Ionophores. Synthesis and Characterization of Cyclic Octa- and Decapeptides Containing Leucine and Proline J. Halstern, S. Mozer, K. Brunfeldt
219
Histone Model Peptide Synthetized by Solid Phase Fragment Condensation V. Gut, H. Votavovä, K. Bläha, J. Sponar
223
The Biomimetic Gel Phase Synthesis of the RNA-Polymerase II Inhibitor Peptide 6'-Deshydroxy-Amanul1 in C. Birr, B. Schmitt
227
Methodological Studies on Gel Phase Synthesis of the Arginine-Rich Propeptide Extension of Proalbumin R. Pipkorn, C. Birr, M. Schmid, K. Weigand
233
Use of the Nbb-Resin and 4-HydroxymethylphenoxymethylResin in Solid Phase Peptide Synthesis E. Pedroso, A. Grandas, R. Eritja, E. Giralt
237
Comparative Syntheses of an Octapeptide Using Continuous Flow (Column) and Conventional Polyamide Solid Phase Methods E. Atherton, L.E. Cammish, R.C. Sheppard
241
The Solid Phase Synthesis of Neurotensin and Related Peptides on Polydimethylacrylamide Resins B.J. Williams
247
XII
Liquid-Phase Synthesis of Biologically Active Peptides on Easily Detachable Poly(Ethylene Glycol) Supports R. Colombo
2 5 1
Synthesis of Individual Peptides Synthesis of Tuftsin under HPLC Control 0.A. Kaurov, A.N. Prusakov, A.M. Pivovarov, V.A. Pasechnik
257
Synthesis of Tuftsin Analogs with Elongated Peptide Chain and a Possible Anticancer Activity D. Konopinska, V.A. Najjar, M. Luczak
261
Synthesis of an IgG Fragment Decapeptide and Preliminary Evaluation of its Role on Phagocytosis Stimulation of Human Polymorphonuclear Leukocytes J. Martinez, J. Laur, F. Winternitz
265
Synthesis and Pharmacologic Characterization of Glucagon (1-21)-Peptide H. Petersen, B.F. Lundt, N.L. Johansen, F.C. Gr^nvald .... 269 The Synthesis of Peptides Related to Prothrombin A. Hallett, A.P. Hope, M.S. Munns, R. Richardson, G.T. Young
273
Total Synthesis of Neurotoxin II from the Central Asian Cobra (Naja naja oxiana) venom V. Deigin, V. Ulyashin, I. Mikhaleva, V. Ivanov
277
Synthesis of Labelled Peptides Catalytic Exchange Labelling of Peptides D.E. Brundish, M.G. Combe, R. Wade
285
XIII
Solid Phase Synthesis of Neurotensin Analogues Susceptible to Radiolabelling C. Labbe, D. Blanot, E. Bricas, J.L. Morgat, P. Kitabgi, J.P. Vincent, C. Granier, J. Van Rietschoten
289
Tritium Incorporation into Histidine by Direct Catalytic Exchange: Labelling of Gonadotropin Releasing Hormone and Analogs E. Klauschenz, M. Bienert, H. Berger, B. Mehlis, H. Niedrich, U. Pleiss
293
3
The H-Labelling of Peptides by Reduction of Dehydroleucine P.M. Hardy, P.W. Sheppard, D.E. Brundish, R. Wade Analogues of [8-ArginineJ Receptor Research
297
Vasopressin for Hormone
F. Fahrenholz, P. Crause, J.-L. Morgat
301
Synthesis of Peptides Containing Non-Coded Amino Acids Synthetic Fragments of Bacterial Cell Walls. Physicochemical and Biological Properties M. Budesinsky, J. Jezek, V. Krchnak, M. Lebl, M. Zaoral, J. Rotta, R. Straka
305
Synthesis of Analogues of Precursors of Bacterial Peptidoglycan D. Blanot, A. Kretsovali, M. Abo-Galia, D. MenginLecreulx, J. van Heijenoort
311
Synthesis of Peptides with ot, B-Dehydroaminoacid Residue B. Rzeszotarska, M. Makowski, Z. Kubica
.315
Synthesis of Dehydro Amino Acids and Peptides R.H. Mazur, D.R. Pilipauskas
319
a-Hydroxymethylation of Peptides: A Synthetic Route to Peptides Containing a-Hydroxymethy1-Amino Acids Z.J. Kaminski, M.T. Leplawy, U. Siomczynska
323
XIV
L- a-Aminoadipic Acid S-N-Benzyloxycarbonylamide and its Use in Peptide Synthesis B. Liberek, R. Kasprzykowska
(Jablonska)
327
Synthesis of ß-Homo-L-Proline Analogues of Peptide Hormones K. Bankowski, A. Misicka
331
Optically Active Neopentylglycine and its Applications in Peptide Chemistry J. PospiSek, K. Bläha
333
Monodisperse Conjugates of Catecholamines K.A. Jacobson, R.P. Rosenkranz, M.S. Verlander, K.L. Melmon, M. Goodman
337
Total Synthesis of Althiomycin T. Shiba, K. Inami
341
Peptide Tricyclic Thia-Cyclols from Linear Precursors G. Zanotti, F. Pinnen, G. Lucente, S. Cerrini, W. Fedeli, F. Mazza
345
Semi-Synthesis Synthesis of Cytochrome C-(66-104) Nonatriacontapeptide and Analogues P.B.W. Ten Kortenaar, G.I. Tesser, R.J.F. Nivard
349
Cytochrome C Semisynthesis Using Enzymic Resynthesis Techniques A.E.I. Proudfoot, C.J.A. Wallace
353
Semisynthetic Analogs of Globomycin J.D. Glass, B. Hayes, M. Inouye
357
Semisynthetic Studies on the Bovine Trypsin-Kallikrein Inhibitor L. Biondi, B. Filippi, F. Filira, V. Giormani, R. Rocchi . 361
XV Synthesis of a Hybrid Chicken/Human Insulin H.-J. Wieneke, G. Wolf, W. Wolff, E.E. Büllesbach, H.-G. Gattner, D. Brandenburg
3 67
Semisyntheses of Insulin Analogues by Replacement of the Sequence Al-4 D. Saunders, K. Freude, V.K. Naithani, D. Brandenburg, S. Stoev
371
Synthesis of Peptides Using Enzymes Enzymatic Peptide Synthesis F. Widmer, M. Ohno, M. Smith, N. Nelson, C.B. Anfinsen ... 375 Amidation of Synthetic Peptides by Pituitary Enzyme: Specificity and Mechanism of the Reaction A. F. Bradbury, D.G. Smyth
381
Reaction Mechanism in Trypsin Catalyzed Synthesis of Human Insulin Studied by -^O-NMR Spectroscopy J. Markussen, K. Schaumburg
387
Trypsin-Catalyzed Oligomerization of the Ala-Ala-Arg Tripeptide V. Cerovsky, K. Jost
395
Thermitase-Catalyzed Hydrolysis of the C-Terminal Ester Group of Protected Peptide Ester Derivatives P. Hermann, L. Salewski
399
Reversibility of Tryptic Hydrolysis in a Model Nonapeptide Sequence V.S. Ganu, J.D. Glass
403
Synthesis and Characterization of a- and/or ^-Substituted Lysine Peptides P. Stehle, B. Kühne, A. Plessing, P. Fürst, P. Pfaender .. 407
XVI
Purification, Characterization and Analytics Isolation by Preparative HPLC and Characterization of Major Components after Cyclization of a Decapeptide P. Larsen, 0. Schou, T. Christensen
411
Separation of Basic, Hydrophilic Peptides by ReversedPhase Ion-Pair Chromatography. III. A Progress Report B. Fransson, U. Ragnarsson
415
Pre-Column Derivatization in HPLC of Peptides G. Szokän, G. Pinter
419
Fast Atom Bombardment Mass Spectrometry - a New Tool for Peptide Sequence Analysis W.A. König, M. Aydin, U. Schulze, M. Rinken
423
Progress Towards a Post-Synthetic Chiral Analysis of Peptides J.S. Davies, A.K. Mohammed, E. Hakeem
431
Direct Peptide Sequencing after TLC on Silica Gel without Substance Elution R. Kraft, A. Otto, G. Etzold
437
Structure-Activity Relations Neurohypophyseal Hormones Two Analogues of Oxytocin with Modified Proline Cyclic Structure Z. Prochâzka, M. Lebl, T. Barth, J. Hlavâcek, K. Jost .... 441 Synthesis of new Active and Highly Selective Analogues of Oxytocin and Arginine-Vasopressin Z. Grzonka, F. Kasprzykowski, B. Lammek, D. Gazis, I.L. Schwartz
445
XVII
CNS - Active Vasopressin Analogues F. Brtnik, T. Barth, J. Skopkova, K. Jost, I. Krejci, B. Kupkova
449
Investigation of Position 2 and 3 of Vasopressins I. Blaha, V. Krchnak, M. Zaoral, D. Konopinska
453
Analogues of Neurohypophysial Hormones Containing a D-Amino Acid in Position 2 M. Lebl, T. Barth, L. Servitovä, J. Slaninovä, K. Jost ... 457 Penicillamine-Containing Analogues of Neurohypophysial Hormones P. Simek, T. Barth, F. Brtnik, J. Slaninova, K. Jost
461
9-Substituted Vasopressin Analogs with Substantial Antidiuretic Activity D. Gazis, A. Buku, I.L. Schwartz
465
Interactions of Deamino-6-Carba-0xytocin Analogues in Rat Kidney and Liver Membrane Systems T. Barth, M. Lebl, K. Jo^t, B. Cantau, D. Butlan, G. Guillon, S. Jard
467
Opioid Peptides Synthesis and Biological Activity of New Enkephalin Analogues R. Paruszewski, R. Matusiak, E. Gmitrzuk, W. Gumuika, P. Janicki
471
Biochemical and Pharmacological Investigations of Peripheral and Brain 6-0piate Receptors Using Tyr-D-Thr-GlyPhe-Leu-Thr, a New Fully Specific 6-Ligand B.P. Roques, G. Gacel, P. Dodey, J.-M. Zajac, M.C. Fournie-Zaluski
475
Double Opiate Peptides. A Hypothesis of Two Different Mechanisms of Opiate Actions A.W. Lipkowski, M. Konopka, B. Osipiak, W.S. Gumuika
481
XVIII
Synthesis and Activity of Kyotorphin and its Analogs L. Balaspiri, K. Kovacs, A. Geese, G. Telegdy, K. Neubert
487
Opioid Activity of Synthetic "Small Demorphins" R. Tomatis, S. Salvadori, G. Sarto
495
Structure-Activity Relationship of Dermorphin K. Darlak, Z. Grzonka, P. Janicki, A. Czionkowski, S.W. Gumuika
501
Structural Modifications of B-Casomorphin-5: Synthesis and Pharmacology B. Hartrodt, K. Neubert, H. Matthies, H.-L. Riithrich, H. Stark, A. Barth
505
Substance P Substance P: The "Yin-Yang" of Behavior? J.M. Stewart, M.E. Hall
511
Hydrophilic Analogs of Substance P: Introduction of Sugar Acids and Sulfonium Groups M. Bienert, K. Forner, B. Mehlis, H. Niedrich, J. Bergmann, R. Kraft
517
Influence of the Methionine Sidechain on the Biological Activity of Substance P D. Theodoropoulos, C. Poulos, D. Gatos, P. Cordopatis, R. Couture, J. Mizrahi, D. Regoli, E. Escher
521
Substance P Analogues Containing Para-Substituted Phenylalanine: Synthesis and Pharmacological Properties E. Munekata, I. Kanazawa
527
Synthesis of Potent and Specific Antagonists of Substance P E. Escher, J. Mizrahi, S. Caranikas, P. D'OrleansJuste, D. Regoli
531
XIX
Substance P: Inactivation in CNS, Enzymatically Resistant Analogue and Development of "Brain Selective" Agonist B.E.B. Sandberg, M.R. Hanley, L.L. Iversen, J.E. Maggio, R.R.D. Pinnock, S.P. Watson
535
Other Biologically Active Peptides Some Pharmaceutical Aspects of Peptide Research L. Kisf aludy
543
The Synthesis and Gonadotropic Activity of [D-Tle 6 , Pro-NH-Et9]LRF M. Flegel, J. Posplsek, J. Picha, D. Pichovä
551
The Role of N-Acyl Groups in the Inhibitory Activity of LH-RH Analogues I. Mezö, J. Seprödi, J. Erchegyi, I. Teplän, M. Koväcs, B. Flerko
555
Gonadotropin Releasing Hormone and its Analogs Desensitize Pituitary GnRH Action G. Keri, K. Nikolics, I. Teplän DSIP: Novel Developments in Structure-Functional
559 Studies
I. Mikhaleva, A. Sargsyan, V. Ivanov
563
The Active Centres of Gastrin and Cholecystokynin: Syntheses, Conformational Problems, Correlation between Chemical Structure and Biological Activity B. Penke, M. Zarandi, G.K. Toth, K. Koväcs, M. Fekete, G. Telegdy, P. Pham
569
What is the Minimum Active Centre of Gastrin? M. Zarändi, B. Penke, J. Varga, K. Koväcs, G. Holczinger, T. Kadär
577
Structure-Activity Relationships of Highly Potent and Specific Gctapeptide Analogues of Somatostatin W. Bauer, U. Briner, W. Doepfner, R. Haller, R. Huguenin, P. Marbach, T.J. Petcher, J. Pless
583
XX Photoreactive Labelling
[Leu^l-a-MSH Derivatives for Receptor
A.N. Eberle, J. Girard, P.N.E. de Graan, F. F.C.G. van de Veerdonk
589
Degradation of a-Melanotropin by the Enzymes of the Soluble Fraction of Rat Brain Homogenate H. Medzihradszky-Schweiger, J. Szécsi, K. Medzihradszky .. 593 Solid Phase Synthesis of Amunine and Two Urotensin I
(CRF), Sauvagine
J. Rivier, J. Spiess, C. Rivier, R. Galyean, W. Vale, K. Lederis
597
Proctolin: Synthesis, Enzymatic Degradation and Effect on the Cyclic Nucleotide System H. Arold, C. Liebmann, S. Reissmann, J. Scheidt
603
Phosphonopeptides, Novel Inhibitors of Bacterial Cell Wall Biosynthesis C.H. Hassall, F.R. Atherton, M.J. Hall, R.W. Lambert, W.J. Lloyd, P.S. Ringrose
607
Urinary Excretion of Biologically Active Peptides and/or Peptide-Like Material in Various Disorders J.H. Johansen, J.B. BszSler, K.L. Reichelt, P.D. Edminson, N.K. Pape
613
Inhibitors and Binding Studies Synthesis and Properties of Peptide Ketones S. Fittkau, G. Jahreis
617
Enkephalin Diazomethyl and Chloromethyl Ketones: Synthesis and Biological Activity K. Medzihradszky, J. Szecsi, G. Csanady, J. Hepp
623
Use of Quantitative Lipophilicity Relationships for the Design of Renin Inhibitors J. Burton
629
XXI
Specific Inhibitors of Renin M. Szelke, A. Hallett, D.M. Jones, J. Sueiras, B. Atrash, B. Leckie, M. Tree, A.F. Lever
635
Anionic Inhibitors of Elastase E. Kasaflrek, P. Fric, J. Slaby
639
Inhibition of Thrombin with H- and Boc-D-Phe-Pro-Agm S. Bajusz, E. Barabäs, D. Bagdy
643
Analogues of Chymostatin I.J. Galpin, A. H. Wilby, R.J. Beynon
649
Binding Studies of Glucagon Antagonists V.J. Hruby, J.T. Pelton, R. McKee, D. Trivedi
653
Determination of the Toxic and Antigenic Sites of Peptide Snake Venom Short Neurotoxins A. Menez, J.-C. Boulain, P. Fromageot
657
Design and Synthesis of Two Peptides as Models for the Antigenic Sites of the Toxin II of the Scorpion Androctonus australis Hector C. Granier, E. Bahraoui, J. Van Rietschoten, H. Rochat, M. El Ayeb
663
Immunology Related Peptides Chemical Approaches to Improve Immunoassays of Peptide Hormones L. Moroder, M. Gemeiner, H. Kaibacher, R. Nyfeler, E. Wünsch
667
Antineoplastic and Immunogenic Effects of Tuftsin (Thr-Lys-Pro-Arg) and its Analogs V.A. Najjar, D. Konopinska, M.K. Chaudhuri, L. Linehan ... 673
XXII
Synthesis and Biological Assays of Peptides from a Tuberculin-Active Protein J. Savrda
679
Synthesis and Immunoreactivity of Escherichia Coli Heat Stable Enterotoxins Analogs A. Duflot, H. Gras-Masse, A. Tartar, E. Duflot, P. Boquet
683
Preparation and Antigenicity of the C-Terminal Fragments of Human Leukocyte Interferons a2 and c*i M. Ohno, F. Widmer, M.E. Smith, H. Arnheiter, K.C. Zoon .. 687 Immunological Properties of Hapten-Peptide Conjugates: The Effect of Size, Lipophilic Substituents and Haptenic Distance on Tolerogenicity and Anaphylactogenicity I. F. Luescher, C.H. Schneider
693
Conformational Studies Conformation: Model Peptides Conformational Features of Alternating L, D Peptides A. Bavoso, E. Benedetti, B. Di Biasio, V. Pavone, C. Pedone, V. Barone, G. Esposito, F. Lelj, G.P. Lorenzi . 699 Conformation of Cyclic Hexapeptides Studied by the Modified Factor Analysis of Circular Dichroism Spectra P. Panco^ka, K. Blaha, J. Vicar
705
Conformational Energy Calculations of Heterodetic Cyclic Hexapeptides Related to Oxytocin Ring Moiety P. Malon, G.V. Nikiforovich, K. Blaha
709
Conformational Energy Analysis of Oxytocin Molecule V. Krchnak
713
XXI 11
Conformational Analysis of Peptides Substrate of N-Glycosylation E. Giralt, M. Pons, J.M. Ricart, J.J. Perez, C. Granier, J. Van Rietschoten
717
Serine and ß-Folding M. Marraud, A. Aubry
721
X-Ray Structure and Conformation in Solution of Peptides Containing a-Aminoisobutyric Acid Residues G. Jung, R. Bosch, H. Brückner, E. Katz, H. Schaal, H. Schmitt, J. Strähle, K.-P. Voges, W. Winter
725
Preferred Conformations of Host-Guest Peptides M. Mutter, F. Maser, B. Klein, C. Toniolo, G.M. Bonora ... 729
Conformation: Biologically Active Peptides Conformation Calculations and Biologically Active Conformations of Cyclopeptides G. Nikiforovich, S. Rozenblit, I. Liepina, G. Chipens .... 735 Peptaibol Antibiotics: A Study on the Helical Structure of Emerimicins C. Toniolo, G.M. Bonora, E. Benedetti, A. Bavoso, B. di Biasio, V. Pavone, C. Pedone
741
Conformational and Ionophoric Properties of Prolyl Containing Analogs of Valinomycin T. Balashova, L. Fonina, G. Avotina, V. Xvanov
745
Synthesis of the Postulated Calcium Binding Site I of Calmodulin and Binding Studies F. Marchiori, G. Borin, G. Chessa, E. Peggion
751
X-Ray Structural Study of Ionophores of a Valinomycin Group V. Popovich, V. Pletnev
755
XXIV
Conformational Studies on Gaba-Enkephalinamides C. Di Bello, S. Andini, L. Ferrara, R. Napolitano, L. Paolillo
759
Conformational Studies of the "in vitro" Potent Opiate [D-Met2f Trp4, Pro5J Enkephalinamide by Fluorescence and Theoretical Calculations J.-M. Garcia Anton, F. Reig, G. Valencia, J.J. Garcia Dominquez, R. Guillard, J.-P. Demonte, A. Englert
763
Configuration of the Azo Bridge in Azo-Enkephalin I.Z. Siemion, A. Jankowski, M. Lisowski, Z. Szewczuk
767
Self-Association of Substance P and its C-Terminal Sequences K. Gast, J. Behlke, M. Rüger, M. Bienert, B. Mehlis
771
Spatial Structure of Bradykinin Potentiating Peptide BPPg a S. Reißmann, H. Arold, M.P. Filatova, N.A. Krit, I. Fric 775 Guest-Host Relationship in Bradykinin Peptides V. Dive, K. Lintner, S. Fermandjian, S.S. Pierre, D. Regoli
781
Importance of Residue 5 in Antiotensin IX C. Sakarellos, F. Piriou, M. Juy, F. Torna, H. Lam-Thanh, K. Lintner, S. Fermandjian, M.C. Khosla, R.R. Smeby, F.M. Bumpus
785
Circular Dichroism Aids Interpretation of StructureActivity Relationship of Somatostatin Analogs D.F. Veber, W.C. Randall, R.F. Nutt, R.M. Freidinger, S.F. Brady, D.S. Perlow, P. Curley, W.J. Paleveda, R.G. Strachan, F.W. Holly, R. Saperstein
789
The Conformational Equilibrium of the Peptide Hormone Somatostatin and some Analogues in Aqueous Solution K. Hallenga, F. Vlaeminck, G. Van Binst, M. Knappenberg, A. Michel, J. Zanen
793
XXV
Application of Homonuclear and Heteronuclear Two-Dimensional NMR Spectroscopy to Cyclolinopeptide A (1) H. Kess1er, R. Schuck
797
Role of the N-Terminal Fragment on the Stability of the Porcine Pancreatic Secretory Tryps in Inhibitors (KAZAL) A. Scatturin, V. Periotto, M. Guarneri, E. Menegatti, A. De Marco
801
Relationship between the Steric Structure of Insulin Derivatives and their Biological Activity G. Vlasov, N. Izvarina, N. Illarionova
805
Studies of Hydrogen Bonding in Relation to Oxytocin Activity D. Gazis, J. Roy, U. Roy, J.D. Glass, I.L. Schwartz
809
Synthesis, Conformation and Interaction with a Decanucleotide of the Fragment (26-39) of the "Cro" Protein from Bacteriophage X R. Mayer, G. Lancelot, C. Hélène
815
Abbreviations
819
Subject Index
829
Authors' Index
841
XXVII
EUROPEAN PEPTIDE COMMITTEE Aus tria: Belgium: Bulgary: Czechoslovakia: Denmark: Great Britain: France: PRG: GDR: Greece: Hungary: Israel: Italy: The Netherlands: Poland: Spain: Sweden: Switzerland: USSR:
H. Nesvadba A. Loffet B. V. Aleksiev K. Blàha It. Brurtfeldt R. C. Sheppard E. Bricas H. Hagenmaier H. Niedrich I. Photaki K. Medzihradszky A. Pa tchornik R. Rocchi H. C. Beyerman G. Kupry s z ewski E. Giralt U. Ragnarsson J.-L. Fauchere Y. Ovchinnikov
PROGRAMME COMMITTEE It. Blàha D. Brandenburg V.T. Ivanov K. Medzihradszky G.T. Young
H O N O R A R Y COMMITTEE B. Kvasil, J, Öermäk, Z. V. J. J.
Öeska, Holat, Chromik, Gabel
E. Hala V, Kubanek, L. KubiSek, J. Mostecky, K,
Sebesta,
F.
ätafa,
President of the Czechoslovak (chairman) Academy of Sciences Director, Institute of Chemical Process Fundamentals Rector of the Charles University 1st Deputy Minister, Czech Ministry of Health Director General, SPOFA 1st Deputy Minister, Federal Ministry for Technical Development and Investment Academician Head of the Science Department of the Central Committee Scientific Secretary of the Academy Rector of the Prague Institute of Chemical Technology Director, Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry Lord Mayor of Prague
ORGANIZING COMMITTEE K. T. I. F. M. I. V. J.
Blaha (chairman) Barth Blaha Brtnik Flegel Friö Gut Hlavaöek
K. M. P. J. Z. P. J. M.
Joät Lebl^ Ma Ion PospiSek Prochazka Simek Skopkova Zaoral
XXIX Previous E u r o p e a n 1.
Czechoslovakia,
1958;
Peptide
Symposia
Prague.
C o l l e c t . Czech. Chem. Conunun. 24, S p e c i a l I s s u e
(1959)
1-160. 2.
FRG, 1959;
Munich.
A n g e w . Chem. 71 3.
Switzerland,
(1959)
I960;
741-743.
Basel.
Chimia l4 (i960) 366-38O; 393-418. 4.
USSR, 1961;
Moscow.
C o l l e c t . Czech. Chem. C o m m u n . 27 also in Z h u r n a l M e n d e l e y e v s k o v o 5.
Great B r i t a i n , 1962;
6.
Greece, 1963;
7.
H u n g a r y , 1964;
Peptides Peptides Acta
(L. Zervas,
Peptides 9.
France,
(1962).
Oxford
(1963).
e d . ) P e r g a m o n Press, O x f o r d
(1966),
e d . ) P e r g a m o n Press,
Budapest.
Academiae Scientarium Hungaricae
The Netherlands,
1966;
eds) 44
Peptides 1968
1-239.
A. v a n de Linde, W . M a a s s e n
eds) N o r t h - H o l l a n d ,
1968;
(1965)
(V. B r u c k -
Noordwijk.
(H.C. B e y e r m a n ,
der Brink,
7
Athens.
n e r and K . M e d z i h r a d s z k y , 8.
2229-2262,
Oxford.
(G.T. Young,
Chimica
(1962)
Obshchestva
Amsterdam
van
(1967).
Orsay. (E. Bricas,
ed.) N o r t h - H o l l a n d ,
Amsterdam
(1968). 10.
Italy,
1969; A b a n o T e r m e .
Peptides 1969
(E. Scoffone,
ed.) N o r t h - H o l l a n d ,
Amsterdam
(1971).
11.
Austria,
1971;
Peptides 1971
Vienna. (H. Nesva.dba , ed,) N o r t h - H o l l a n d ,
Amsterdam
(1973). 12.
GDR, 1972; R e i n h a r d s b r u n n Peptides 1 9 7 2
Castle.
(H. H a n s o n a n d H.D. Jakubke,
Holland, A m s t e r d a m
(1973).
eds) N o r t h -
XXX 13.
Israel, 1972*; Kiryat Anavim. Peptides 197^ (Y. tfolman, ed.) Keter Press, Jerusalem (1975).
14.
Belgium, 1976; Wépion. Peptides 1976 (A. Loffet, ed.) Editions de 1 Université de Bruxelles.
15.
Poland, 1978; Gdansk. Peptides 1978 (i.Z. Siemion and G. Kupryszewski, eds) Wroclaw University Press (1979).
16.
Denmark, 1980; Helsing^r. Peptides 1980 (K, Bruni*eldt, ed.) Scriptor, (1981).
Copenhagen
XXXI
LIST OF PARTICIPANTS Albericio F., Dr., Laboratoire de Biochimie Faculte de Médicine, Secteur Nord, 13 326 Marseille Cedex 15, France Aleksiev B., Prof., Higher Institute of Technology, 1156 Sofia, Bulgary Allen M., Dr., Ciba Geigy Pharmaceuticals Division, Wimblehurst Rd, Horsham, Vest Sussex, HH 12 4AB, U.K. Amaral Trigo M. J.S.A. , Prof., Faculda.de de Ciencias do Porto, Departamento de Química, kOOO Porto, Portugal Andreatta R., Dr., Ciba Geigy AG, CH-4056 Basel, Switzerland Arielly S., Dr., Violgatan 3A, S-^34 00 Kungsbacka, Sweden Arold H., Prof., Sektion Biologie, Friedrich Schiller Universität, Humboldtstrasse 10, 6900 Jena, G.D.R. Bajusz S., Dr., Institute for Drug Research, P.O. Box 82, H-1325 Budapest, Hungary Balashova T.A., Dr., Shemyakin Institute of Bioorganic Chemistry, USSR Academy of Sciences, Vavilova. 32, 117 988 GSP-1, Moscow 33^, U.S.S.R. Baláspiri L., Dr., Institute of Medical Chemistry, Szeged University, Medical School, Dom ter 8, 6720 Szeged, Hungary Baiíkowski K., Dr., Faculty of Chemistry, University of Warszawa, Pa.steura 1, 02-093 Warszawa, Poland Barth T., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Bauer W. , Dr., SANDOZ Ltd., Bldg. 507/204, Pharmaceutical Division, CH-4002 Basel, Switzerland Di Bello C., Prof., Istituto di Chimica Industriale, Via Marzolo 9, 35100 Padova, Italy Benoiton N.L., Prof., Department of Biochemistry, University of Ottawa, Ottawa, Ontario KIN 9A9, Canada Bienert M., Dr., Institut für Wirkstofforschung, Alfred Kowalke Strasse 4, 1136 Berlin, G.D.R. van Binst G., Prof., Vrije Universiteit Brüssel, Fakulteit Wetenschappen, Dienst Organische Chemie, Pleinlaan 2, B-1050 Brüssel, Belgium Birr C., Prof., Max Planck Institut für Medizinische Forschung, Jahnstrasse 29, D-69OO Heidelberg, F.R.G. Bláha I., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia
XXXII
Blàha K,, Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Blanot D., Dr., Equipe de Recherche no 24-5 du CNRS, Institut de Biochimie, Université de Paris Sud, 9l405 Orsay Cedex, France Bodanszky M., Prof., Case Western Reserve University, Department of Chemistry, Cleveland, OH 44lO6, U.S.A. Borin G. , Dr., Istituto di Chimica Organica, Via Marzolo, 1, 1-35100 Padova, Italy Bradbury A.F., Dr., National Institute for Medical Research, The Ridgeway, Mill Hill, London NW7 1AA, U.K. Brandenburg D., Dr., Deutsches Wollforschungsinstitut, Technische Hochschule, Veitmanplatz 8, D-5100 Aachen, F.R.G. Brenner M., Prof., Institut für Organische Chemie, Universität St. Johans Ring 19, CH-4056 Basel, Switzerland Bricas E., Dr., 11, Avenue de la Résidence, 92l60 Antony, France Brtnik F., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Brunfeldt K., Prof., The Danish Institute of Protein Chemistry, 4, Venlighedsvej, DK-2970 H^rsholm, Denmark Burton J., Dr., Laboratory of Cellular and Molecular Research, Massachusetts General Hospital, Boston, MA 02114, U.S.A. Clausen K., Dr., Kemisk Institut, Laboratory for Organisk Kemi, DK 8000 Arhus C, Denmark Colombo R., Dr., Cattedra di Chimica Biologica, Ospedale 5. Raffaele, via Olgettina 60, 1-20132 Milano, Italy Cordopatis P., Dr., Laboratory of Organic Chemistry, University of Pa.tras, Patrai, Greece Davies J.S., Dr., University College of Swansea, Department of Chemistry, Singleton Park, Swansea SAI 8PP, U.K. Deigin V., Dr., Institute of Protein Chemistry, Poustchino, Moscow Region 142292, U.S.S.R. Durieux J. P. , Dr., UCB Bioproducts, 68 rue Berkendael, B-IO6O Bruxelles, Belgium Eberle A., Dr., Research Department, Kantonsspital, Hebelstrasse 20, CH-4031 Basel, Switzerland Escher E., Dr., Department of Pharmacology, Faculty of Medicine, University of Sherbrooke, Sherbrooke, Quebec JIH 5N4, Canada
XXXIII
Etzold G., Dr., Academy of Sciences of the GDR, Central Institute of Molecular Biology, Berlin-Buch, G.D.R. Fahrenholz F., Dr., Max Planck Institut für Biophysik, Kennedy Allee 70, D-6000 Frankfurt 70, F. R.G. Fauchère J.L. , Dr., Institut für Molekularbiologie und Biophysik ETH,Hanggerberg, CH-8093 Zurich, Switzerland Fauszt I., Dr., Institute for Drug Research, P.O. Box 82, H-1325 Budapest, Hungary Fermandjian S., Dr., Service de Biochemie, C.E.N, Saclay B.P. no 2, F-911 91 Gif-sur-Yvette, France Filippi B., Dr., Istituto di Chimica Organica, via Marzolo, 1 1-35100 Padova, Italy Fischer R., Bachem AG, Hauptstrasse l44, CH-44l6 Bubendorf, Switzerland Fittkau S., Dr., Institut fur Physiologische Chemie, Martin Luther Universität, Hollystra.sse 1, 402 Halle/Salle, G.D.R. Flegel M., Dr., LÉÔIVA - Pharmaceuticals, Laboratory of Peptides, l43 10 Prague 4-Modrany, Czechoslovakia Fournié-Za.luski M. C. , Dr.. Department Chimie Organique, Faculté de Pharmacie, 4, avenue de 1 Observatoire, F-75006 Paris, France Friö I., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia. Friedrich A., Dr., Hoechst A.G., Pharma Synthese, Postfach 8OO32O, D-623O Frankfurt/Main 80, F.R.G. Fromageot P., Prof., Service de Biochimie, C.E.N. Saclay B.P. no 2, F-91191 Gif-sur-Yvette, France Galpin I.J., Dr., University of Liverpool, Department of Organic Chemistry, P.O. Box 147, Liverpool LÓ9 3BX, U.K. Garcxa-Anton J.M., Dr., Instituto de Techología, Química, Jorge Girona, Salgado s/n. , Barcelona 34, Spain Gazis D., Dr., Room 21-84. Annenberg Bldg., Mount Sinai School of Medicine, 100th St. and 5th Ave., New York, N Y 10029, U.S.A. Gillessen G., Dr., F. Hoffmann-La Roche & Co. Ltd., Bldg. 15/241, CH-4002 Basel, Switzerland Giralt E. , Prof,, Department de Química Orgánica, Fa.cultat de Química, Universität de Barcelona, Diagonal 645, Barcelona 28, Spain Glass J.D. , Dr., Mt. Sinai School of Medicine, Department of Physiology, 5th Avenue at 100th Street, New York, N Y IOO29, U.S.A.
XXXIV Gras-Masse H., Dr., Faculté de Pharmacie, Université de Lille, rue du Prof. Laguesse, F-59045 Lille, France Grzonka Z. , Dr., Institute of Chemistry, University of Gdansk, Sobieskiego 18, 80 952 Gdansk, Poland Guegan R,, Dr., Centre de Recherches Clin-Midy, rue du Pr. Blayac, F-34082 Montpellier, France Gustavsson S., Dr., AB Kabi, Peptide Research Molndal, Box 156, S-431 22 Moûnda1, Sweden Gut V., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Halstr^in J. , Dr. , The Danish Institute of Protein Chemistry, 4, Venlighedsve j, DK-2970 Hj^rsholm, Denmark Hallet A., Dr., University of London, Endocrine Unit, Royal Postgraduate Medical School, Hammersmith Hospital, Dueon Road, London ¥12 OHS, U.K. Hardy P.M., Dr., Department of Chemistry, University of Exeter, Stocker Road, Exeter EX4 4QD, U.K. Hartrodt B., Dr., Martin Luther Universität, Halle-Wittenberg, Sektion Biowissenschaften, WB Biochemie, Domplatz 1, 4020 Halle/Salle, G.D.R. Hassall C.H., Prof., Roche Products, Ltd., P.O. Box 8, Welwyn Garden City, Herts AL7 3AY, U.K. Hauzer K., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 1 6 6 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia van der Helm D., Prof., Department of Chemistry, of Oklahoma, 620 Parrington Oval, Room 211, Norman, OK 73019, U.S.A.
University
Hermann P., Dr., Institut für Physiologische Chemie, Martin Luther Universität, Hollystrasse 1, Postfach 184, 402 Halle/Salle, G.D.R. Hlavaöek J., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Hollôsi M., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry, Eotvös University, Mûzeum krt. 4/B, H-1088 Budapest, Hungary
Lorând
Hruby V.J., Prof., Department of Chemistry, University of Arizona, Tucson, AZ 85721, U.S.A. Ivanov V.T., Prof., Shemyakin Institute of Bioorganic Chemistry, USSR Academy of Sciences, Vavilova 32, Moscow 117312, U.S.S.R.
XXXV Izdebskl J., Dr., Department of Chemistry, University of Warsaw, ul. L. Pasteura 1, 02-093 Varszawa, Poland Jacobson K., Dr., Department of Organic Chemistry, Institute of Science, Rehovot, Israel
Weizmann
Jakubke H.D., Prof. Karl Marx Universität, Sektion Biowissenschaften, Bereich Biochemie, Talstrasse 33, 7010 Leipzig, G.D.R. Jaquenoud P.A., Dr., SANDOZ Ltd., Lichtstrasse j6, CH-4056 Basel, Switzerland Jeschkeit H., Dr., Sektion Chemie Martin-Luther-Universitat, Weinbergweg 16, 402 Halle, G.D.R. Jezek J., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Johansen J., Dr., CARLBIOTECH, l6, Tagensvej, DK 2200 Copenhagen N, Denmark Johansen J.H., Dr., The Peptide Group, Pediatric Research Institute, Children Clinic, University Hospital, Oslo, Norway Jost K., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Jung G., Prof., Institut für Organische Chemie der Universität, Auf der Morgenstelle 18, D-7400 Tübingen, F.R.G. Kasafxrek E., Dr., Research Institute for Pharmacy and Biochemistry, Kourimska 17, 130 60 Prague 3> Czechoslovakia Kaufmann K.D., Dr., Institut für Wirkstofforschung, AW DDR, Alfred Kowalke Strasse 1136 Berlin, G.D.R. Kaurov 0., Dr., All-Union Institute of Extra Pure Biopreparations, Bolsoj pr. 71, 199026 Leningrad V.O., U.S.S.R. Kessler H., Prof., Institut für Organische Chemie, J.W, Goethe Universität, Niederurseier Hang, D-6000 Frankfurt 50, F.R.G. Kisfaludy L., Dr., Chemical Works G. Richter, P.O. Box 27, 1475 Budapest 10, Hungary Kohlbeck W.^ Dr., Diamalt A.G., Georg-Reismüller Strasse 34, D-8000 München 50, F.R.G. Kojfodzie jczyk A. , Dr., Faculty of Chemistry, Technical University of Gdansk, Majakowskiego 11/12, 80 952 Gdansk, Poland König W.A., Prof., Institut für Organische Chemie und Biochemie der Universität, Martin-Luther-King-Platz 6, D-2000 Hamburg 13, F.R.G.
XXXVI Konopinska D., Dr., Institute of Chemistry, University of Wroclaw, ul. Joliot Curie l4, 50 3 8 3 Wroclaw, Poland Krchnak V., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak. Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Krojidlo M., Dr., LEClVA - Pharmaceuticals, Laboratory of Peptides, 143 10 Prague 4-Modrany, Czechoslovakia. Kubler U., Dr., VEB Berlin-Chemie, Glienicker Weg 182-184, 1199 Berlin-Adlershof, G.D.R. Kupryszewski G., Prof., Institute of Chemistry, University of Gdansk, Sobieskiego 18, 80 952 Gdansk, Poland Lammek B., Dr., Institute of Chemistry, University of Gdansk, ul. Sobieskiego 18, 80-952 Gdansk, Poland Larsson L.E., Dr., Pharmacia AB, Box 181, S-75104 Uppsala, Sweden Lebl M., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Lefrancier P., Dr., Institut Choay, 10, rue Morel, F-92 120 Montrouge, France Leplawy M., Prof,, Institute of Organic Chemistry, Technical University, ul. Zwirki 3 6 , 90 924 Lodz, Poland Leukart 0., Dr., BACHEM Feinchemikalien AG, Hauptstrasse 144, CH-44l6 Bubendorf, Switzerland Liberek B., Prof., Institute of Chemistry, University of Gdansk, Sobieskiego 18, 80 952 Gdansk, Poland Lindeberg G., Dr., Pentapharm AG, Engelgasse 109, CH-4002 Basel, Switzerland Lipkowski A., Dr., Faculty of Chemistry, University of Warsaw, Pasteura 1, 02 093 Warszawa, Poland Loffet A., Dr., UCB Bioproducts, 68 rue Berkendael, D-1060 Bruxelles, Belgium Loozen H,J,, Dr., Scientific Development Group, Organon, Int. B. V., P.O. Box 20, 5340 BH Oss, Netherlands Low M., Prof., Chemical Works G. Richter, P.O. Box 27, H-l475 Budapest, Hungary Lowe L.A., Dr., The Wellcome Research Laboratories, Langley Court, Beckenham, Kent BR3 3BS, U.K. Lundin R., Dr., Kabi Vitrum AB, Avd. FO, S—112 87 Stockholm, Sweden Makineni R., Dr., BACHEM Inc., 3132 Kashiwa Torrance, CA 90505, U.S.A.
Street,
XXXVII
Malori P. , Dr. , Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Markussen J,, Dr., Novo Research Institute, Novo Allee, DK-2880 Bagsvaerd, Denmark Marraud M. , Prof., Laboratoire de Chimie-Physique Macroraoléculaire, Equipe de Recherche Associée au CNRS no 23, 1, rue Grandville, F-54042 Nancy Cedex, France Martinez J., Dr., Centre de Pharmacologie Endocrinologie, Rue de 20 Cardonille, F-34000 Montpellier, France Mayer R. , Dr., Centre de Biophysique Moléculaire, F-45045 Orléans Cedex, France Mazur R.H., Dr., Searle Research and Development, Division of G.D. Searle & Co, P.O. Box 5110, Chicago, IL 60680, U.S.A. Medzihradszky K., Prof., Central Research Institute of Chemistry, Hungarian Academy of Sciences, Pusztaszeri ut. 59, H-1025 Budapest, Hungary Mehlis B., Dr., Institut für Wirkstofforschung, Alfred Kowalke Strasse 4, 1136 Berlin, G.D.R. Merrifield R.B., Prof., The Rockefeller University, New York, NY 10021, U.S.A. Mezë I., Dr., 1st Institute of Biochemistry, Semmelweiss University Medical School, P.O. Box 260, H 1444 Budapest 8, Hungary Mikhaleva I.I., Dr., Shemyakin Institute of Bioorganic Chemistry, USSR Academy of Sciences, Vavilova 32, 117988 Moscow, U.S.S.R. Minchev S., Dr., Higher Pedagogical Institute, 97OO Shoumen, Bulgary Mitin Yu.V., Dr., Institute of Protein Research, USSR Academy of Sciences, 142292 Poustschino, Moscow Region, U.S.S.R. Morley J.S., Dr., 24 Cheadle Road, Cheadle Hulme, Cheshire SK8 5EW, U.K. Moroder L., Prof., Max Planck Institut für Biochemie, Abteilung fur Peptidchemie, am Klopferspitz, D-8033 Martinsried b. München, F.R.G. Munekata. E., Prof., University of Tsukuba, Institute of Applied Biochemistry, Ibarakiken, 305, Tsukuba., Japan Naithani V.K, , Dr. , Deutsches Wollforschungsinstitut an der Technischen Hochschule Aachen, Veltmanplatz 8, D-51OO Aachen, F.R.G. Najjar V.A., Prof., Tufts University School of Medicine, American Cancer Society, 136 Harrison Avenue, Boston, MA 02111, U.S.A.
XXXVIII
Nesvadba. Ii., Dr., SANDOZ Forschungsinstitut, Brunner Strasse 59, Postfach 80, A-1235 Wien, Austria Niedrich H., Prof., Institut für Wirkstofforschung, Alfred Kowalke Strasse 4, 1136 Berlin, G.D.R. Nikiforovich G.V., Dr., Institute of Organic Synthesis, Acad. Sci. of the Latvian SSR, Aizlcraukles 21, 226006 Riga 6, U.S.S.R. Nikolics K., Dr., First Institute of Biochemistry, Semmelweis University Medical School, Budapest, Hungary van Nispen J.W.F.M., Dr., Scientific Development Group, Organon Int. B.V., P.O. Box 20, 5340 BH Oss, Netherlands Offord R., Prof., Dópartment de Biochimie medicale, 21 rue Lombard, 1211 Geneve, Switzerland Ohno M., Dr., Laboratory of Chemical Biology NIADDK, Bldg.10, 9N-307, National Institute of Health, Bethesda, MD 20205, U.S.A. Ovchinnikov Ya.A., Prof., Shemyakin Institute of Bioorganic Chemistry, USSR Academy of Sciences, Vavilova 32, Moscow II7312, U.S.S.R. Paruszewski R., Dr., Medical Academy, Department of Pharmaceutical Chemistry, Banacha. 1, 02 097 Warszawa, Poland Patchornik A., Prof., Department of Organic Chemistry, Weizmann Institute of Science, Rehovot, Israel Pedone C., Dr., Università di Napoli, Istituto chimico, via Mazocannone, 4, 80134 Napoli, Italy Pedroso E., Dr., Department of Química Orgànica., Facultat de Química., Universität de Barcelona, Diagonal 647, Barcelona 28, Spain Penke B. v Dr., Institute of Medicinal Chemistry, Dom ter 8, 6720 Szeged, Hungary Perseo A., Dr., Farmitalia Carlo Erba, via dei Crasci 3, Milano, 20l46-Italy Petersen H., Dr., Novo Research Institute, Novo Allee, DK-2880 Bagsvaerd, Denmark Pfaender P., Prof., Abteilung Biologische Chemie, Universität Hohenheim, Postfach 106, D-7000 Stuttgart 70, F.R.G. Photaki I., Prof., University of Athens, Laboratory of Organic Chemistry, Navarinou Street 13 a , Athens 144, Greece Pipkorn R., Dr., Ferring AB, Box 3 0 5 6 1 , S-200Ó2 Malmö, Sweden Popovich V.A., Dr., Shemyakin Institute of Bioorganic Chemistry, Vavilova 32, Moscow 117988, U.S.S.R.
XXXIX Pospiëek J., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia. Poulos C., Dr., Laboratory of Organic Chemistry, University of Patras, Patrai, Greece Prochâzka Z., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia Przyby^ski J., Dr., Institute of Chemistry, University of Gdansk, Sobieskiego 18, 80 952 Gdansk, Poland Ragnarsson U., Dr., Institute of Biochemistry, University of Uppsala, Biomedical Center, Box 576, S-751 23 Uppsala, Sweden Ramage R., Prof., University of Manchester, Institute of Science and Technology, P.O. Box 88, Manchester M60 1QD, U.K. Reig F., Dr., Instituto de Tecnologia. Quimica y Textil C.S.I.C., C/Jorge Girona. Salgado s/n, Barcelona. 34, Spain van Rietschoten J., Dr., Inserm S.C. 10, Faculté de Médecine, Sec. Nord, Boulevard P. Dramard, F-13 326 Marseille Cedex 15, France Rivier J.E., Dr., Peptide Biology Laboratory, The Salk Institute, P.O. Box 858OO, San Diego, CA 92138, U.S.A. Rocchi R., Prof., Istituto di Chiraica via Marzolo 1, 351 Padova., Italy
Organica,
Roques B., Prof., Laboratoire de Chimie Organique, UER Sciences Pharmaceutiques et Biologiques, Université R. Descartes, 4, Av. de 1 Observatoire, F-75270 Paris Cedex 06, France Roy P.D., Dr., Océ-Andeno B.V., P.O. Box 81, 5900 AB Venlo, Netherlands Rzeszotarska, B., Prof., Institute of Chemistry, Higher School of Pedagogy, Oleska 48, 45-052 Opole, Poland Sakarellos C., Prof., Laboratory of Organic Chemistry, University of Ioannina, Ioannina., Greece Sandberg B., Dr., MRC Neurochemical Pharmacology Unit, Medical School, Hill's Road, Cambridge CB2 2QH, U.K. Sa.vrda J. , Dr. , Institut Pasteur, Service de la Tuberculose, 25, rue du Dr. Roux, F-75724 Paris, France Scatturin A., Prof., Istituto di Chimica. Farma.ceutica, via Scandiana, 21, 1-44100 Ferrara, Italy Schaaper W., Dr., Delft University of Technology, Laboratory of Organic Chemistry, Julianalaan 1 3 6 , 2628 B L Delft, Netherlands
XL Schneider C.H. , Prof., Institut fur Klinische Immunologie, Inselspital, CH-3010 Bern, Switzerland Schön I., Dr., Chemical Works of Gedeon Richter, Ltd., Budapest, P.O. Box 27, H-1^75 Budapest, Hungary Schou O., Dr., Danish Institute of Protein Chemistry, k, Venlighedsvej, DK-2970 H^rsholm, Denmark Schwartz I.L., Prof., Room 21-86, Annenberg Bldg., Mt. Sinai School of Medicine, 100th Street and 5th Avenue, New York, NY 10029, U.S.A. Schwyzer R., Prof., Institut für Molekularbiologie und Biophysik ETHZ, CH-8093 Zürich, Switzerland Seprodi J., Dr., First Institute of Biochemistry, Semmelweis University Medical School, Budapest, Hungary Servitova L. , Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia. Sheppard R.C., Dr., Laboratory of Molecular Biology, MRC Centre, Hill's Road, Cambridge CB2 2QH, U.K. Shiba T., Dr., Department of Chemistry, Faculty of Science, Osaka University, Toyonaka 560, Osaka, Japan Siemion I.Z., Prof., Institute of Chemistry, University of Wroclaw, ul. Joliot Curie l4, 50 383 Wroclaw, Poland Skopkova J., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia. Stehle P., Dr., Institut fur Biologische Chemie und Ernährungswissenschaft, University of Hohenheim, D-7000 Stuttgart 70, F.R.G. Stewart J.M,, Prof., University of Colorado, Medical School, Biochemistry B-126, Denver, CO 80262, U.S.A. Stoev S., Dr., Institute of Molecular Biology, Bulgarian Academy of Sciences, 1113 Sofia, Bulga.ry Straka R,, Dr., Institute of Hygiene and Epidemiology, Srobarova 48, 100 kZ Prague 10-Vinohrady, Czechoslovakia. SÜli-Vargha H., Dr., Research Group for Peptide Chemistry, Hungarian Academy of Sciences, Muzeum krt. 4/B, H-1088 Budapest, Hungary Szelke M., Dr., Royal Postgraduate Medical School, Hammersmith Hospital, Ducane Road, London W12 OHS, U.K. *
r
••
••
Szokan G., Dr., Institute of Organic Chemistry, Eotvos University, Muzeum krt. 4/B, H-1088 Budapest, Hungary Teetz V,, Dr., Hoechst A.G., Pharma Synthese G 8 3 8 , Postfach 800320, D-6230 Frankfurt/Main 80, F.R.G.
XLI Ten Kortenaar P.B.W., Dr., Laboratorium voor Organische Chemie, Toernooiveld, NL-6525 ED Nijmegen, Netherlands Teplân I., Dr., Hungarian Academy of Sciences, Department of Life Sciences, P.O. Box 6 , H - 1 3 6 1 Budapest, Hungary Theodoropoulos D. , Prof., Laboratory of Organic Chemistry, School of Natural Sciences, University of Patras, Patras, Greece Thoreil J., Dr., Ferring AB, Fack, S-200 60 Malmö,
Sweden
Thornber C., Dr., ICI Pharmaceuticals Division, Mereside, Alderley Park, Macclesfield, Cheshire SK10 4TG, U.K. Tomatis R., Prof., Istituto di Chimica Pharmaceutica, via Scandiana, 21, 1-44100 Ferrara, Italy Toniolo C., Prof., Istituto di Chimica Organica, University di Padova, via Marzolo, 1, 1-35100 Padova, Italy Vavrek R., Dr., Department of Biochemistry B12ó, University of Colorado, Medical School, 4200 East 9th Avenue, Denver, CO 802Ó2, U.S.A. Veber D. F. , Dr., Department of Medicinal Chemistry, Merck Sharp and Dohme, Research Laboratories, West Point, PA 19486, U.S.A. Vicar J., Dr., Department of Chemistry, Medical Faculty, Palacky University, S. Allende 3» 77515 Olomouc, Czechoslovakia Vlasov G.P., Dr., Institute of High Molecular Weight Compounds, USSR Academy of Sciences, Leningrad, U.S.S.R. Voelter W., Prof., Physiologisch-Chemisches Institut, Universität Tübingen, Hope-Seyler Strasse 1, D-7400 Tübingen, F.R.G. Vogel E., Dr., Fluka AG, CH-9^70 Buchs,
Switzerland
Voss C., Dr., Max Planck Institut fur Medizinische Abtlg. Naturstoff-Chemie, Jahnstrasse 29> D - 6 9 O O Heidelberg, F.R.G.
Forschung,
Wade J., Dr., Laboratory of Molecular Biology, MRC Centre, Hill's Road, Cambridge CB2 2QH, U.K. Wade R., Dr., CIBA GEIGY, Pharmaceuticals Division, Wimblehurst Road, Horsham, West Sussex RH12 4AB, U.K. Wallace C.J.A., Dr., Départment de Biochimie médicale, Centre Médical Universitaire, 1, rue Michel-Servet, 1211 Genève 4, Switzerland Walz H., Dr., VEB Berlin-Chemie, Glienicker Weg 182-184, 1199 Berlin-Adlershof, G.D.R, Widmer F., Dr., National Institutes of Health, Laboratory of Chemical Biology NIADDK, Bg.lO, 9 N - 3 0 7 , Bethesda, MD 20205, U.S.A.
XLII Wieland T., Prof., Max Planck Institut für Medizinische Forschung, Jahnstrasse 29, D-69OO Heidelberg, F.R.G. Williams B.J., Dr., Neurochemical Pharmacology Unit, Medical Research Council Centre, Hill s Road, Cambridge, U.K. Winter H., Dr., Institute fur Organische Chemie Universität Tübingen, auf der Morgenstelle 18, Tübingen, F.R.G. Wünsch E., Prof., Max Planck Institut für Biochemie, Abteilung für Peptidchemie, am Klopferspitz, D-8033 Martinsried b. München, F.R.G. Young G.T., Dr., The Dyson Perrins Laboratory, South Parks Road, 0X2 6UR Oxford, U.K. Zahn H., Prof., Deutsches Wollforschungsinstitut der Technischen Hochschule Aachen, Veitmanplatz 8, D-5100 Aachen, F.R.G. Zanotti G., Dr., Xstituto di Chimica Farmaceutica, Citta Universitaria, Pz. le Aldo Moro, 1-00100 Roma, Italy Zaora.l M. , Dr. , Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, l66 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia
XLIII Emil Taschner 1900 - 1982 Emil Taschner was born in Cracow in 1900. He entered the Jagiellonian University in 1920 to study chemistry and later moved to Vienna where he received in 1927 his PhD degree. After postgraduate studies in Paris (Pa steur Institute, Department of Biochemistry and Department of Internal Medicine of the University of Paris he returned to Cracow and worked in the Pharmacology Department of the Jagiellonian University (Professor J. Supniewski) and in the research laboratory of the pharmaceutical factory "Dr. A. Wander".
The years of World War II he spent in Lwow partly as a workman, partly in hiding. Vhentfie atrocities were over he moved to Wroclaw where he joined the General Chemistry Department of the University and Technical University. In 1953 he folior
wed a call to Gdansk and was appointed Head of the Department of General Chemistry at the Technical University. In 1964 he became Head of the Peptide Chemistry Department at the same University. He retired from that post in 1971« Taschner s scientific carreer began in Vienna with the isolation of compounds from Brionia dioica. (doctor thesis). In
XLIV Paris he widened his horizons into biochemistry (investigations on serum lipase). During the Cracow period his interest was focused on biochemistry and drug research. For his studies on tumor-inducing compounds he was awarded in 1938 the Pilsudski prize of the Polish Society for Fighting Cancer. His studies on derivatives of tyrosine hydantoin as potential antithyreotoxicosis agents, started in Cracow and continued in Wroclaw, are the first indica.tion of his future interest in amino acids and peptides. After World War II studies had begun in Wroclaw on acylation with diacetylamides, and this was a further indication of his future interest in peptide research. The move to Gdansk provided the opportunity for expansion of his research activities. He recognized amino acids and peptides as a field of expanding importance and was fortunate enough to gather a group of co-workers who laid the founda«tion for a school of peptide chemistry in Poland. He started by introducing newer methods of organic chemistry to peptide synthesis. In a series of papers various aspects of fision reactions of ester, urethane and amide groups were studied. These investigations culminated in the elaboration of new procedures for acidolytic removal of benzyloxycarbonyl amino protection. In this context, I should also mention the cleavage reaction of esters by lithium halogenides. This method, albeit not used widely in peptide chemistry, found its way into organic chemistry as a method of choice for solving specific problems connected with the carboxyl protection. The seniors among us will recall the first meeting of the European peptide community in Prague where Taschner reviewed the problem of carboxyl protection. It is a pity that the manuscript of the lecture was not published, but the printed discussion following his lecture gives evidence that he being aware of shortcomings of the methods available at that time and inspired from the field of penicillin chemistry -
XLV proposed to use the tert-butyl group for amino and carboxyl protection. To envisage protection with tertiary alkyl groups required great foresight and inspiration. It remained in his mind until in 1959 in Munich at the XVTIth Congress of Pure and Applied Chemistry and 2nd EPS he presented the first approaches to the synthesis of tert-butyl esters of amino acids. In 1961 Taschner and his group published the first paper on the synthesis of tert-butyl esters of amino acids by transesterification of tert-butyl acetate. This
transesterifica-
tion - or esterolysis, as Taschner called it - set a milestone not only in the history of carboxyl protection in peptide research but also as a method of choice for the generation of tert-butyl cations in organic chemistry. The approach was developed further and methods became available for the direct esterification of amino acids with unmasked amino group, selective esterification of the gamma carboxylic group of glutamic acid, etc. The studies of Taschner's group were contemporary to those of Robert Schwyzer's group. Both authors became aware of the synthetic potentialities of tertiary esters which were subsequently exploited in numerous syntheses. Another topic - epimerization
(ra.cemization) studies - conti-
nued to be Taschner's main theme for several years and culminated in the "two spots Taschner's ra.cemization test" as it was denoted in "Houben Weyl" by Wunsch et al. Using paper and/or thin-layer chromatography various activation procedures were tested for the degree of loss of stereochemical homogeneity in the a.cylating residue during coupling. A further point of interest was the evaluation of the danger of ra.cemization in the amino acid residue penultimate to the C-terminal one. Having established the degree of epimerization in various coupling procedures, including the azide method, and having defined the experimental conditions which
XLVI suppress the undesirable formation of epimers in peptide synthesis, Taschner considered even more ambitious targets. His last papers on peptide chemistry described new methods for peptide bond formation which, according to two spots test, were free or almost free from racemization. These routes included the use of active 3-Pyridyl, N-hydroxyquinolinimide, and benzhydroxamic esters. /
I have tried to offer an account of Taschner s more important contributions believing that this would be the best tribute to his innovative ability and foresight. Throughout his life, he was hard working and productive with many original ideas, and evinced the greatest enthusiasm for research devoting full vigour to his beloved peptide field. Taschner was a person who did not care for rank, honours or grades. The achievements which brought him international reputation gave him no splendour in his homeland. My portrait of a person and a scientist would not be complete without mentioning that he will always be remembered for his wit, and for anecdotes about him. I would like to quote from Theodor Wieland's recollections at the Gdansk meeting in 1978: "There was Etail Taschner who contributed at this place to the genius loci, and whose presence always brought a sort of pepper to the symposia". Einil Taschner died in Gdansk on Hay 4, 1982 in his 82nd year. He left over 100 scientific publications and patents. The Polish peptide community has lost its most prominent personality who will always be remembered.
(Bogdan Liberek)
XLVII Dieter Marquarding 193^ - 1982 Dr. Dieter Marquarding, Professor at the Technische Universität in Munich died untimely July 9, 1982 after a short, but severe disease. He was 47 years old. Born in Königsberg (presently Kaliningrad) on November 3°> 193^ Dieter Marquarding received the degree of Diplom-Cheraist from the University of Hamburg in 1961 and working with Professor G. Snatzke the Doctor degree in chemistry in 1965 from the University of Bonn. He then went to the research laboratories of Bayer AG, Leverkusen and finally in 1973 he joined the research group of Professor Ivar Ugi at the Technische Universität in Munich.
Dieter Marquarding made numerous research contributions to the stereochemistry of ferrocene derivatives in collaboration with Ivar Ugi. Among these as most significant results one has to mention the retentive nucleophilic substitution, the stereoselective 2-lithiation of a-ferrocenylamines, the use of OC-ferrocenyl alkylamines for asymmetric syntheses as well as a new method for the determination of the absolute configuration.
XLVIII
Besides his specific research contributions to the theoretical stereochemistry as pseudorotation and Tournstile rotation, hyperchira.lity or group theoretical analysis of conformational flexibility, since seven years in collaboration with Rosemarie Kopp, James Dugundji and Ivar Ugi he enthusiastically worked on a. new theory of chemical identity. The results of these extensive studies will be published by the Springer Verlag in the Lecture Note Series. Dieter Marquarding's main contribution to the peptide chemistry derived from his engagement in collaboration with Ivar Ugi in the chemistry of isonitriles. The development of new methodology based on the four component condensation procedure (Ugi's reaction) as well as the morpholinoethyl isocyanide as a. new coupling reagent enriched remarkably the possibilities of peptide chemistry. For these new developments Dieter Marquarding will be remembered by the peptide chemists and his active participation at Peptide Symposia, and other meetings he attended will be missed. He was a. constant contributer to scientific discussion, a distinguished scientist and a. dear colleague. Erich Wünsch Luis Moroder
XLIX
ERHARD GROSS, 1928-1981
The tragic death of Erhard Gross, Chief of the Section on Molecular Structure, Reproduction Research Branch, National Institutes of Health, Bethesda, Maryland, in a traffic accident in Germany on September 12, 1981, deeply shocked scientists in all parts of the world.
In an instant, Gross passed away,
in the most active period of his scientific career. Throughout the years Gross participated in almost every meeting on peptides and proteins in the United States or abroad. Thus, for many years he became an international ambassador in this field of research - a role served earlier by Josef Rudinger, the founder of Peptide Symposia.
The entire scien-
tific career of Gross has been characterized by the highest kind of motivation and accomplishment; because of this his presence was missed very much in this 17th European Peptide Symposium and will be missed for many years in our future scientific gatherings.
L
Erhard Gross was born in 1928 in Wenings, near Frankfurt/Main. After graduation from the Wolfgang Ernst Gymnasium at Büdingen, he studied chemistry at the Universities of Mainz (1949-1953) and Frankfurt/Main (1953-1958).
He received his doctorate
degree (Ph.D.) in 1958, working with Professor Theodor Wieland on the synthesis of a bicyclic model peptide related to the mushroom toxin phalloidin.
Upon completion of his studies
Gross went to the United States in 1958 to work with Professor Bernhard Witkop at the National Institute of Arthritis and Metabolic Diseases, National Institutes of Health in Bethesda, Maryland.
He also spent some time with Professor Lyman C.
Craig at the Rockefeller University in New York City, further broadening his fields of expertise.
In 1968 Gross was ap-
pointed Chief of the Section on Molecular Structure, Laboratory of Biomedical Sciences, and in 1973 Chief of the Section on Molecular Structure, Reproduction Research Branch at the National Institute of Child Health and Human Development, National Institutes of Health. The scientific work of Erhard Gross was distinguished by excellence and innovation, and the foundations for these qualities were undoubtedly developed during his studies with Theodor Wieland in Frankfurt.
The style of Gross' work, the precision
and attention to detail as well as his extraordinary perseverance, were developed during these years.
The admirable com-
bination of basic organic chemistry, natural products chemistry and peptide synthesis in Wieland's laboratory determined the directions of Gross' research.
Of equally lasting influence
was the close friendship that existed between Wieland and Gross and which extended throughout his career.
The association
with Lyman C. Craig, an innovative genius and yet so kind and modest a person, was in Gross' own words "of the most profound
LI influence on my subsequent career"
(1).
Of, perhaps, similar
consequence was his affiliation for ten years with Bernhard Witkop, a superb analytic and philosophic mind at the National Institute of Arthritis and Metabolic Diseases. A series of publications started to appear in 1960 dealing with non-enzymatic cleavage of peptide bonds.
The paper by
Gross and Witkop on the "selective cleavage of methionyl peptide bonds in ribonuclease with cyanogen bromide"
(2) dis-
closed the most useful of all chemical cleavage procedures, which combined mild reaction conditions with a high level of selectivity.
It continues to be an indispensable method
for the structural elucidation of peptides and proteins that contain methionine
(3) and has recently gained additional
importance for rapid HPLC peptide mapping and for recombinant DNA synthesis. In 1967 the first publication on the peptide antibiotic nisin was published by Gross and Morell.
The report of the presence
of an unusual amino acid, i.e. dehydroalanine, in nisin was not to cause any special attention because unusual constituents had long become the hallmark of most antibiotics.
However, it
soon became apparent that nisin possessed a most fascinating complexity of unprecedented structural features.
The complete
structure was reported in 1971 (4), and of the 29 amino acids in nisin, eight are rarely found in nature.
Three of these are
dehydroamino acids, i.e. two dehydroalanine and one dehydrobutyrine residue.
There are five cyclic structures in the
peptide chain, formed by sulfide bridges that are contributed by one lanthionine and four 8-methyllanthionine units.
Penta-
cyclic heterodetic type of peptides were found for the first
Lll time, two of which were fused in a unique double-ring structure consisting of 13-membered rings each at the carboxyl terminal region of nisin. Surprisingly, other peptide antibiotics from different microorganisms, such as subtilin, cinnamycin, and duramycin were found to have similar backbone structures, although of slightly different amino acid sequence
(for review see 5).
The study of
these antibiotics developed into a lifelong project for Gross and his collaborators.
Plans and work toward the synthesis of
these complex molecules
(6) and on the further exploration of
their interesting biological effects remain uncompleted. The occurrence of so many unusual amino acids in nisin and subtilin became the origin of another fascinating trail of research for Gross, i.e. the chemistry and synthetic utility of a,0-unsaturated amino acids.
Dehydroalanine, isolated from
nisin in 1967 (7) was the first a,3-unsaturated amino acid discovered in nature.
It can be readily incorporated into peptide
chains via g-elimination of intermediate O-tosylserine residues, and its side chain reactivity then permits cleavage into peptide acyl amide and pyruvyl peptide by mild acid hydrolysis. Recently an elegant solid phase synthesis of oxytocin was described
(8) in which the carboxy terminal amide was generated
from a dehydroalanine anchor to the solid support and both the asparaginyl and glutaminyl amide groups from dehydroalanyl ethylamide, by acid hydrolysis at the end of the synthesis
(for
review see 9). Another family of antibiotic peptides with highly unusual albeit highly ordered structural features, the linear gramicidins, proved to be of continuous and lasting interest to Gross.
LIU Efficient solid phase procedures were developed for the synthesis of gramicidins A, B and C (10).
These formylpentadeca-
peptide ethanolamide molecules with an alternating pattern of L- and D-configurations were found by Dan Urry to assume the conformation of the ir -helix and to form channels for cation LD transport in lipid membranes. An intensive study of these systems was carried out in collaboration with Peter Läuger at the University in Konstanz using synthetic analogs of the gramicidins (for review see 11). The most recent interest of Gross was focused on the chemistry and function of chemotactic peptides, which he pursued in collaboration with E. Schiffmann (12). Erhard Gross will also be widely remembered for his outstanding literary contributions to the peptide and protein field. At a very critical time, in the early 1960's, when the methodology of peptide synthesis was rapidly expanding, Gross undertook the enormous task of translating the two volumes, "The Peptides", compiled by Eberhard Schröder and Klaus Lübke from German into English, published by Academic Press in (1965/66).
The impact of these books on the rapid development
of peptide research was invaluable.
Ten years later we dis-
cussed whether the monumental Houben-Weyl of Erich Wünsch should be translated into English, or whether an expanded second edition of Schröder/Ltlbke should be produced.
It was
Gross' dre am to collect all the information on the now exponentially growing peptide field in concise form.
Eventually, this
assumed the format of multi-authored, medium-sized reviews in the open-ended treatise, "The Peptides, Analysis, Synthesis, Biology .{Academic Press).
Due to the tireless efforts of Gross,
LIV four volumes have appeared (13).
Two other volumes under his
editorship are in preparation (14) . Gross was very active in the American Peptide Symposium Committee and made major contributions to the organization of several of the symposia.
One of the most outstanding meetings was one
held under his chairmanship in Georgetown University, Washington, D.C., in 1979.
The number of participants, as well as of
lectures and posters, and the size of the Proceedings Volume (Peptides: Structure and Biological Function) exceeded those of all previous symposia.
The Winter Gordon Conferences on
Peptides established in 1976 were regularly attended by Gross who was an outstanding contributor to the discussions and provided much stimulation. Gross always promoted international collaboration and exchange. Many of his collaborators were visitors from overseas, especially Japan and Poland.
In 1979 he was awarded the Alexander von
Humboldt prize to carry out collaborative studies in Germany a well deserved honor. Gross had a wide span of extracurricular interests including theater, literature and music. enjoyed a party.
He was very sociable and always
He did not hesitate to drive for hours to
obtain a selected bottle of wine.
At his home in Bethesda
Gross preferred to maintain a German style of life with his wife, Gertrud, and his two sons, Johannes and Christoph.
Every
year they spent their summer vacations at their German home town.
On each Christmas Eve the family followed him into the
nearby Virginia woods to personally cut a Christmas tree to be decorated in their home. Along with his family the large constituency of his friends throughout the world mourn his passing and will always remember him
-
(J. Meienhofer)
LV
References 1.
Gross, E.: In "Peptides: Chemistry, Structure and Biology (R. Walter, J. Meienhofer, eds.), p. 31. Ann Arbor Sei. Publ., Ann Arbor, Michigan 1975.
2.
Gross, E., Witkop, B.: J. Am. Chem. Soc. £3, 1510-1511 (1961).
3.
Gross, E.: In "Methods in Enzymology" (C.H.W. Hirs, ed.), pp. 238-255. Academic Press, New York 1966.
4.
Gross, E., Morell, J.L.: J. Am. Chem. Soc. 93., 4634-4635 (1971).
5.
Gross, E.: In "Protein Crosslinking-B" (M. Friedman, ed.) pp. 131-153. Plenum Publ., New York 1977.
6.
Pallai, P., Gross, E.: In "Peptides 1978" (I.Z. Siemion, G. Kupryszewski, eds.), pp. 357-363. Wroclaw University Press, Wroclaw, Poland 1979.
7.
Gross, E., Morell, J.L.: J. Am. Chem. Soc. 89^, 2791-2792 (1967) .
8.
Nöda, K., Gazis, D., Gross, E.: Int. J. Peptide Protein Res. 19 , 413-419 (1982) .
9.
Gross, E., Nöda, K., Matsuura, S.: In "Peptides 1974" (Y. Wolman, ed.), pp. 403-413. Wiley, New York 1975.
10.
Nöda, K., Gross, E.: In "Chemistry and Biology of Peptide (J. Meienhofer, ed.), pp. 241-250. Ann Arbor Sei. Publ., Ann Arbor, Michigan 1972.
11.
Bamberg, E., Apell, H.-J., Alpes, H., Gross, E., Morell, J.L., Harbaugh, J.F., Janko, K., Läuger, P.: Federation Proc. 37_, 2633-2638 (1978).
12.
Aswanikumar, S., Schiffmann, E., Corcoran, B.A., Pert, C.B., Morell, J.L., Gross, E.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 80., 464-477 (1978) .
13.
The Peptides, Analysis, Synthesis, Biology (E. Gross, J. Meienhofer, eds.): Vol. 1, Major Methods of Peptide Bond Formation (1979); Vol. 2, Special Methods in Peptide Synthesis, Part A (1980); Vol. 3, Protection of Functional Groups in Peptide Synthesis (1981); Vol. 4, Modern Techniques of Conformational, Structural and Configurational Analysis (1981). Academic Press, New York.
14.
See (13): Vol. 5, Special Methods in Peptide Synthesis, Part B (1983); Vol. 6, Physical Methods in Peptide Confor mational Studies. (V. Hruby, Volume ed.) (1983).
RECENT DEVELOPMENTS IN THE CHEMISTRY AND BIOLOGY OF CYCLIC PEPTIDES
Yuri Ovchinnikov, Gunar Chipens* and Vadim Ivanov Shemyakin Institute of Bioorganic Chemistry, USSR Academy of Sciences, 117988 Moscow, USSR *Institute of Organic Synthesis, Latvian Academy of Sciences, Riga, USSR
Cyclopeptides comprise a large group of compounds isolated from natural sources or obtained by chemical synthesis. There are many reasons due to which cyclic peptides over a number of decades remain a popular object of study. All cyclic peptides (except cyclic disulfides) are synthesized by specific
poly-
enzymic systems rather than by conventional ribosomal procedure. In addition to being cyclic they all have other peculiar features not present in the peptides obtained by processing of proteins. The most obvious is presence of various noncoded D,_ N u -methyl, A , etc. amino acids or a-hydroxy acids. Chemistry of cyclopeptides continuously raises interesting theoretical problems concerning their structure elucidation, synthesis or explanation of physicochemical properties. Reaction of cyclization appeared to be a complex process in which linear oligomerization competes with cyclization of both the original activated peptide and its oligomers, hence the term
R I H - (NHCHCO )n- X
I
R I ^-(NHCHCO)n^ Fig. 1.
R I H-(NHCHCOX
I
R ' ^(NHCHCO
R I *~H-(NHCHCO ), - X
I R
1
NHCHCO)^
Cyclooligomerization of a linear peptide (1).
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
, etc .
2
"cyclooligomerization"
(Fig. 1). Relative yields of the pro-
ducts obtained are determined by an intricate combination of factors: dilution, conformation of linear peptides and the cycles to be formed, structures of the reaction complexes, stability of the reactive intermediates, and so on. The problem of cyclic disulfide formation has been met and solved in early 50-ies by Du
Vigneaud in his pioneering
studies of oxytocin and related molecules. Here, additional possibility arises that the cyclic dimer might be parallel and antiparallel, as shown in Fig. 2. The regularities found at the study of cyclic disulfides are directly related to such aspects of protein chemistry as recombination of A and B chains of insulin and renaturation of cystine-containing proteins after reduction (ribonuclease A, trypsin inhibitor, etc.). Cyclopeptides, especially with smaller rings sometimes possess unusual chemical properties due to transannular interactions resulting, for example, in formation of cyclols (5) (ergot alkaloids, antamanide, Fig. 3). Besides, it is the chemistry of cyclols from which an original method of cyclopeptides synthesis has evolved, the so called hydroxy (or amino) acyl incorporation. This method afforded facile preparation of a series of cyclic depsipeptides, including the antibiotic serratamolide (Fig. 4) .
H - C y s - G l y n ~ Cys - OH
> H - Cys-Glyn"Cys-OH
H-Cys-Glyn-Cys-OH
H - Cys - Gly n - Cys - OH
H - C y s - G l y n - Cys - O H Fig. 2. (2, 3).
HO - C y s - G l y n - C y s - H
Cyclization of Cys,Cys-containing peptides
3
H0
H QH
r C-C-NH
-NH-CJ 0
*
,0
r c-c'
-r—' -N-C n .0
NH,
* ,0
rc-c-
:R • HjN- •—COOMe I MeOH _J -N -N-C II _0
-H20/ /H20 H -C-C=Ni H» rC-C-NH ^ N-C-'
_H
* ^ N-C 1
^ N-C—'
n t g Fig. 3. Suggested formation of cyclols (b) during acid hydrolysis of antamanide, leading to "false" sequences (d) and racemization due to (b)i(f)£(g)*(h) equilibrium (4).
Absence of N- or C-terminal groups and availability of model cyclopeptides have made them favourable objects for physicochemical studies. Especially popular are the simplest cyclopeptides, the diketopiperazines. They easily form even on acid hydrolys is of proteins. This fact/ discovered in the last century at the reign of Emil Fischer led to a number of diketopiperazine theories of protein structure; some of them survived until the late 50-ies. At present diketopiperazines serve a
ACOCHJ
NH
0
OBZL CH 3 (CH ; )°CHCH 2 C0CI
O^nh-^ch2OAC
Bzl
CH,0Ac
OCAL^S
co^y10 o\-, Bzl
C 7 H ,5N
ri
1
1
CH2OH Serratamolide
Fig. 4. Total synthesis of serratamolide by hydroxyacyl incorporation (6, 7).
4 more prosaic but still a useful purpose in the studies of racemization kinetics (8-13), photolysis (14), radiolysis (15), mass-spectrometric fragmentation (16-19), solution thermodynamics (20) . Many naturally occuring cyclopeptides possess high biological activity. Extreme diversity of their structures, of mechanisms of action and of molecular targets is quite remarkable (see the review (21)). To this group belong the widely known cyclic disulfides - hormones oxytocin, vasopressin, calcitonin, somatostatin, toxins of the phalloidin and amanitin families, apamine, tertiapin, secapin, the antitoxin antamanide, cyclopeptides - carriers of alkali metal ions (valinomycin, enniatins) and Fe"*+ (ferrichromes), antibiotics disturbing the structure of biological membranes (gramicidin S, polymixins), blocking the ribosomal function (etamycin, virginiamycin S and related cyclodepsipeptides, containing a 3-hydroxypicolinic residue), the biosynthesis of bacterial cell wall (vancomycin and penicillins, though attribution of the latter to cyclopeptides might be rather far fetched) or binding to DNA (actinomycins, triostins and echinomycins); considerable interest is currently attracted by a powerful immunodepressor, cyclosporine A. Conformationally cyclic peptides are less flexible than their linear counterparts, a feature which has far-reaching consequences. Comparative simplicity of the conformational equilibrium greatly facilitates studies of three dimensional structures, both by X-ray analysis (conformationally homogeneous samples are easier to crystallize) and by spectral methods in solutions which are so difficult to apply to linear peptides because of averaging of the spectral parameters. Conformational studies provided a key to understanding the mechanisms of action of antibiotics-ionophores
(valinomycin,
enniatins), antamanide, gramicidin S, actinomycins, echinomycin, and some other cyclopeptides. Only a few examples from other classes of pharmacologically active compounds can be cited with a comparable insight into molecular mechanisms of action.
5
Understanding of regularities of cyclopeptide mitted goal-directed
folding per-
synthesis of new compounds of this class,
which are used either as enzyme substrates (22-30) or as models of enzyme active sites (31-40). Advances in stereochemistry of depsipeptides - ionophores stimulated preparation of novel syn2+ thetic ion-, particularly Ca -transporting cyclopeptides (41, 42). They also accelerated investigations into chemistry of other types of metal binding molecules - crown ethers, cryptands (43, 44) and even linear amides
(45-47).
Cyclopeptides are favourite objects for developing the methodology of the spectral analysis of peptide conformation. Assignment of CD bands and evaluation of their calculation methods, quantitative analysis of hydrogen bonding from IR and NMR spectra
(see the reviews (19, 48)), formulation of stereo-
chemical dependencies of vicinal coupling constants (49) these and many other studies became possible due to accessibility of cyclopeptides and their unique properties. It is not surprising that cyclopeptides became a sort of test field for formulating and verifying new stereochemical concepts subsequently extended to linear peptides and proteins. In 50-ies Schwyzer (50) having only sparse firm data at hand proposed "pleated sheet" structures for cyclic hexa- and decapeptides, a concept which we all accept
today. Conformational
parameters of g-turns stabilized with 4->-l hydrogen bonds were established on the example of cyclopeptides
(valinomycin,
gramicidin S, cyclic hexapeptides). Now B - turns are considered along with the a-helix and g-structure as the major, basic elements of the protein structure. In 1963 Dale (51) included cyclopeptides into his more general analysis of relative thermodynamic stabilities of various macrocycles. At the end of 60-ies Prelog et al. (52-54) developed on the example of cyclopeptides his original ideas of cycloenantiomerism and cyclodiasterebisomerism. The idea of total transformation of the peptide (retro-, enantio-, retroenantio isomers, substitutions COO
CONH, CONH
COO and so
on) with preservation of the overall molecular topography was
6
formulated by us on the example of cyclic peptides (55, 56). According to this approach, called topochemical, a number interesting analogs of valinomycin (57, 58), enniatins (59, 60), antamanide (61-64) and gramicidin S (65-67) was obtained. Similar transformations of linear peptides afforded various active preparations - inhibitors of enzymes, a-chymotrypsin (56, 68, 69), pepsin (56, 70), thrombin (71), analogs of angiotensin (72, 73) and enkephaline (74-76). Recent developments in experimental and theoretical approaches to conformational states of peptides afforded some progress in unraveling the spatial structures of biologically active linear peptides: bradykinin, angiotensin, corticotropin, enkephalins, neurotensin, 6-sleep inducing peptide, tuftsin and others. Despite the clearly expressed conformational mobility folded structures seemed to participate in the conformational equilibrium of all these peptides. Calculations showed that these structures may be stabilized by ionic interactions of oppositely charged carboxyl and amino (or guanidinium) moieties. These interactions are weak in the strongly solvating water but are expected to increase considerably in the lipophilic phase of bioreceptor as shown in Fig. 5. Thus, we arrive at the
Polar (aqueous) solution
L i p o p h i l i c receptor
biophase
Fig. 5. Receptor binding favours ionic interactions and folding (77, 78, 84).
7 suggestion that covalent crosslinking of these quasicyclic structures, i.e. cyclization of linear peptides might be a plausible way to novel biologically active preparations.
7 In fact as early as in 1966 Meienhofer synthesized cyclo (-Gly —
kallidin-) (78), in 1975 DeCoen et al. prepared (79), in 1977 Donzel et al.
cycloangiotensin
(80) and in 1978 Seprodi et al.
(81) have made several cycloluliberins. Since all these preparations proved inactive, work was not continued in that direction. However, a simple analysis shows that general topography of the cycloanalog, i.e. its complementarity to the receptor strongly depends upon the choice of cyclization site, this conclusion is schematically shown in Fig. 6. Therefore in the absence of concrete data on "bioactive" conformation of the peptide the search of active analogs should include variation of the cyclization site and the ring sizes. Such search was carried out for a number of peptides
and selected results
of this work are presented below. Quite interesting data were obtained in the bradykinin/kallidin series (Table 1). It appeared that e-cyclokallidin (IV) is a
full
agonist
(a=l) both in uterus contraction and arte-
ria pressure tests in rat -(although less active than bradykinin itself, pD2=7.6) . Noteworthy, in the in vivo test the cyclic analog expressed its action for more than 2 hr whereas bracfykinin
N
O D D u N C
Fig. 6.
"
r
L
C
N
c
Linear peptides can fold in a number of ways.
8
00
CN Q CM
IO
Ol
•P
00
1-H S 0
2
U
a)
o
rH (0 o •H 01 0 rH 0 •rH CQ
T3 g i rH O 0 M CM 0 M CM Oi M
1 •X) ta M XJ i
43 CM 0 U CM >i rH O 0) Sí >i CM i—i >i O rH 1 — O 0 0 rH h O CM 0 >1 M u 1 CM 01 a h
60
Val-HH, (70BM J Z-tlo-Ph«-OM«
lav-NH} ( 70 «M )
60 I-AI«-Pha-lav-HH;
V«I-HH, (70 *M ) I- l*u-Alo-OM*
Z-Ab-Tr-OMa
• sc-Lau-Fha-OMa
76 B
40 60
l«»-NH2 I 70 AMI
Z-lM-ila-lau-NH,
30
Val-HH, ( 70 mM)
Z-Lau-At«- Val-HH,
40
95"
J20
lay-HH, (105 mM)
I-Ala-T»
lohelix transition of ACTH N-terminal segments in trifluoroethanol (a solvent mimicking hydrophobic membrane surroundings [22])has been well documented by circular dichroism [23] and infrared spectroscopy [13]. Our results prove that the conformation of ACTH in membranes is similar to that in trifluoroethanol, but that, in membranes, the a-helical segments are oriented approximately parallel to one-another and to the lipid hydrocarbon chains. In thus appears that the lipid phase of target-cell membranes (that contain excess anionic lipid [24] could capture ACTH(l-24) molecules and facilitate receptor interaction by reduction of dimensionality [2],
The
membrane interaction would leave the address segment [25] of ACTH(1-24) on the hydrophilic surface and lead to an incorporation of the message segment [25] as an oriented a-helix into the hydrophobic layers.
This would
expose those elements of the message that are responsible for triggering different receptors for different responses on different surface elements of the helix [25].
Thus, the peptide/membrane interaction might well be
responsible for the correct orientation of the message within the membrane, so that it would then be in a position to interact properly with different receptors.
For such an interaction to take place, the active sites of the
receptors might be buried in the hydrophobic layers of the membranes and not necessarily be exposed on the hydrophilic surface.
This would explain
69 the extremely weak biological activity of the 'free message', ACTH(l-lO), that hardly interacted with membranes and prefered the p-pleated sheet over the 'active' a-helical structure of the highly potent ACTH(l-24). We might predict that a necessary condition for being a strong ACTH agonist is the presence in the molecule of a 'potentiator' or an 'address' segment [25] that will promote the tendency of the 'message' segment to be inserted into the membrane and assume a helical conformation.
If the
message is impaired, so that it cannot trigger the receptor (examples in [25], but can still meet the insertion and conformation condition, then we could expect such a molecule to be a potent antagonist. Preliminary experiments with our methods indicate that these assumptions might be correct, at least in the case of the native hormone ACTH(1-39), the partial agonist ACTH(5-24), and the strong antagonist ACTH(7-24).
(The peptide ACTH(ll-24)
is indeed only a very weak antagonist and could act by electrostatic competition on the membrane surface and not at the receptor itself.)
4.2 Opioid peptides
We have not yet performed ATR-IR experiments with these peptides, but our HL experiments strongly indicated differential ('specific') interactions with lipid bilayer vesicles. Dynorphin(1-13), which is a strong K-receptor agonist containing (like ACTH) a pharmacologically defined, N-terminal message segment (Tyr-Gly-Gly-Phe-) followed by an address segment (5-13) [26] , behaved very much like ACTH(l-24):
It inserted its message sequence into the membrane.
Thus a similar role of the membrane for the molecular mechanism of dynorphin action can be postulated.
Particularly, the recognition and active
sites of the •4
ap
d ^g
an
6
(D-Ala-D-Ala) and e ( I ) ( G l y - G l y ) bends:
d i angles d i f f e r by more than 100°, and t h i s i s i n
agreement w i t h the expectations f o r e ( I ) and p ( I ) ' II).
This i s
]
bends (Figure 5 ( I and
A least-squares f i t using the 18 atoms i n the r i n g and C„ atoms i s
shown i n Fig. 7.
P
o
The average d i f f e r e n c e i n l o c a t i o n o f the atoms i s 0.85 A.
From the drawing i t can be seen t h a t i t i s e s p e c i a l l y the peptide linkages i n the middle of the bends which do not f i t .
I f i t i s indeed p r i m a r i l y the
side groups which determine the topochemical equivalence, t h i s may not be too important because there i s compensation of the angles such t h a t the peptide linkages before and a f t e r the bends f i t q u i t e w e l l .
The d i f f e r e n c e
i n the l o c a t i o n o f the t o p o l o go i c a l equivalent C„P atoms i n the peptide and i t s retroenantiomer are 1.24 A. Prelog and coworkers (12) synthesized the peptides c ( L - A l a - L - A l a - G l y - G l y L-Ala-Gly) and c ( L - A l a - L - A l a - G l y - L - A l a - G l y - G l y ) merism or cycloisomensm i n c y c l i c peptides. mined the s t r u c t u r e s of both peptides (13).
to prove s t r u c t u r a l
iso-
Several years ago we deterF r e i d i n g e r and Veber (14)
96
5CLY 'fCO 6CLY
L-*U 3L-AL* GLY5^7T)2GLY GLY6 1GLY
X GLY1 gGLY GLY23(^(¡^ 5GLY 4 U-ALA L-4U Fig. 6. Retroenantiomer from enantiomer for c(2-D-Ala-4-C.ly).
0* «y 0 «MO
Fig. 7. Least-squares fit for c(2-D-Ala-4-Gly) and R.E.
L-Al» • Glv OA*« MU
Fig. 8. L.S. fit for c(L-Ala-L-AIa-Gly Gly-L-AlaGly ) and R.E.
Fig. 9. L.S. fit for (Mol. A c(Gly-D-Leu-L-Leu-Gly-D-LeuL-Leu) and R.E.
CkUu» L-Uu
97 TABLE 1
105 (
14 ß( I ) 1 1 3 1 -35
173
35 (
31
-53
-131 (
145
*,) -43 ( * . )
-14 (
145
-84 ( 4 )
>n) ß ( i ) - 6 6 (
31
0 UJ
*
3
)
*3) •4)
-105~ • 5 T ~ -168 -70
*
6
)
-16 ß ( I ) - 106
c(L Ala-L A l a Gly-Gly-L-AlaGly)
70
175 66
A
R.E
c(2 D Ala 4 Gly)
)
5
-175" (
70~
139
- 1 0 1 ( -e6)
A
-106
(-*3)
81
-14 (-k,2) 95 ( - * _ )
39 138 117
33
ß ( I )
62
62
(-*.)
28"
1P3) 84 U )
119 ( - < U 6 )
40 78
-17 (
53
)106 (
122
-113
CH2C12 washing
salt of the
out) and of m e t h y l a m i d e
of the products with MeNHg were
in
after
RCONHMe
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
168
CH R \ c=o
N
H
i R' - C
R
R-
! 1
R I C0-NHCH-C00H (4)
R1CO-NHCH-C R2C0-NHCH-C
/
1«
R
(3)
1
2 CO-NHCH-COOH R^
(2)
a :
R
R
= alkoxy;
R
= R
b:
R2
= al kyl /I ;
R3
=
c :
alkoxy;
obtained
rate
mole
one
drides. one m o l e of
salt
present
2)
in
R2
obtained
of a m i d e
and
in the
no
zolones acid
Down
were
mixed
(Id)
in C h ^ C ^
Z-Gly-Leu-OH.
in the
are
amount
f
R4
gene-
anhy-
and w h i c h
oxazolones.
of t h e to
and which
salt
iPr
iPr
= alkyl ; R 3
The of
generate amount
anhydride
1% of a n h y d r i d e
(9),
mixed
with
2-pheny1 - 5(4H) -
(l e ) , 4 - i s o p r o p y 1 - 5 ( 4 H— ) - o x a z o l o n e ,—•
and with
products
are
=
=
detected.
2-Benzyloxy-5(4H)-oxazolone oxazolone
of
in < 5 0 % y i e l d
salt
R
by w e i g h t
one mole
is a m e a s u r e
product. be
yield
and
Products
can
Ph;
>>50%
of a m i d e
generated
oxazolone
R4
,2 R = alkyl
Products
= P h C h 2 0 ; R3
R
solution
was
with The
1 equiv. nature
established
and
other
of t h e
of t h e using
oxa-
parent
neutral 60-MHz
NMR
spectroscopy.
Results 1)
Based
on a n a l y s i s
of E DC w i t h
of
pure
Z-Gly-Leu-OH,
and
crude
products,
Z-Leu-Gly-OH,
the
For-Val-OH
reaction and
169
For-Phe-OH gave
exclusively
the a n h y d r i d e
tides the
gave
with
proof
itely
did
in 88% y i e l d .
D C C are is
less
not
believed
give
(3d) / v
Z-Gly-Leu-OH, neutral
anhydride
ively (~2 b ) .
give
The
the
added
valine
was
component
when
2-alkyl-oxazolone
(2e).
Z-Gly-Leu-OH, derived
from
oxazolones reaction In the
However,
a mixture the
(£)
with
the
presence
into
a single
NMR
with
(le) w a s le w a s
(2d)
present
added
added
Bz-Leu-OH
substrate
was
present.
and
For-Phe-OH
6 = 5.7
complete
ppm
two
acids
did
the
chan-
exhibit
ring-protons.
for 4-iso p r o p y l - 5 ( 4 H J - o x a z o l o n e . (lb)
for
for
(6)
(7) w h i c h x
incomplete
resembles
no
acids.
but
Tfa-amino
or
Similarly, showed
was
oxazolone
the
exclus-
to
to
conversion
from
in
or
2-al k y l - o x a z o l o n e
4-a 1 k y l - 5 ( 2 H ) - o x a z o l o n e s —
kyl-5(4H)-oxazolones
give
f r o m the a c i d No r e a c t i o n
Et,N, 4 - a 1kyl-5(4H)-oxazolones
at
to
consisted
The
new
DCC.
the
For-Val-OH
signal
but
defin-
le a n d
parent
of
achiral
of
leucyl
from
when
acids
to B z - L e u - O H
of t h e 2 - a l k y l - o x a z o l o n e (5b) d e r i v e d Z - V a l - O H h a d b e e n p r o d u c e d f r o m Id. •—
Bz-Val-OH
pep-
products,
Z-Val-OH
Id was ^ f
of
same
reaction
with
neutral
o f the
formylamino
after
But w h e n
Z-Gly-Pro-OH
Reactions
The
reacts
side-chain
fraction.
occurred
ged
(lj)
(9). no
to
convincing.
2-Alkoxy-oxazolone ( Z - V a l ) oC 0
the o x a z o l o n e ;
4-sec-butyl-5(4H)-oxazolone
not
behave
2,4-Dial-
similarly.
"pseudo-oxazolones"
(8)
This derived
(10).
R
,'JA
N // H-C
C=0
(6)
Et3N C=0
(7)
C=0
(8)
170 Conclusion We
conclude
or
protected
that
H o w e v e r , we (3c) i—'
2b
into
of
formation
4d a n d
l_f a n d
exist
intermediate
is p o s t u l a t e d
mation
anhydrides
do n o t
postulate
as t r a n s i e n t
Id a n d (3f)
symmetrical
peptides
the
unsymmetrical
to a c c o u n t
intermediate
into
for
to a c c o u n t
an e q u i l i b r i u m
cyclizes
simultaneous ively. occurs
expulsion
In the for
to
the of
presence
(3) w h e n
R1
the
free
acid
of t e r t i a r y = R2
= OtBu
of
anhydride the
of
transfor-
l_f, 2 f ,
4f
w h e n a n h y d r i d e (3) a l k y l , the m o l e c u l e
2-al k y l - 5 ( - o x a z o l o n e
the
anhydride
conversion
for
mixture
acids
compounds.
Moreover,
a n d 5f. We p r o p o s e the f o l l o w i n g t h e s i s : '— 1 2 is f o r m e d a n d o n e or b o t h of R and R are immediately
of a c y l a m i n o
isolable
5b r e s p e c t i v e l y .
as
2f
of
(3b)
as
(4a) —
amines,
(5b)
with
or
(4b)
respect-
the
same
reaction
r~>
(11).
References
1.
Schüssler,
H.,
Zahn,
H.:
2.
Chen, F . M . F . , K u r o d a , K., B e n o i t o n , 9 2 9 (1 9 7 8 ) ; 232 (1 9 7 9 ) . I.Z., Nowak,
Chem.
Ber.
3.
Siemion,
4.
Chen, F.M.F., 232 ( 1 9 7 9 ) .
5.
Arendt, A., Kolodziejczyk , A.M.: 3868 (1978).
Kuroda,
E.: A n n .
K. : R o c z .
9J5, 1 076-1 080 N.L.:
Chem.
K., B e n o i t o n ,
Synthesis, 1 479-1 4 8 2
Tetrahedron
Schnabel,
7.
J o n e s , J . H . : in The P e p t i d e s : A n a l y s i s , S y n t h e s i s , V o l . 1. Gross, E., M e i e n h o f e r , J., eds. Academic N e w Y o r k , 1 979 , p. 71 .
8.
Meienhofer,
9.
Benoiton, (1981 ) .
10.
W e y g a n d , F., Prox, A., S c h m i d h a m m e r , C h e m . Int. Edn. 2, 1 8 3 - 1 8 8 ( 1 9 6 3 ) .
11.
Benoiton, 1225-1227
J.:
Ibid., Chen,
N.L., Chen, (1981).
p.
([88, 2 3 8 - 2 4 9
Lett.,
928(1 9 6 0 ) .
Synthesis,
6.
N.L.,
Chem.
34,
N.L.:
( 1 962).
2303867-
( 1 9 6 5 ). Biology. Press,
306.
F.M.F.:
F.M.F.:
Can.
J.
J.
Chem. L.,
Chem.
59^,
384-389
König, W.:
Soc.
Chem.
Angew.
Commun.,
FIRST RESULTS WITH NEW REAGENTS FOR PEPTIDE COUPLING
Peter Henklein, Klaus Forner, Hartmut Iliedrich Akademie der Wissenschaften der DDR, Institut für Wirkstoffforschung, DDR-1136 Berlin Peteris Ya. Romanovski Institute of Organic Synthesis, Academy of Sciences of Latvian SSR, Riga, USSR
Introduction In search of condensation reagents to be used alternatively to carbodiimides and without such drawbacks as allergenic properties and difficultly removable byproducts, we did some experiments with the Saccharin-derivative 3-chloro-1,2-benzoisothiazole 1,1-dioxide (BID-C1), a sulfimide acid chloride. Recently Inomata (1) reported the use of 3-(succinimidoxy)and 3-(5-nitro-2-pyridon-1-yl)-1,2-benzoisothiazole-1,1-dioxide for the synthesis of esters and peptides. The results of our studies on acylated derivatives of pentafluorophenol (2), the successful application of HOPfp (3) and HONB (4) in peptide chemistry and the limited stability of reagents like Cl3C-COOCgF5
(2,5) prompted us to prepare
3-(pentafluorophenyloxy)-1,2-benzoisothiazole
1,1-dioxide
(BID-OPfp) and 3-(5-norbornen-2,3-dicarboximidoxy)-BID
(BID-
ONB) and to use them for synthesis of peptides, see formula.
Results 1) Preparation of BID-OPfp and BID-ONB. Mixing of BID-C1 and HOPfp or HONB in acetonitrile and
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
172
dropwise addition of triethylamine at 0° C according to (1) yields BID-OPfp (87 %) and BID-ONB (89 %), respectively, as crystalline compounds.
|-0H S'N
•PC15 or S0CI2
rCl ^CX^S'
0
>F
^ 0
* %
0
BlO-OPtp
a) • HOPfp / NEt3 b) »HONB / N Eti
0
yliapld:,79 87% .,81.c
0 0
-S'N '/ W 0 0
II 0
Boc-NH-CHR-COOH + HjN-R =
>
BID - O N B NET 3
( Boc-NH-CHR-CO-ONB I
Boc-NH-CHR-CO-NH-R'
2) Peptide coupling. The protected amino acid and N-methylmorpholine, dissolved in C F ^ C ^ , DMF or CH^CN, are mixed at 0° C with BID-OPfp or BID-ONB. After 15 min. the amino component is added. The reaction is complete within 60 min. BID-OH, HONB and HOPfp, can easily be removed from the peptide by washing the organic phase with NaHCO^-solution. 3) Racemization. The Izumiya-test (6) was used to check racemization. Peptide coupling with BID-ONB or BID-OPfp alone gave racemization of 17 % and 15 %, respectively. No racemization was detectable when 2 moles of HONB or HOPfp were added before activation. Thus, these reagents can be applied for fragment condensation.
173
Table
1 : C o u p l i n g of p r o t e c t e d a m i n o
Peptide obtained
Method
Z-Val-Gly-OEt
acids Yield %
m.p.
°C
+
BID-OPfp
83
163 - 1 6 5
+
BID-ONB
85
163 - 1 6 5
i s o l • Z-Val'- O N B
83
163 - 1 6 5
isol. Z-Ala-Gly-OEt
+
Boc-Phe-Val-OMe
+
80
163 - 1 6 5
BID-ONB
81
9 4 .-96
Z-Val -OPfp
87
117 - 1 1 9
BID-OPfp
83
90'- 9 2
Z-Pro-Ala-OH
BID-ONB
81
154 - 1 5 6
83
159 -161
82
-141
Z-Asp(OtBu)-PheNH
2 Boc-Tyr-Met-Gly-OEt
dt
°dto.
a l l p e p t i d e s g a v e o n e s p o t in 4) F r a g m e n t c o n d e n s a t i o n .
CO
BID-OPfp
Boc-Trp-Gly-ONbz
t.l.c.
Using BID-ONB we synthesized
following protected peptides in good yields, graphically of fragments
(t.l.c.)
and optically pure by
the
chromato-
condensation
(2 + 2 a n d 4 + 4) .
Table 2 : Peptides o b t a i n e d by fragment
condensation
Boc-Trp-Met-Asp(OtBu)-PheNH2
77 %
m.p.
179-81
°C
Z-Val-His-Pro-AlaOH
86 %
m.p.
131-35
°C
Boc-Pro-Phe-His-LeuONbz
88 % [a]p°= - 3 8 , 1 ° c=1 , D M F
Z-Sar-Arg(N0„)-Val-Tyr-Val-His-Pro-AlaOH
65 %
174
Conclusions - BID-ONB and BID-OPfp have been shown to be useful condensing reagents for the preparation of both activated esters of protected amino acids in situ and peptides. - The reaction conditions are mild and yields are high. - The condensing reagents are stable and crystalline compounds. - Exce® of HONB and HOPfp is necessary to avoid racemization during fragment condensation. - BID-C1, the basic compound for this activation method, can be obtained from versatile Saccharin. - Side products formed in the coupling reaction as Saccharin, HONB, HOPfp, can easily be removed.
References 1. Inomata, K., Kimoshita, H., Fukuda, H., Miyano, 0., Yamashiro, Y, Kotake, H.: Chemistry Letters 1979 , 12651268 and Ahmed, A., Fukuda, H., Inomata, K., Kotake, H.: Chemistry Letters 1980, 1161-1164 2.
Romanovski, P.Ya., Azmanis, A.A., Romanovska, I.K., Juchnovich, A.D., Chipens, G.I.: 4.Soviet.Sympos.Chem. of Proteine; and Peptides, Kiew 1977
3.
Kisfaludy, L., Low, H., Nyeki, C., Szirtes, T., Schön, J.: Liebigs Ann.Chem. 1973, 1421-1428
4.
Fujino, M., Kobayashi, S., Obayashi, M., Fukuda, T., Shinagawe, S., Nishimura, 0.: Chem. Pharm.Bull. 2_2, 1 8571863 (1974)
5.
Gubkov, A.T. and Schechvatova, G.V.: Zh.obsc.Chim. 40, 2146 (1978) Izumiya, N. and Muraoka, M.: J.Amer.Chem.Soc. 9J_, 23912394 (1969) .
6.
PEPTIDE SYNTHESES WITHOUT ISOLATION OP INTERMEDIATES USING BIPHASIC SOLVENT SYSTEMS
Rudolf Dolling and Klaus-Dieter Kaufmann Humboldt-University, Section Chemistry, and Institute of Drug Research, Academy of Science of GDR, Berlin
Introduction Rapid peptide syntheses in solution without isolation of intermediates require complete coupling and deblocking without side reactions, a highly reactive carboxyl component and an excess of reagents. Application of mixed anhydrides (1), pentafluorophenyl- (2), o-nitrophenyl- (3), N-hydroxysuccinimide- (4) and N-hydroxybenzotriazole esters (5,6) or carbodiimides (7) differ in the excess of carboxyl component and in the way of its removal after the coupling, whereas the deprotection of the N ^ B o c group has been carried out mostly with trifluoro acetic acid. We found, that coupling of active Boc-amino acid esters of N-hydroxy-5-norbornene-2,3-dicarboximide (HONB) (8) proceeds rapidly and without racemisation, if a two layer system of dichloroethane or ethyl acetate with aqueous sodium hydrogencarbonate solution had been used. The catalysis in the intermediate layer and the simultaneous extraction of the acidic, water soluble HONB are obviously responsible for the acceleration of the coupling. In a synthesis scheme, developed on the basis of this coupling conditions, the growing peptide is consequently hold within the organic phase.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
176
Methods Sufficiently
hydrophobic amino acid or peptide ester (or ami-
de) and 1 . 2 - 2 equivalents of the Boc-amino acid ONB-ester are dissolved in dichloroethane, overlayed with 1 M HaHCO^ solution and intensively strirred. Coupling is finished mostly within some minutes up to one hour as detected by tic. The phases are separated and the active ester excess is transformed into an appropriate acid soluble amide by stirring the organic phase for 20 minutes with two equivalents of a prim./ tert. diamine, e.g. 3-dimethylamino-propylamine, which can be removed by washing (2). The Boc-group of the N-protected peptide is removed directly in the dichloroethane phase by treatment with a strong organic acid, e.g. methane-sulphonic acid, in 0.5 M concentration within 10 to 20 minutes (9). The excess of the acid is neutralized by 1 M NaHCO^ and separated. The two layer system than will be completed for the next coupling step. Results and Discussion Examples (see table 1) were synthesized in a 5 - 10 mmol scale with a time of 4 hours for one cycle. and 2 yielded the correct final products using an excess of 1.5 equivalents of the active esters without further purification. The example 2. shows, that tyrosin needn't any protection of the hydroxyl function. A partial tyrosin 0-acylation takes place forming depsipeptides, which however are cleaved together with the active ester excess in the acid soluble Boc-amino acid amides and the desired tyrosin peptides with free hydroxyl group by treatment with the prim./tert. diamine. The formation of the O-acyl-tyrosin derivative was observed for the coupling of Z-Gly-ONB and H-Tyr-OBzl already after some minutes before a complete N-acylation took place. The depsipeptide Z-GlyTyr(Z-Gly)-0Bzl, which was prepared with more excess of Z-Gly-ONB and by means of a tri-
177
ethylamine catalysis, could be cleaved quantitatively to the dipeptide with free hydroxyl group in dichloroethane by means of 4 equivalents 3-dimethylamino-propylamine within 30 min. Table 1 yield
m.p. OC
Boc-Tyr(Bzl)GlyLeu-OMe
83
55-•58
2
Z-GlyPhePheTyr(Bzl)-OMe
71
161-•164
-9.0°(DMF)
2
Z-GlyPhePheTyr-OMe
70
176-•178
-8.0°(DMP) x )
176 (10)
-13.5° (10) -17.0°(MeOH)
4
Z-Tyr(Bz1)GlyGlyPheLeu-OBzl 75
4 a H-TyrGlyGlyPheLeu-OH
95
151-•153 157-•159 160 (11)
578
-23.0°(DMP) -23.4°
(12)
x ) the rotation of the peptide differs from the literature value, but could be confirmed with a peptide prepared by a 2 + 2 fragment condensation For the synthesis of Leu-enkephaline ^a, a totally benzyltype protected precursor 4, w a s
chosen, to cleave all pro-
tection groups simultaneously. The leucin benzyl ester
and all
peptide intermediates were soluble in dichloroethane. N-(2-aminoethyl)-morpholine has been used to form the amides of the Boc-amino acids. Only the amide Z-Tyr(Bzl)HH(CH 2 ) 2 I^jD was difficult to extract with aqueous acids (13), so that traces of this compound had to be separated from protected Leu-enkephaline by gel filtration. This shows that amino acid active esters with an extreme hydrophobicity should be avoided. The final hydrogenation yielded the free Leu-enkephalin of high purity (70%).
The examples show
that this method permits to prepare pure
peptides in 70 - 80% yield. Prerequisites for a successful application are a sufficient hydrophobic character of the amino component to avoid its partition between the organic and aqueous phase, an appropriate solubility of the peptides
178
in the organic phase and a sufficiently hydrophilic behaviour of the Boc-amino acid amides for the extraction with aqueous acids. These properties can be attained mostly by selection of terminal and side chain protecting groups. After an appropriate adoption of this strategy it should be possible, to prepare peptides with a chain length up to about ten amino acids.
References 1.
Beyermann, H.C., DeLeer, E.W.B., Floor, J.: Rec.Trav. Chim.Pays-Bas ¿2, 481 (1973).
2.
Kisfaludy, L., Schön, I., Szirtes, T., Nyeki, 0., Löw.M.: Tetrahedron Letters 1785 (1974). Bodanszky, M., Punk, K.W., Pink, M.L.: J.Org.Chem. ¿8, 3565 (1973).
3. 4.
Schneider, C.H., Wirtz, W. : Helv.Chim.Acta
5.
Bratby, D.N., Coyle, S., Greggon, R.P., Hardy. C.W., Young, Q.T. : J.Chem.Soc.,Perkin I, 1901 (1979). Rolli, H., Blaser, K., Pfeuti, C., Schneider, C.H.: Int.J.Peptide Prot.Res. 399 (1980).
6. 7. 8.
1062 (1972).
Nozaki, S., Kimura, A., Muramatsu, I.: Chemistry Letters 1057 (1977). Fujino, M., Kobayashi, S., Fukuda, T., Shinagawa, S., Nishimura, 0.: Chem.Pharm.Bull. (Japan) 22, 1857 (1974).
9.
Yajima, H., Ogawa. H., Fujino, M., Funakoshi, S.: Chem. Pharm.Bull.(Japan) 2£, 740 (1977). 10. Katsoyannis, P.G., Ginos, G., Cosmatos, A., Schwartz, G.s J.Amer.Chem.Soc. 6427 (1973). 11. üeki, M., Inazu, T., Ikeda, S.: Bull.Chem.Soc.(Japan) 52, 2424 (1979). 12. Bower, J.D., Guest, K.P., Morgan, B.A.: J.Chem.Soc., Perkin I, 2488 (1976). 13. Schneider, C.H., Rolli, H., Blaser, K., Int.J.Peptide Prot. Res. 15,411 (1980).
SOME APPLICATIONS OF THE CURTIUS REARRANGEMENT Panayiota Moutevelis-Minakakis and Iphigenia Photaki University of Athens, Laboratory of Organic Chemistry 13A Navarinou str., Athens 144, Greece
As is known N-protected amino-acid azides are subject to the Curtius rearrangement and the resulting isocyanates can react with alcohols to give urethane derivatives. In 1936 Bergmann and Zervas (1) applied the following reactions in the so-called carbobenzoxy stepwise degradation method for the elucidation of the primary structure of peptides: BzNHCHCOOR1 I
• BzNHCHCONHNH,
R
I
R
• BzNHCHN=C=0
¿
R710H DZ,J W
H0N
^
- " . BzNHCHNHZ
¿
° > BzNHCHCON, I
J
R H
?/Pd
H=C1
—
• BzNHCHNH„ ,HC1
¿
•
• BzNH 2 + RCHO + NH 4 C1 Characterization of the liberated aldheyde gave information on the amino-acid originally present. Recently, the same series of reactions have been used for the synthesis of gem-diamino compounds incorporated into synthetical retro-isomers of biologically active peptides (2). Starting from the same L-amino-acid and applying the Curtius rearrangement followed by the reaction of the isocyanates with appropriate alcohols, we have been able to prepare optically pure enantiomers, R and S, of N,N'-substituted gem-diamines (assuming that no inversion or partial racemization occurs at the chiral centre which migrates from C to N).
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
180
CONHNH_ i.
1
ZNHCH t CH2CH (CH3) 2
1. Bu ONO,H 2
NHCOOEt
A
1
" „ .i. htUH
ZNHCH i CH2CH (CH3)
S-Enantianer (a)
i25 [cx]jr +12.4°(c 0.96,DMF) m.p. 123-125°C C0NHNHo
1.Bu ONO,H
'
2
i i . EtOCONHCH ch2ch(ch3)2
3
-
NHZ
A
'
EtOCONHCH
R-Enantianer (a 1 )
ch2ch(ch3)2
B z l 0 H
l25 [a]j: -12.4°(c 1 .01 ,DMF) m.p. 123-125°C I n an a n a l o g o u s way t h e p a i r s o f
enantiomers
have a l s o been s y n t h e s i z e d .
interchange of
This
tached at the asymmetrically atom o f
substituted
the parent amino-acid,
who has c o n v e r t e d
the p r i n c i p l e
tetrahedral
formation of
first
table
two g r o u p s
reac-
a racemate,
a p p l i e d by F i s c h e r
(+)-isopropylmalonamidic
at-
a-carbon
using analogous s e r i e s of
t i o n s and w i t h o u t t h e i n t e r m e d i a t e a n o t h e r example o f
shown i n t h e
acid to i t s
is (3)
(-)-en-
antiomer. Table Starting
Material
Alcohol
Used
Final
Product
¡2
[ a ] p 5 +17.1 ° (c 1 .05,DMF)m.p.143-145°C EtOCO-L-Ala-NHNH_
BzlOH
R-Enantiomer
(b')
[ a ] p 5 -16.0°(c 0.9,DMF)m.p. 143-146°C Z-L-Leu-NHNH„
Bzl(OMe)OH
Z(OMe)-L-Leu-NHNH0
BzlOH
R-Enantiomer
(c1)
- 1 . 8 ° ( c 0.9,DMF) m.p.138-140°C S-Enantiomer [a]n°
+1-75°(£
(c)
0.95,DMF) m.p. 138-140°C
181
Primary alcohols as used above give the best results when reacting with the isocyanates. However, starting from Boc-^-AlaNHNH2 and using benzyl alcohol we failed to obtain the N,N'~ -disubstituted S-enantiomer. This can be due to the known decomposition of the Boc group under heating (4). We have obtained the known R-enantiomer (2) from Z-L-Ala-NHNH2 only at the presence of anhydrous Et^N as catalyst (5). In the absence of Et^N, depending on the conditions, we have isolated two other products (III) or (VI). The formation of the former can be explained by the following reactions: ZNHCHN=C=0
(I)
+
Hn0
ZNHCHNH2 (II) + C0 2 ,
ch3
ZNHCHNHCONHCHNHZ (III)
(I) + (II)
CH-
CH_
Since after the formation of the azide the mixture was carefully dried, the necessary water for the above reaction could be derived from the known dehydration of t-BuOH in the presence of the isocyanate (6). The other compound (VI) was isolated in the presence of an agueous acid, i.e. either when the azide was insufficiently washed with aq.KHCO^, or when I,1-bis(trifluoroacetoxy)iodobenzene (PIT) (7a) was used in AcCN-H 2 0 for the degradation of Z-L-Ala-NH2 to a gem-diamine. This reaction is considered also to occur via an isocyanate with the simultaneous liberation of trifluoroacetic acid. We suggest the following mechanism for the formation of compound (VI): ZNHCHN=C=0
I
CH_,
(IV)
H
2°
+
H_0 £
f+) ZNHCHNH UN 3 (la) + (C02)
+
• ZNHCHOH + (H ) CH,
ZNHaf^ (IV) + (NH3)
CH, ZNH2 (V) + CH 3 CH=0
182
(IV) + (V)
Compound
H + + ZNHCHNHZ i CH^
• ZNHCliSli-Z i ^ CH^
(VI)*
(VI) was also prepared from Z-L-Ala-NHNH^ by the
Curtius rearrangement etc or from Z-L-Ala-NH2
and PIT in an-
hydrous DMF by the addition of benzyl alcohol.
H PIT „ „ . „ , „ 2° A na-n n • ZNHCHN=C=€> + (C,H I+2CF 7 C00H)—— (IV) etc ACUN H2U ^ b b H PIT
DMF
"
+
"
"
BzlOH
•(VI)
, , (VI)
References 1.
Bergmann, M., Zervas, L.: J. Biol. Chem. 113, 341-357 (1 936) .
2.
Chorev, M., Willson, C.G., Goodman, M.: J. Amer.Chem. Soc. 99, 8075-8076 (1977).
3.
Fischer, E., Brauns, F.: Ber. _47, 31 81-31 93 (1 91 4).
4.
Felix, A.M., Heimer, E.P., Lambros, T.L., Tzougraki, C., Meienhofer, J.: J. Org. Chem. £3, 4194-4196 (1978).
5.
Baker, J.W., Holdsworth, J.B.: J. Chem. Soc. 713-726 (1947).
6.
Baumgarten, H.E., Smith, H.L., Staklis, A.: J. Org. Chem. 40, 3554-3561 (1975).
7.
(a) Radhakrishna, A.S., Parham, M.E., Riggs, R.M., Loudon, G.M.: J. Org. Chem. _44, 1 746-1 747 (1 979); (b) Loudon, G.M., Almond, M.R., Jacob, J.N.: J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 103, 45084515 (1981).
*After having developed the above mechanism, we noticed that the same scheme up to the formation of compound (V) was proposed, but rejected, by Loudon et al. (7b) for the hydrolysis of N(1-aminoalkyl)amides in acidic solutions.
A NEW METHOD FOR THE SELECTIVE SYNTHESIS OF UNSYMMETRICAL CYSTINE PEPTIDES
Erich Wünsch, Sigrun Romani and Luis Moroder Max-Planck-Institut für Biochemie, Abteilung Peptidchemie, 8033 Martinsried/München, FRG.
Introduction The tryptic digest of the cyanogen bromide fragment 10-118 of mouse nerve growth factor leads to an acid-insoluble fraction, from which an unsymmetrical cystine-peptide corresponding to the sequence portions 10-25 and 75-88 can be isolated; on molar basis this fragment exhibits a 100 fold activity if compared with the intact nerve growth factor (1). For a successfull synthesis of this unsymmetric cystine-peptide a selective disulfide pairing has to be achieved. For this purpose the procedures based on sulfenyl halides (2-4) cannot be applied because of the presence of tryptophan residues in both peptide chains with consequent well known side reaction to thio-indole derivatives.
Results The use of
azodicarboxylic acid derivatives for oxidation
of cysteine peptides (5) has been extended by us to the selective synthesis of unsymmetrical cystine peptides (6) as following: O O R1 - S -i N - CO,Bu' R,- SH » But O "- C - N "= N -t C - OBu »• | H - N - C02BU'
* ~ „2 -u
O O r' - S - S - R2 » Bu1 - O - C - NH - NH - C - OBu1
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
•
184
The sulfenohydrazide derivatives of cysteine peptides are readily isolated as stable and analytically well characterized sulphur-activated intermediates, which in turn react smoothly with the second cysteine-component to produce in optimal conditions exclusively the unsymmetrical cystine-peptide (6,7). A careful
screening of the reaction conditions has clearly
indicated that the best results are obtained by dropwise addition of the cysteine-component to a larger excess of the sulfenohydrazide-component, e.g. at a molar ratio of 1:3, in solvents such as dimethylformamide, dimethylacetamide or N-methylpyrrolidone. By this procedure concomitant oxidation of the cysteine-component to the symmetrical disulfide and/or disproportionation of the unsymmetrical disulfide induced by the thiol-component to a "statistical energy-dependent distribution", is efficiently suppressed. In fact, as shown by the preparative example reported in Fig. 1, the unsymmetrical cystine-peptide was insolated in over 80 % yield as homogenous material (Fig. 2).
BOC-Ala-Cly-Cys(NCOjBut-NHCOjBul) -OH • BOC-Thr( Bul)-Ala-Cys-Gly-CIn-Lys( BOC)-Ser( Bu')-Pro-OBu1 (3:1)
i
BOC-Ala-Gly-Cys-OH 1 t Bu )-P tro-OBu BOC-Thr(But)-Ala- Cys-Gly-Cln-Lys(BOC)-Ser( SH-content of the reaction mixture after 24 hrs hplc : 0% Ellmann's test : 0 % Yield of isolated unsymmetrical disulfide : 84 % mp. 1S3-155°C; (a) P0 = -67,7°, |a]^6^-80,8o (c = 0. 5,methanol); CggH11 ^JO^SJ- 1. 5 HjO ( 1533. 96). calcd. : C 51.68. H 7.75, N 11.87, S 4.18, found: C 51.87, H 7.87, N 11.24, S 4.23; amino acid analysis (6N HCI, 24h, 110°C) : Thr 1.04 (1), Ser 1. 02 (1), Clu t .04 (1), Pro 1. 05 {1), Cly 1. 99 ( 2), Ala 1.99 (2), Cys2 0. 94 (1), Lys 0.92 (1) ; peptide content (calcd. for Mr 1533.96) : 96 %. Fig. 1
185
Chromatographic
tests of purity of
Boc-Ala-Gly-Cys -OH
Boc-Thr(Bu*)-Ala-Cys-Gly-Gln-Lys(Boc)-Ser(But)-Pro-OBut
hpttc onprecoated silica gel-60 hplc :^Bondapak CI8 (0,4x30cm) lates (Merck AC) etuent:0,1 M ammonium acetateIpH 6,8)/ p solvent system: 1-butanol/ acetonitrit 52:48(v/v), a c en tic acid/water/pyridine i isocratic elution at a f low rate of l,5m(/ 6m0 : 6 24 :20 absorbance at 210nm
I
i a 12 16 20 2imin
Fig. 2
At molar ratios of the reaction components of 1:1 or higher a thiol induced disproportionation of the unsymmetrical disulfide was observed to occur as monitored by hplc and tic. To block in such cases the thiol-interchange at the maximum content of unsymmetrical cystine-peptide (for the examples discussed below after 24 h reaction time the concentration of symmetrical cystine-peptides was still negligible) and to concomitantly simplify the purification procedure thiol-trapping reagents on polymer matrix should be the most advisable. Among the various proposed SH-reagents N-alkylmaleimides are known to react rapidly and rather specifically with thiols. Thus, 3-maleimidopropionic acid was coupled via its N-hydroxysuccinimido ester (8) with amino-polyoxyethylene glycol (M
= 6000) to yield the water
soluble 3-maleimidopropionyl-amino-polyoxyethylene glycol (0.02 ^mol B-Ala/mg PEG). On the other side, the 3-maleimidopropionic acid active ester was also used to acylate L-leucyl - oxymethylpolystyrene [prepared according
186
to the method of Gisin (9) from Boc-Leu-OH cesium salt and chloromethylpolystyrene-co-1 % divinylbenzene resin (Merrifield polymer), followed by acidolytic removal of the Boc-group] to produce the insoluble 3-maleimido-propionyl-Lleucyl - oxymethylpolystyrene [0.51 mmol Leu/g resin; 6-Ala: Leu, 1:1 as determined by amino acid analysis of the acid hydrolysate; HCl/propionic acid; 1:1 (v/v), 130°C]. The usefulness of the cysteine-trapping procedure is illustrated in the two following examples: Example 1 S'-component:
BOC-Ala-Cly-Cys(NCC>2But-NHC02But)-OH
SH-component:
B O C - T h r ( But) - A 1 a - C y s - C l y - C l n - L y s ( BOC) -Ser( Bu*)-Pro-OBu1
S
component
•
SH
component
(1:1)
Mal-B-Ala-NH - ( PEC]
c o n j u g a t e of Mai B A l a - N H - [ P E C ) unsymmetrical
I SH-component
disulfide
S H - c o n t e n t of t h e r e a c t i o n m i x t u r e a f t e r 2« h r s hplc
: 37 °0
Ellmann's test
: 29 %
SH-content after treatment with M a i - A - A l a - N H - [ P E C ] hplc
:
0
Ellmann's test
:
0%
Y i e l d of i s o l a t e d u n s y m m e t r i c a l d i s u l f i d e
( 0 . 2 0 pniol m a l e i m i d e / m g
PEC}
: 53 »
A m i n o a c i d a n a l y s i s of S H - c o m p o n e n t / P E G c o n j u g a t e
:
37 ° S H
component
After treatment of the reaction mixture with an excess of 3-maleimidopropionyl-amino-PEG for 30 min
the unsymmetri-
cal cystine-peptide was isolated by precipitation with water followed by recrystallization from methanol-water in ca. 50 % yield [calculated taking into account the ca. 40 % unreacted cysteine-component;.the low yield is due to partial water solubility of the unsymmetrical cystine-peptide]. In the second example the reaction mixture was stirred with an excess of 3-maleimidopropionyl-L-leucyl-oxymethylpolystyrene. The capture of the thiol-component was monitored
187 Example 2
S* - component
:
5H- component
:
BOC-Ala-Cly-Cys(NCOJBU'-NHCOJBU1)-OH BOC-Thr( Bu^-Ala-Cys-Cly-Cln-Lyst BOC)-Ser{ Bul)-Pro-OBu1
S
- component
•
SH - c o m p o n e n t
(1:1)
Mal-ft-Ala-Leu-(g)
^
unsymmetrical
hplc
: 37 %
Ellmann's test
: 33
Ellmann's test
I ®
(0.51 ymol maleimide/mg
resin)
0 % 0 I disulfide:
95
I
A m i n o a c i d a n a l y s i s of S H - c o m p o n e n t / M a l - f t - A l a - L e u - ®
both by Ellman's
SH-component
2U h r s
SH-content after treatment with Mal-fi-Ala-Leu-
Yield of isolated unsymmetrical
/
disulfide
SH-content of the reaction m i x t u r e after
hplc
conjugate of Mal-G-Ala-
:
351 S H - c o m p o n e n t
test (10) and hplc [n-Bondapak C18
(0.4 x 30 cm); eluent: 0.1 M ammonium acetate (pH 6.8) / acetonitrile, 52 : 48 (v/v); isocratic elution at a flow rate of 1.5 ml/min, absorbance at 210 nm]. For the present example the reaction was found to proceed at a remarkable lower rate than with the PEG-bound reagent. A quantitative removal of the cysteine-peptide was achieved only after 12 h. The resin was then filtered off and the unsymmetrical cystine-peptide was isolated on addition of ether in nearly quantitative yield. In both examples the unsymmetrical disulfide compound exhibited analytical data identical to those reported above.
Conclusion The experimental models used to investigate the sulfenohydrazide method for the synthesis of unsymmetrical cystinepeptides clearly indicate its usefulness particularly if tryptophan is present in the peptide chain. No modification at the indole function was observed under the experimental conditions of this new procedure.
188
References 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Mercanti, D., Butler, R., Revoltella, R.: Biochim. Biophys. Acta 496^, 41 2 - 419 (1977). Kamber, B.: Helv. Chim. Acta 56^ 1 370 - 1381 (1974). Castell, J.V., Tun-Kyi, A.: Helv. Chim. Acta 62_, 2507 - 251 0 (1 979) . Matsueda, R., Kimura, T., Kaiser, E.T., Matsueda, G.R.: Chem. Lett. 737 - 740 (1981). Arold, H., Eule, M.: in Peptides 19 72, Proc. 12th Eur. Pept. Symp. Reinhardsbrunn Castle, GDR (H. Hanson and H.-D. Jakubke, eds) pp. 78 - 85, North Holland, Amsterdam.
6.
Wünsch, E., Romani, S.: Hoppe-Seyler's Z. Physiol. Chem. 363, 449 - 453 (1982).
7.
Romani, S., Göhring, W., Moroder, L., Wünsch, E.: in Proceedings of the 4th FRG-USSR Symposium on Chemistry of Peptides and Proteins, Tübingen, June 8 - 12, 1982, in press. Moroder, L., Nyfeler, R., Gemeiner, H., Kaibacher, H., Wünsch, E.: Biopolymers, in press. Gisin, B.F.: Helv. Chim. Acta 56, 1476 - 1482 (1973).
8. 9.
10. Ellman, G.L.: Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 82, 70 - 77 (1959).
A CONTROLLED SYNTHESIS OF CYCLIC UNSYMMETRICAL CYSTINE PEPTIEES BEARING TWO S-S BRIDGES IN THE RING.
Iphigenia Photaki, Miltiadis Kolovos, Ageliki StathakiFerderigos, and +Leonidas Zervas University of Athens, Laboratory of Organic Chemistry 13A Navarinou Str., Athens 144, Greece
Because of the importance in nature of cyclic peptides containing more than one S-S bridges, the problem of their synthesis has been intensively studied by several groups. Open-chain unsymmetrical cystine peptides are necessary intermediates for the synthesis of such cyclic multi-cystine peptides; they are known however to rearrange easily to the symmetrical ones (1) under conditions applied in peptide synthesis. Therefore, years ago (2) we expressed the opinion that an approach to a controlled synthesis of non-symmetrical "parallel" (3) cystine peptides with two or more S-S bridges would be facilitated if two peptide chains A and B containing cysteines bearing different and selectively removable S-protecting groups could be coupled through their amino-ends to a polyvalent N-protecting group G. I.
,NH-CHCO
/ \
-R
2
/ I \
CH2SR
1
NHCHCO
•
CH2SR
CH9SR1
| 2
NH-CHCO
2
A _R1
oxidation
CH0SR2
| 2
NHCHCO
and oxidation
A N D
B
/
/
V
\
.NHCHCO 1
CH2S
| 2
NHCHCO
NHCHCO
'
2
CH2SR
CH0SR2"
| 2
NHCHCO
etc
The establishment of the first S-S bridge would form a multimembered ring so that rearrangement of the cystine peptide chain could be prevented. An additional ring would be estab-
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
190
lished by the formation of the second S-S bridge. The next step would be the removal of the polyvalent N-protecting group G in such a way that neither the peptide bonds nor the S-S bridges would be affected. In the variation II of the above scheme the group G could be combined with two S-protected derivatives of cysteine which would form the first S-S bridge. The peptide chain could be propagated at both sides, and at a desirable length it could be supplied with new S-protected cysteine derivatives. II. NHCHCO / ç'
CH„SR 2
\
Cys(Trt)-Ala-0E)EM(4)
Cgl^S Na+
CH2OCO-Cys(Trt)Gly-OPac
^ ^
~
¿ ¿ ^ CH 2 OCO-Cys ( T r t ) -Ala-ODpn CH^O-Cys (Trt)-Gly
CH 2 OCO-Cys ( T r t ) -Ala-ODpm
O
(?)
CH 2 OCX>Cys-Gly-ODpm
2Cys(flan)-ODpn| m.a.
\
^
CH 2 OCO-Cys-Ala
Phenol"
CH 2 OCO-Cys-Gly
^ O C O - C y s - A l a - C y s (Aon) -ODpn k^®2C)CO-Cys-Gly-Cys(Aan)-ODpTi
CH 2 OCO-Cys-Gly-Cys-ODpm
-CH 2 OCO-Cys-Ala-Cys-QMe - CH 2 CXX)-Cys-Gly-Cys-OMe
Phenol
(12)
Scheme
(I)
(5)
MPOH
CH 2 OCO-Cys(Trt)-Gly-ODpn
CH 2 OCO-Cys-Ala-ODpn
'
C y s ( T r t ) -Ala-ODpn
^ ^ - C H 2 O C O - C y s (Trt)-Gly-OPac
(CgH5)2CN2
(2)
(g)
^ 1
'
DMF-AcOH
(^OCO-Cys-Gly-Cys
~
192 Compound
(7) is an unsymmetrically substituted cystine deriva-
tive of phthalyl alcohol containing the first S-S bridge in a ring. Elongation of the peptide chains from both of compound
(8) leads to compound
carboxy-ends
(10) bearing two S-S bridges.
All substances shown on the schemes having a number are moncmeric compounds and they have been characterized as optically and chemically pure. The removal of both the -ODpm groups with TFAphenol proceeded quantitatively at room temperature to give the monomeric peptide
(11). The Phthoc group being a protecting
group of the urethane type can be quantitatively removed by acidolysis. Treatment of the symmetrical cyclic compounds (13a-c) or
(14c) either with HBr/AcOH in the presence of anisol at rcon
temperature or with TFA-phenol at 70°C removed the phthoc group
0
X-Cys-Cys(Acm)-ODpm i X-Cys-Cys(Acm)-ODpm
CH 2 0C0-Cys-0R CH 2 0C0-Cys-0R
(13a_c)
a: R=Dpm b: R=Me c: R=H
a: X=Zb: X=Bocc: X , X = P h t h o c C Scheme
(II)
quantitatively, i.e. these reactions are comparable to the removal of the Z or the Boc group from open-chain cystine derivatives such as
(14a,b) or the cyclic peptide
(15) with one intra-
-chain S-S bridge. However, the removal of the same N-protectZ-Cys-Cys 1
1
(15)
X-Cys-Cys-ODpm i i X-Cys-Cys-ODpm a: X=Zb: X=Bocc: X, X = P h t h o c d Scheme
(III)
193 ing g r o u p s f r o m the c y c l i c s y m m e t r i c a l or n o n - s y m m e t r i c a l cystine peptides
(10),
(11),
(12) o r
(16a-c)
di-
r e s u l t e d in a m i x -
ture of p r o d u c t s . T h e s e f i n d i n g s s u g g e s t a n i n s t a b i l i t y of the r e s u l t i n g free s y m m e t r i c a l or n o n - s y m m e t r i c a l c y c l i c
peptides
b e a r i n g two S-S b r i d g e s . It h a s to be i n v e s t i g a t e d if this
in-
s t a b i l i t y is c o n n e c t e d w i t h the n u m b e r a n d the n a t u r e of the a m i n o - a c i d s b e t w e e n the two c y s t i n e m o i e t i e s ,
i.e. w i t h the
size of the r i n g a n d its p r i m a r y s t r u c t u r e , as it h a s s t a t e d for c y c l i c n o n - s y m m e t r i c a l p e p t i d e s w i t h o n e S-S bridge
been
intra-chain
(5).
References (a) Z e r v a s , L., B e n o i t o n , L., W e i s s , E., W i n i t z , M . , G r e e n s t e i n , J . P . : J. A m e r . C h e m . Soc. 81_, 1 729-1734 (1 959); (b) S a n g e r , F.: N a t u r e 171, 1 0 2 5 - 1 0 2 6 (1953); R y l e , A . P . , S a n g e r , F.: B i o c h e m . J. 60, 5 3 5 - 5 4 0 (1955); B e n e s h , R . E . , B e n e s c h , R.: J. A m e r . C h e m . Soc. 80, 1 6 6 6 - 1 6 6 9 (1958): K a m b e r , B.: H e l v . C h i m . A c t a 54, 3 9 8 - 4 2 2 (1971). Z e r v a s , L., P h o t a k i , I.: C h i m i a , 1_4, 375-376 C h e m . Soc. 84, 3 8 8 7 - 3 8 9 7 (1962).
(1 960); J.Amer.
W a d e , R., W i n i t z , M . , G r e e n s t e i n , J . P . : J. A m e r . C h e m . 78, 3 7 3 - 3 7 7 (1 956) .
Soc.
P h o t a k i , I., F e r d e r i g o s , A . , Z e r v a s , L.: in " P e p t i d e s : P r o c e e d i n g s of the T h i r t e e n t h E u r o p e a n S y m p o s i u m " , ed. Y. W o l m a n , W i l e y - I s r a e l U n i v e r s i t i e s P r e s s , N e w York-Jerusalem, 47-52 (1 975) . H a r d y , P . M . , R i d g e , B., R y d o n , H . N . , S e r r ä o , F . O . d o s S . P . : J. C h e m . Soc. (C) 1722-1731 (1971); L a r g e , D . G . , R y d o n , H. N., S c h o f i e l d , J . A . : J. C h e m . Soc. (C) 1 7 4 9 - 1 7 5 2 (1961); W e b e r , U., H a l t e r , P.: Z. p h y s i o l . C h e m . 355, 189-199 (1974) idem: i b i d . 2 0 0 - 2 0 4 .
SYNTHESIS 3-0-
OF
CYSTEINE
AND
CYST INCGNTA I N I N G
PEPTIDES
THROUGH
[n-benzyloxycarbonyl-s-acetahidomethyl-cysteinyl]-HYDROXY2-PHENYLINDENONE
Stoyan Higher
The
amide
Pedagogical
of
On
the
glycylcystine
cysteine of
the
uith
arise above
usual
at
such
isomerised (3).
of
2
ue
of
in
the
function
in
as
functions
uith
means
for
basic
reagents.
the
the
DCCI
difficulties
(2).
thiol And
the
is
the
for
the
reason the
the
quoted
respective
the
elimination
group
is
it
knoun
loosing
is
which
part
function
of
of
can
the
the
performed
can
their
difficulties
cysteine,
indandionyl
carboxylic
for
by
synthesis the
through because
of
respiratory
peptides
experimental
possible
of
(l).Uith
its
compounds
not
hydrobromide
be
that easily
biological ue
chose
removed
amides.
The
N-benzyloxy-
N-butyloxycarbonyl-S-acetamidomethyl-cysteine
uith
Y-Cys(Acm)-OH
on
of
mitochondria
well
eliminate
the
JL a n d
realized
2-amino-2-phenyl-
2-amino-2-ary1-1,3-indandiones
group
changes
activation
is
strong
To
diamide
considerable
which
Acm-protective
carbonyl-
as
mentioned
conditions
function
with
anticoagulating
effect
liver
protective
help
be
without
rat
amides
derivatives
the
an
the
a stimulatory
there the
has
Bulgaria
hand
cystine
Getting
Shoumeri,
2-amino-2-(4-methoxyphenyl)-1,3-indandione
isolated
method
9700
with
chain
in
Sofroniev
other
has
the
Institute,
(HjNPID)
(H2NAID)
of
Nedyalko
N-benzyloxycarbonyl-glycine
1,3-indandione blood.
Minchev,
+
3-hydroxy-2-phenylindenone
H0-
= 0
DCCI
Y= Z
according
Y - C y s ( A cm) - 0 -
(1);
Boc
(2)
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
(4,5):
=0
196 Esters
and
results ethyl
2 are
shou
ester
producing
that of
the
yellou-orange these
glycine
tuo
82.4 % the
peptides
f o r _5,
rest
of
aminolysis till
6a.
the
less
is
same
basic
more
constants
than
uith
is
by
are
and
7_a
X =
H
7b
X = DCHj
es t e r
deblocking
of
out of
by the
HgCl2
constants (7), the is
and
are
fact,
activated
ester
DCCI 7a
at
and
react
The and
runs
the
interaction
2-amiho-2-(4-methoxy-
uith
activated
X =
OCHj
o f _3 a n d g l u t am i c
follouing acid,
in
all
Acm-group as
from
(6).
In
the
from
the
the
first
accordance
uith
resulting of
hydrobromide
a m i d e s _8 a n d
good
thiol
compound
the
is
of
ue
Acm-
carried
oxidation
(T-glutathione,uhose published
compound is
12
case,after is
group
uith compound
groups.
the
result
same
e s t e r _1»
aminolysis resulting
functional
groups,the
deblocking
of
6b.Though
9
the
of
the
method -
(H2NAID)
the
5.
f o r _4 a n d
Successfully
H
uell
that
%
results,
X -
a m i d e _8 t h e
successful the
(j5) .
thiol
in
from
87.8
JB
according
released
of
obtained:
protected
g l u t a t h i o n e _ll,as
alanylglycine,
(H2NPID)
of
| p - g l u t a t h i o n e _10, The
9
decarboxylation
IT-activated
of
the
respectively
published
obtained
HjNPID 7_b a l s o
8
yields
the
coincide
and
After
uith
2-amino-2-phenyl-
amides
ester
by
Boc-Cys(Acm)-A1a-Gly-0Et
phenyl)-1,3-indandione the
ethyl
aminolysis
achieved
2-glycylamino-2-pheny1-1,3-indandione
compound
Z-Cys(Acm)-Gly-OH
undergo
the
obtained
o f _1 u i t h
The
A and
are
uhich
compounds.The
Z - C y s ( A c m ) - G l y - D E t _3,
Z-Cys(A cm)-A1a-Gly-0Et last
compounds a n d by
peptides
crystal
of
also
benzyloxycarbony1-cys tine
is
results
13a.
great
importance
obtained (5),
For from
after
the
its
197
Table Yield,
1*1. P . ,
Compound
tu
%
°C 1
Z - C y s ( A cm)-Gft"
64.2
159-160
M
D
141-143
B o c - C y s(A c m ) - O A
57 .8
3
142-143
Z-Cys(Acm)-Gly-0Et
74.4
6
Z-Cys(Acm)-Gly-NHPID
a 108-110
70.0
b
72.1
108-109
8
Z-Cys(Acm)-NHPID
79.8
amorph.
amo rph.
Z-Cys(Acm)-l\IHAID
85.7
-33.1
10
72.3
amorph.
Z-Glu-OM e
-26.3
Hbr.H-Cys(Acm)-NHAID
-18.4
13
(Z-Cys-NHPID)2
88.6
amorph.
a 213-215"" 77.6
215-216""
79.6
(Z-Gly-Cys-NHAID)2
148-15
0"**60.7
EtOAc)
+41.9
, 21
(Me) 2 ^ 0 )
+42.6 (1,
14
, 21
-
(1, b
, 19
EtOAc)
(1, 11
, 20
EtOAc)
(l,
C y s ( A c m ) - G l y - 0 Et
, 18
EtOAc)
(1, 9
, 24
EtOAc)
-14.2 (l,
, 18
EtOAc)
-13.6 (1,
, 20
EtOAc)
-26.8 (1,
, 27
EtOAc)
-19.8 (l,
, 21
(Ne)2C0)
-58.4
, 20
(1, DCIF) *A e
3-hydroxy-2-phenylindenone
""according """according
to (2) to (l)
m.p.
residue
215-216°C
m. p.- 1 5 0 - 1 5 1
C
^
solvent/
-27.9 (l,
2
.
/c,
198 aminolysis
uith
2 - a m i n o - 2 - p h eriy 1 - 1 , 3 - i n d an d i o n e 1 3 b .
compound
has
DCCI
(2).
method
been The
h y d r o b r o m i d e _12. groups
and
obtained
In
flcm-group this
interaction
characteristics
uith
already As
described
a result
suggested as
uell
of
for
as
is
in
for
very
1_4 i s
exactly
peptides
easily ester
The
uay
-
by
removed of
of
the
from
the
the
thiol
benzyloxy-
obtained,
uhich,
identical
uith
experiments of
another
oxidation
activated
synthesis
their
in
after
publications
these the
is
case,
c a r b o n y l - g l y c i n e, c o m p o u n d its
before
according
the
to
compound,
(l). a convenient
amides uith
of
method
cystine
and
is cysteine,
2-amino-2-ary1-1,3-indan-
diones. Some
of
the
compounds
most
are
characteristic
given
in
a
data
for
the
neu
obtained
table.
R e f e r en c es 1.
Minchev, G.B.:
S.,
Pol.
Sofroniev,
J.
Chem.
2.
Aleksiev,
B. , M i n c e v ,
3.
Aren,
Lencbergs,
kim.
A., ser.
1980
(6),
4.
I»!incev,
S. : Compt.
5.
Mincev,
S.,
54,
443
Aleksiev,
B.V.,
Kupryszeuski,
press).
S.: I.:
3.
pract.
Chem.
L atv,
PSR
Acad.
bulg.
316,
Zinat.
140
Acad.
(1974).
Vestis,
677. rend.
Derdouska,
Sci.
I.,
Kupryszeuski,
E.:
J.
32»
623
G. : P o l .
(1979). J.
Chem.
(1980).
6.
Hermann,
7.
Pastuszak, (1980).
N.V.,
(in
P.,
Schreier,
J.3.,
Chimiak,
A.:
pract. 3.
Chem.
pract.
316,
Chem.
719
322,
(1974). 495
METHOD OF CYCLIZATION OF CARBA ANALOGUES OF OXYTOCIN
Milan Krojidlo and Martin Flegel L6Siva - Pharmaceuticals, Laboratory of Peptides 143 10 Prague Czechoslovakia Michal Lebl Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia
Introduction Recently carba analogues of oxytocin found use in both veterinary and human medicine. ^2-0-Methyltyrosine^]deamino-1-carba-oxytocin (CARBETOCIN) has been introduced into veterinary therapy as oxytocicum with protracted activity and [j2-p- e thyl phenyl a lanine^j deamino-6-carba-oxytocin
(NACARTOCIN)
is being clinically tested as salureticum. The purpose of the present study is to find an easy method of cyclization without significant side reactions which would enable to prepare even large quantities of analogues of neurohypophyseal hormones.
Results The method is exemplified by the following procedure: The solution of -NHg
Nps-Tyr(Me)-Ile—Gln-Asn-Cys(C^H^COOH)—Pro-Leu—Gly-
(17.^ g; pure by chromatography) was treated with 50 ml
of 2M-HC1 in ether. After 15 min standing at room temperature the hydrochloride of the octapeptide amide was precipitated with ether, dried and dissolved in the mixture of DMFA (2^0 ml) and dioxane (150 ml). The cooled (0°C) solution was
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
200
stirred with DCCI (23.1 g) and 1-hydroxybenzotriazole (21 g) for 2 h at 20 C. The solution, was filtered and poured drop by drop into the stirred mixture of methanol (4 000 ml) and triethylamine (35 ml). After 3 h at room temperature the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness; the residue was dissolved in 50$ aqueous acetic acid and purified on Sephadex G-15 column (4 000 ml) eluted with the same solvent. The crude product obtained by freeze drying (9.3 g) was further purified on Separon SI-C-18 column (500 g) using mobile phase composed of 55$ methanol and 45$ of 0.05M ammonium acetate (pH 7.0) by volume, see Fig. 1A. Evaporation and freeze drying yielded 3.38 g (22$) of
Q2-0-methyltyrosine]deamino-1-
-carba-oxytocin. The purity of the product was checked by HPLC, see Fig. IB.
O.D-220
—
60 A: B:
1 120
180
. ,
t(min)
0
± t(min)
Preparative HPLC Analytical HPLC: CGC column (0.3 x 15 cm) with SEPARON SI-C-18, mobile phase : 55$ methanol and 45$ 0.05M ammonium acetate (pH 7)
201
In the above way we prepared the following carba analogues; deamino-l-carba-oxytocin, [^2-0-methyl tyrosine] deamino-1-carba-oxytocin, deamino-6-carba-oxytocin, [^2-p-ethylphenylalanineJdeamino-6-carba.-oxy tocin, all in 20-25?o yield of HPLC pure products. Hie procedure is represented by the following scheme: Carba Is
Carba 6 s -S
CH,
I CH,
CH, CH2-COOH X
=
X-
CH„
CH, CH2-COOH
CH, X-
Nps, Boc, Z 1 - splitting off the protecting group 2 - protection by protonation
CH, CH, CH--CO -
3 - activation of carboxylic group k - cyclization S S CH,
CH,
CH, CH,
CH2-CO-
Discussion With the various types of peptides different cyclization methods were used for closing the carba bridge (see e.g. 1-3)• The most commonly used active ester method with the active ester prepared from properly substituted aryl sulphite suffers from difficulties connected with the preparation of the particular sulphite the stability of which is also limited. Hie synthesis of the active ester is time consuming. The most serious side reaction accompanying the cyclization with p-nitro- or 2,b,5-trichlorophenylesters in pyridine at eleva-
202 ted temperature is the one leading to products of higher molecular weight. Another disadvantage of the mentioned methods consists in the necessity to remove the protecting group after the synthesis of the active ester (often a discomforting feature). We found it possible to prepare the N-hydroxybenzotriazole active ester in situ with DCCI from a peptide protected only by protonation. Cyclization proceeds almost instantaneously after liberation of the amino group by pouring the solution of the active ester salt into alkaline medium where the intramolecularly cyclized product is predominantly formed. The reaction is fast enough even at room temperature. There was found no transesterifica.tion in methanol (on comparison by HPLC with an authentic sample of the corresponding linear peptide methyl ester). Trials were done also with other solvents (acetonitrile, tert-butanol, pyridine, isopropanol, DMFA). Sufficiently high reaction rate enables the reaction to be performed without risk in a. small volume compared with other methods of cycliza.tion. The described procedure was tested on cycliza.tion of both small (30 nig) and big
(26 g) batches.
References 1. 2.
3.
Jost, K.: Collect. Czech. Chem. Commun. 36, 218-233 (1971). Brady, S.F. , Vaxga., S.L. , Freidinger, R.M., Schwenk, D.A., Medlowski, M., Holly, F.W. , Veber, D.F.: J. Org. Chem. kk, 3101-3105 (1979). Sakakibara, S. , Ha.se, S. : Bull. Chem. Soc. Japan
2816 (1968).
SYNTHESIS OF ISOPEPTIDES OF LYSINE AS FUNDAMENTAL STRUCTURAL UNITS OF CLAVICEPAMINES Gyula Szókàn, Marian Gyenes Institute of Organic Chemistry, Eotvos University H-1088 Budapest, Hungary Erno Tyihàk Research Institute for Medicinal Plants Budakalàsz Béla Szende Institute of Pathology and Experimental Cancer Research, Semmelweis Medical University Budapest
Introduction The clavicepamines are lysine rich basic proteins isolated from saprophytic culture of ergot (Claviceps purpurea)(1). The lysine level in them changed between 30-95 mol %, their MW is between 2-17.000 dalton and they showed a cell proliferation retarding effect (2). The isopeptides of Lys occur rarely in nature: in some peptide antibiotics (3), in cell wall of bacteria (4) and in cross linkage of several proteins (5).
Results Dansylated, then hydrolyzed clavicepamines were analyzed exactly by HPLC and OPTLC methods elaborated for separating a, e and bis-Dns-lysines from each other. Chromatographic data: TLC -Merck silicagel G,EtOAc: i-propanol: NH^ 40:32:20 (v/v); HPLC - ODS Hypersil (125x4 mm), MeOH-phosphate buffer (pH 7.7) 50:50, 1.3 ml/min. On the base of finding only a-Dns-Lys it
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
204
was stated, that the lysine e-Nf^ groups are fully blocked, so isopeptides of Lys build up clavicepamines. To prove and to investigate the isopeptide structure e-oligo and poly-lysines were synthesized by our laboratory. Earlier e-lysine dipeptides were formed by classic peptide synthetic methods (1,6), via the NCA-method in aqueous media (7) and using lysine Cu-complex (8). We synthesized a few known and new Lys-peptides. The method of Theodoropoulos (8) was applied and improved. Lys-Cu complex was acylated by protected amino acids. Peptides were formed via MCA method, EEDQ and active ester in THF (or AcN)-aqueous system with 60-80% yield (Fig.l.). Decomposition of peptide complexes proceeded together with crystallization of half-protected Lyspeptides . X-Lys-Y f| Q
Fig.l
Q Gly, Phe, D Phe, Glu(OBil) Glu, Lys (OBzl)
Lys Lys—Gly
X H H
Y OH OH
Lys
OH
H
OH
ca-Polypeptides of basic amino acids were synthesized at first by Kushwaha (9) and Mathur (10) via polycondensation. We elaborated a new procedure using the^backing off-method (11) to obtain Lys-peptide active esters suitable for polycondensation. Lys and Lys peptide-ONp esters were acylated stepwise with protected Lys by rapid coupling method (for example MCA)(Fig. 2.). The method was systematically studied, optimalized and extended with Glu-peptide active esters (12). It can be used in the field of sequential polypeptides, branched peptides and multichain oligo and polyamino acids, too. The purity of active esters were controlled by HPLC. After deprotection and dialysis poly (s-L-lysine) was obtained with MW 20.000 dalton. The isopolypeptide with similar prqperties was prepared by polymerization of Z-Lys-OH with DPPA according to Nishi (13), too.
205
Z - L y s - O H
Fig.2 Polyeond«niatior
£
C)
{¿•protection: HBr / AcOH )
-tripeptide active ester
" baclcing-of f "proc*dur*(appt.) (Goodmon-Stutben) classic.method (Mathur)
Z - L y i - O H
I
-
BOC
I£AJ
Z-LyrOH^ I BOC Z - L y i - O N p
—
In DMSO with TEA 55-72 hrs. was needed to get solution. Some data concerning the enzymatic cleavage of the noncommon e-peptide bond were collected. In case of Lys(Gly) and Lys(Phe) the qualitative results were idential with those of Plessing (7). a*/ ,
/ml »1000
AlrHtmtnt
206 The hydrolysis of e-di and polylysines were compared to that of a-peptides. Trypsin, thermolysin, subtilisin did not split the poly(e-L-lysine), but aminopeptidases hydrolyzed it.The effect of synthetic isopeptides on K562 standard tumour strains was measured. The poly (e-L-lysine) showed the same effect as clavicepamines (Fig. 3.)
e-Dipeptides have no activity. On the.
base of structural and biological investigation it was demonstrated, that the e-lysine-peptides are the fundamental structural units of clavicepamines.
References 1.
Tyihäk, E.: Dissertation (1978)
2.
Tyihäk, E., Molnär, G., Patthy, A., Szende, B., Lapis, K.: Proc. 2 0 ^ Hungarian Annual Meeting Biochem,, SLofok (1980)
3.
Hausmann, W., Weisiger, J.R., Craig, L.C.: J.Am.Chem.Soc. 77, 723 (1955) Ghuysen, J.M., Shockman, G.D.: Bacterial Membranes and Walls, pp. 37-130, Marcel Dekker, New York (1973)
4. 5. 6.
Folk, J.E., Finlayson, J.S.: Adv.Prot.Chem. 31, 1 (1977) Chaturvedi, N.C., Khosla, M.C., Anand, N.: Indian J.Chem. 3, 554 (1965)
7.
Plessing, A., Siebert, G., Wissler, J.H., Puigserver, A.J., Pfaender, P.: Hoppe-Seyler's Z. Physiol.Chem.36 3,2 79 (1982) Theodoropoulos, D.: J.Org.Chem. 23, 140 (1958)
8. 9.
Kushwaha, D.R.S., Mathur, K.B., Balasubramanian, D.: Biopolymers 19, 219 (1980)
10. Mathur, K.B., Pandey, R.K., Jagannadham, M.W., Balasubramanian, D . : Int. J . Peptide Protein Res. ±1_, 189 (1981) 11. Goodman, M., Stueben, K.C.: J.Am.Chem.Soc.81, 3980 (1959) 12. Szokän,Gy., Kotai, A., Dobo, Gy., Kökösi, J., Schwartz, A.: Ann.Univ.Sei. Bp. R.Eötvös, 15, 169 (1979) 13. Nishi, N., Nakajima, B., Hasebe, N., Noguchi, J.: Int.J. Biol.Macromol, 2, 53 (1980)
SYNTHESIS OF LEUCINE ENKEPHALIN- AND ASPARTAME ANALOGS CONTAINING THIOAMIDE LINKAGES AT SPECIFIC POSITIONS
K. Clausen, B. Yde, S.-O. Lawesson Department of Organic Chemistry, Chemical Institute, University of Aarhus, DK-8000 Aarhus C, Denmark
Introduction Among peptide backbone modifications the replacement of an amide bond by a thioamide bond has hitherto attracted little attention (1-6). This may be explained by the lack of general synthetic methods for the preparation of endothiopeptides. Recently, we have reported a method leading to protected endothiodipeptide esters and endothiodipeptide ester salts (7, 8). We describe here a general and efficient method for preparing free endothiopeptides applied to the synthesis of the four possible monothioanalogs of leucine-enkephalin, and to the synthesis of the thioanalog of aspartame.
Results The [Leu5, Phet1* ]-enkephalin analog was prepared by the route shown in Scheme 1. The protected dipeptide Boc-Phe-Leu-OBzl was thionated by using 2,4-bis(4-methoxyphenyl)-1,3,2,4-dithiadiphosphetane 2,4-disulfide (Lawesson's Reagent), LR, as described previously (7, 8). Boc-group removal was effected by using 4M HC1 in dioxane. Next the fully protected monothiopentapeptide was obtained by a (3+2) segment condensation (DCC) . The Boc-, Bzl- and OBzl-protection groups were cleaved simultaneously by using HF. The free monothiopentapeptide was purified by Sephadex gel filtration.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
208 [ y r
G I y Boc -
G1 y
•OH
HCI-H-
-OEt
Boc-
- OEt
Boc -
DCC Boc Bz I -OH Bz l
BocBoc •
/
•OH T o s O H • H • DCC
-OEt
-OBzl
Boc
-OBzl
-OEt 1M
Bzl
¿M H C I / d i o x a n e S
N a OH OH
Boc •
-OBzl
LR
4M HCI / d i o x a n e HCI • H DCC/HOBt
L eu
Ph e
HCl-H DCC
Bzl
t
OBzl •OBzl
Boc • HF/ ar
¡soif -OH
H-
5
1
Scheme 1. Preparation of [Leu , Phet * ]-enkephalin.
Single thioamino acid residues were introduced in positions 1, 2 and 3, respectively, by using protected amino acid dithioesters, which were prepared in high yields by the route shown in Scheme 2. A new and promising MA method is involved (9) .
X-NH-CH-C-OH I R
X a b c
1 ) 21}
NEt 3
t
LR
X-NH-CH-C-0-P-(O)-0Me S®NH®Etj
R
20°C
R H- N o°cN
H H --0-CH2
Z Boc Boc
S 11 X-NH-CH-C1 R
•o
LR D
80 C
\
0 II ^ X - N H - C H - C - N ) R
Mel THF
SMe X-NH-CH-C=N^ I ©
©
H, S 0°C
X-NH-CH-C-SMe I R
Scheme 2. Preparation of N-protected amino acid dithioesters.
209
By using Boc-protected amino acid dithioesters as thioacylating reagents we succeeded to prepare the three remaining fully protected monothio leucine-enkephalin derivatives 3
the [Glyt ]-analog by a (2+3) segment coupling
(Scheme 3),
(DCC)and the
[Glyt 2 ]- and [Tyrt 1 ]-analogs by stepwise procedures
(DCC and
DCC/HOBt). Final deblocking was effected by using HF. G I y
Tyr Bz I —OH B zI
Boc
V.
B 0c
HCI-HDCC/HOBt
II
G I y
-OEt
/
-OBzl
Bo c Boc -
-SMe
S
-H-
- OB z I
-OBzl 4M
H C I / d i o x a n e
-OBzl
HCI-H-
-OH
Bz I
HCI
L.
Boc Boc-
Leu
4M H C I / d i o x a n e - 0 Et
Bz I /
Ph e
DCC -OBzl H F / a n i s o l e -OH
G I y
Tyr
G I y Boc-
Phe
-0H
HC I • H -
Leu -OBz I
DCC -OBz I
Boc t Boc -
-SMe
M
HCI / d i o x a n e
HCI•H-
-OBz I -OBz I
Boc Bz I Boc-
4M
-OH
HCI
Bz I
DCC/HOBt
HCI / d
i o x a m
-OBzl
• H -
-OBzl
Boc • H F / a n i s o l e
• OH
G I y
Tyr
Bo c -
G I y
-OH
Ph e
HCI • H-
Leu • OBz I
DCC Boc Bz I B3 oocc ^-F - S M e
-OBzl ¿M
HCI
HCI / d i o x o n e OBzl
•H•
Bz I Boc
yt.
-OBzl H F / o n i s o l e
H-
L
Scheme 3. Preparation of [Glyt 3 ]-, [Glyt 2 ]-, and cine enkephalin.
OH
[TyrtM-leu-
210
Thioaspartame was prepared as outlined in Scheme 4. The fully protected aspartame was thionated by LR to give the corresponding protected thioaspartame, which was deblocked by using HF/ anisole.
?But Z-Asp-Phe-OMe
LR
?But Z-Aspt-Phe-OMe
HF
Aspt-Phe-OMe
Scheme 4. Preparation of thioaspartame.
Acknowledgements This work was supported by a grant from the Danish Natural Science Research Council
(K.C.).
References 1.
Ried, W., von der Emden, W.: Angew. Chem. 72^, 268 (1960).
2.
Ried, W., von der Emden, W-: Liebigs Ann. Chem. 642, 128 (1961).
3.
Ried, W., Schmidt, E.: Ibid. 695, 217 (1966).
4.
Jones, Jr., W.C., Nestor, Jr., J.J., du Vigneaud, V. : J. Am. Chem. Soc. 9ji, 5677 (1973) .
5.
Mock, W.L., Chen, J.-T., Tsang, J.W.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 102, 389 (1981).
6.
Bartlett, P.A., Spear, K.L., Jacobsen, N.E.: Biochemistry 21, 1608 (1982) .
7.
Clausen, K., Thorsen, M., Lawesson, S.-O.: Tetrahedron 37, 1019 (1981) .
8.
Clausen, K., Thorsen, M., Lawesson, S.-O.: Chemica Scripta 20_, 14 (1982) .
9.
Pedersen, U., Thorsen, M., El-Khrisy, E.-E.A.M., Clausen, K., Lawesson, S.-O.: submitted.
SYNTHETIC STUDIES ON THE CECROPINS R.B. Merrifield and L.D. Vizioli The Rockefeller University New York City, New York, U.S.A. H.G. Boman University of Stockholm Stockholm, Sweden
The cecropins are a family of peptides that are induced in pupae of the giant silk moth Hylophora cecropia following injection of live bacteria
(1).
They are part of the humoral
immune response of the insect and are antibacterial against Gram negative and Gram positive bacteria.
Cecropins A and B
both contain 37 amino acid residues and a blocked C-terminus (2). To study its bactericidal activity, a solid phase synthesis of cecropin A(1-33) was undertaken.
The synthetic protected
peptide I was Boc-Lys(ClZ)-Trp(For)-Lys(CIZ)-Leu-Phe-Lys(ClZ)-Lys(C1Z)Ile-Glu(OBzl)-Lys(ClZ)-Val-Gly-Gln-Asn-Ile-Arg(Tos)-Asp(OcHex) Gly-Ile-Ile-Lys(C1Z)-Ala-Gly-Pro-Ala-Val-Ala-Val-Val-Gly-Gln-
The Pam-resin support (3) was used for increased acid stability. Double couplings with symmetrical anhydrides and hydroxybenzotriazole esters were monitored by a new quantitative ninhydrin procedure
(4) (Fig 1).
They proceeded to ^0.2% of completion in
the early part of the synthesis and within ^0.5% in the latter part.
There was a gradual loss of chains during the synthesis,
not due to acidolysis or to termination. resin was evaluated for deletions
The protected peptide-
(5) by solid phase sequencing.
Near the end of the synthesis 0.5 to 0.8% deletions were indicated for residues 4-7. significant deletion
The first 26 steps proceeded without
(ave
L e u
authentic
purification water;
hydrophobic
IR-45
l.
97 >
neuro-
on
5:1:3)
impurities
a
G10
or
on
and
to
homogeneity.
related
peptides
biological
acetylated
have
testing
o n the r e s i n
after
recently (table removal
been
1).
prepared All
in
a
acetylated
of the F m o c
group.
250
TABLE 1
hplcb
Kf3 nt
1-13
[Aha6]NT6_13 Ac-NT
0.25
9.4
0.19
8.6
Aha/Lys
1 05
Pro
Arg
Tyr
Leu
lie
1 .99 2 .04 0 .99 0 .93 1 .01
7-13
0.25
9.1
2 . 12 2 .16 1 .03 0 .90 1 .00
Ac-NT8_13
0.29
8.6
0 .90 2 .07 0 .98 0 .92 1 .00
[Ac-Lys8]NTg_13
0.26
8.4
0 97
0 .90 1 .01 0 .98 0 .90 1 .00
[Aha8]NTg_13
0.29
8.3
1 03
1 .00 1 .03 1 .00 0 .93 1 .02
Ac-NT9_13
0.41
8.7
1 .06 1 .09 1 .04 0 .87 1 .00
AC-NT10_13
0.71
9.2
0 .96
a. R f
(B:A:W
NH^OAc pH 4.5.
12:3:5).
b.
-
1 .01 0 .96 1 .06
CH3CN o v e r 20 m i n at 2 m l / m i n 0.01
5-100%
Aha=6-amino-n-hfixanoic
M
acid.
References
1.
Carraway, (1973) .
R. ,
and
2.
K i t a b g i , P., C a r r a w a y , 7 0 5 3 - 7 0 5 8 (1976).
3.
H a m m e r , R.A., L e e m a n , S.E., C a r r a w a y , Biol. Chem., 255, 2476-2480 (1980).
4.
Y a j i m a , H. , K i t a g a w a , K . , S e g a w a , C h e m . P h a r m . Bull . , _23_, 3 2 9 9 - 3 3 0 0
T. , N a k a n o , (1975).
5.
Carraway, (1975).
J.
6.
R i v i e r , J.E., L a z a r u s , L.H. , P e r r i n , M.H., and B r o w n , M . R . : C h e m . , 20, 1 4 0 9 - 1 4 1 2 ( 1 9 7 7 ) .
7.
Sheppard, R.C.,and in press ( 1 9 8 2 ) .
Williams,
B.J.:
8.
S h e p p a r d , R.C., and W i l l i a m s , 589 ( 1 9 8 2 ) .
B.J.:
9.
Atherton, E., Gait, M.J., Sheppard, B i o o r g . C h e m . , _8_, 3 5 1 - 3 7 0 ( 1 9 7 9 ) .
10.
S t e l a k a t o s , G.E., S o l o m o s - A r a v i d i s , C., K a r a y a n n a k i s , P., K o l o v o s , M.G., and Photaki, I.: Proc. 16th European Peptide symposium, H e l s i n g o r , B r u n f e l d t , D., Ed., pp. 133-138 ( 1 9 8 0 ) .
R., and
Leeman,
S.E.:
R., and
Leeman,
J.
Biol.
Leeman,
S.E.:
Chem.,
S.E.: R.
and
Biol.
Int.
J.
R.C.,
6854-6861,
Biol.
Chem.
Williams,
251 ,
R.H.:
M., and K a t a o k a ,
Chem.,
Pep.
J. C h e m .
248,
and
Soc. and
250,
Prot. Chem.
J. K. :
1912-1918 J.
Med.
Chem., Comm.,
Williams,
20, 587-
B.J.:
LIQUID-PHASE SYNTHESIS OF BIOLOGICALLY ACTIVE PEPTIDES ON EASILY DETACHABLE POLY(ETHYLENE GLYCOL) SUPPORTS Roberto Colombo Department of Biomedical Sciences and Technology , University of Milan, St. Raphael Hospital, 1-20132 Milan, Italy.
Polymer-supported peptide syntheses are based on the idea that a peptide chain can be conveniently assembled in a stepwise manner while it is covalently attached at one hand to a polymer.
In solid-phase synthesis (1) the growing peptide
chain is anchored to an entirely insoluble particle during all stages of the synthesis and all the reactions are carried out in a
heterogeneous system.
Therefore, after each of the
reactions has been completed, the solid phase allows
rapid
filtration and washing for the removal of excess reactants and by-products.
In place of the insoluble matrix, liquid-phase
synthesis (2) uses a linear polymeric support which is soluble in some solvents and insoluble in others, thus allowing a repetitive procedure for the removal of reagents and by-products while exerting a solubilizing effect on the peptide chain during the reactions required by the synthesis. The ever-increasing number of reports dealing with peptide syntheses which are carried out by the solid-phase technique shows the usefulness of this approach, discloses its limitations, and stimulates efforts to improve the present procedures.
On
the contrary, during the past years only a limited number of naturally occurring peptides was prepared on soluble supports; thus, it seemed necessary to examine more closely the feasibility and convenience of the liquid-phase technique as regards the synthesis of small- to medium-sized peptides.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
252
H 2 N-PEG-OCH 3
1. (BOC-Nle-) O 1. Et N/CH Cl 2 > H-Nie-NH-PEG-OCH^ 2. TFA/CH„C1„ • TFA 2. HO-C.H- (CH„) -COOSu 2
z
b
4
Z
Z
Bpoc-LTrp-OH , DCC , CH 2 C1 2
/=\ HO-A. V c H CH CO-Nle-NH-PEG-OCH YL_V
2. 1% TFA/CH 2 C1 2
'
» 3. Et 3 N/CH 2 Cl 2
1.
(Bpoc-DLeu-) 2 0
2.
and so on .
H-LVal-Gly-LAla-DLeu-LAla-DVal-LVal-DVal-LTrp-DLeu-LX(Ac)DLeu-LTrp-DLeu-LTrp-0-^^^-CH 2 CH 2 C0-Nle-NH-PEG-0CH 3 1. H 2 NCH 2 CH 2 OH , DMF , 36 h 2. HCOO-C^H -NO o
4
Z
3. chromatography 1
5
10
HCO-LVal-Gly-LAla-DLeu-LAla-DVal-LVal-DVal-LTrp-DLeu-LX15
DLeu-LTrp-DLeu-LTrp-NHCH 2 CH 2 OH Fig. 1. Outline of the synthesis of Val-gramici 345nm) yielding reactive carbenes. 2 [Phe(pNH2) ]deamino-dicarba-AVP was labelled with tritium by iodination of the 2-p-aminophenylalanine residue and catalytic dehalogenation in the presence of tritium; 3a specific radioactivity of 16 Ci/mMole was obtained. The H-labelled analogue 3 was converted into the H-azidophenylalanine derivative. 2 [pheipNf^) ]deamino-dicarba-AVP retained an antidiuretic activity in anaesthetized rats of 21 I.u./mg. From competition experiments with 3H-AVP (4) 60 the± apparent dissociation
R
NH2 JCl|| 3 H 2 ,Pd/Al 2 0 3 R
R
N=N
NH
NH
CO
I. NO*
2.NQN3
Br
CO [CH 2 ] 2
R
R=
I
NH-CH-CO-Phe-Gln-Asn-Asu-Pro-Arg-Gly-NH2 CH2
Fig. 1.
Introduction of (photo)reactive groups and of tritium label in [2-p-aminophenylalanine, 8-argininejdeamino-dicarba-vasopressin.
303 constants K for the binding of AVP-analogues to vasopressin receptors in plasma membranes were determined. [pheCp-N^) ]deamino-dicarba-AVP showed the highest binding affinities: For -9 -10 bovine kidney medulla K was 5.5-10 M (AVP: K = 9*10 M), —8 —1O for rat liver K Q was 4.1*10 M (AVP: K^ = 8-10 M). The high binding affinity was retained after labelling with tritium. For the introduction of reactive groups or reporter molecules g at the C-terminal end of vasopressin, 1-deamino-[Arg ]vasopressinoic-acid was prepared. Peptide synthesis (Fig. 2) was
Boc-ArglTosl-OH
H-Gly-NH-NH-Z | DCC I HOBt
Bx-Arg(Tos)-Gly-NH-NH-Z
jcFjCOOH I CHjCOOH Bx-Pro-OH
H-Arg{Tos)-Gly-NH-NH-Z
I
Mixed Anhydride Method Boc-Pro-ArglTosl-Gly-NH-NH-Z
jcFjCOOH I CHjCOOH Boc-Cys(Acm)-OH
H-Pro-Arg(Tosl-Gly-NH-NH-Z
1
r-1
I DCC / HOBt
Boc-Cys(Acm)-Pro-Arg(Tosl-Gly-NH-NH-Z
jcFjCOOH I CHjCOOH
Boc-Phe-Gln-Asn-OH
H-CyslAcml-Pro-ArglTosl-Gly-NH-NH-Z
1
'
'
I DCC I HOBt
Boc-Phe-Gln-Asn-Cys(Acml-Pro-Arg(7osl-Gly-NH-NH-Z
| CFjCOOH/CHjCOOH Bx-Tyr-OH
H-Phe-Gln-Asn-CyslAcml-Pro-ArglTosl-Gly-NH-NH-Z
I
Bx-Tyr-Phe-Gln-Asn-Cys(Acm)-Pro-Arg(Tos)-Gly-NH-NH-Z
^CFjCOOH I CHjCOOH p-MpalAcml-OH
H-Tyr-Phe-Gln-Asn-CyslAcml-Pro-ArglTosl-Gly-NH-NH-Z DCC I HOBt
p-Mpa(Acm)-Tyr-Phe-Gln-Asn-Cys(Acm}-Pro-Arg(Tos)-Gly-NH-NH-Z 1. CF3SO3H I m-Cresol, Dimethylsulfide
2. J,
p-Mpa-Tyr-Phe-Gln-Asn-Cys-Pro-Arg-Gly-OH
I
Fig. 2
I
Synthesis of 1-deamino-[Arg ]vasopressinoic acid
304 started with the COOH-terminal glycine hydrazide in the N' protected form and gave yields between 60 and 90 % in all coupling steps. From the protected nonapeptide the N'-Z and N^-Tos groups were removed by trifluoromethane sulfonic acid. The resulting S-protected (Acm) nonapeptide was cyclized by treatment with iodine in acetic acid / water (4:1) and simultaneously the C-terminal hydrazido group was removed (yield:20%). Purification was accomplished by partition chromatography on Sephadex G-25 in n-butanol / ethanol / pyridine / 0.1 N acetic acid (4:1:1:7). [ot] D 2 0 = -68.3 (c = 1 , 1 N acetic acid). + Field desorption g mass spectroscopy: m/e 1071 = MH . 1-Deamino-[Arg ]vasopressinoic acid showed an antidiuretic activity of 19.6 ± 6 I.U./mg (n=4). It stimulated bovine renal adenylate cyclase and bound to vasopressin receptors _7 from bovine kidney inner medulla ( K = 4.5»10 M) and from r Li rat liver ( K = 1.1 • 10 M ).
References 1. 2. 3.
Fahrenholz, F., Thierauch, K.-H., Crause, P.: HoppeSeyler's Z. Physiol. Chem. 153-167 (1980). Fahrenholz, F., Husseini, H.S., Morgat, J.L., Thierauch, K.-H.: Hoppe-Seyler1s Z. Physiol. Chem. (1982) in press. Church, R.F.R., Weiss, M.J.: J. Org. Chem. 3j>/ 2465-2471 (1970).
4.
Crause, P., Fahrenholz, F.: Mol. Cell. Endocrinology (1982) in press.
SYNTHETIC FRAGMENTS O F BACTERIAL C E L L W A L L S . PHYSICOCHEMICAL AND BIOLOGICAL
PROPERTIES
MiloS BudgSinsky, 3an Oezek, Viktor Krchnak, Michal
Lebl,
M i l a n Zaoral Institute of Organic C h e m i s t r y and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak A c a d e m y of Sciences, 166 10 Praha 6, C z e c h o s l o v a k i a OiCi Rotta, R a d o v a n Straka Institute of Hygiene and Epidemiology, 100 42 Praha 10, C z e c h o s l o v a k i a
Introduction There are numerous compounds which show an immunoadjuvant and/or immunostimulating effect. Of their number, the
frag-
ments of bacterial cell wall, peptidoglycan, M D P , and other peptides and glycopeptides (1) are of key importance they permit us a direct examination of the
since
relationship
between the chemical structure and the biological
properties
of the components of bacterial cell walls. The character of the peptidoglycan is that of a sequential polymer. We have designed therefore the first part of our study as an examination of the relationship between biological effects and the complexity of synthetic glycopeptides,
fragments of the cell
wall peptidoglycan of Staphylococcus aureus, strain C o p e n h a gen and S t r e p t o c o c c u s pyogenes, group A. The peptides and glycopeptides needed for our study were prepared both by solid phase synthesis and by synthesis in solution.
Attention
deserves the simultaneous removal of the protecting
groups
from the glycopeptides by treatment with sodium in liquid ammonia (1,2) and the use of solid phase synthesis for the preparation of glycopeptides (1). In this communication we
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
306
have focused a special attention to the problem of the sugar component.
Results 1 1)
HPLC,
H - and
13 C-NMR studies. The high performance
chromatography (HPLC-reversed phase) of MDP,
liquid
galacto-,
alio-, and norallo-MDP showed the presence of three components at least, in each case (see Table I). The
position
of the individual peaks is characterized by the capacity factor k'. In the case of MDP the products represented by the individual peaks were isolated and equilibrated with an aqueous methanolic phosphate buffer. The
equilibrium
mixture contained pairs of the starting compounds. T h i s result shows that MDP represents a mixture of cr and /3 anomers and two impurities. The HPLC data were confirmed 1 13 by measurement of H - and C-NMR spectra. According to these data peak 1 corresponds to the /3-anomer and peak 2 to the oP-anomer. A n a l o g o u s results were obtained
recently
by Lederer et al. (3). Peaks 3 and 4 are impurities with the opposite configuration of the lactyl residue they yielded isomuramic acid after hydrolysis
since
(identifi-
cation by HPLC and in the amino acid analyzer). The densation of the protected glucosamine derivative
con-
with
the derivative of 2-halogenpropionic acid obviously does not proceed quite stereoselectively (cf., 4 ) . The HPLC of galacto-, alio-, and norallo-MDP indicated a mixture of three compounds (Table I). Each of these components afforded after equilibration, carried out as with MDP, the original equilibrium mixture. We account
for two of the
peaks by the presence of the of- and /3-anomer of the pyranoid form; the third peak corresponds to the
furanoid
form. T h i s assumption is supported by the results of e x p e r i m e n t s with the reduction of D - g a l a c t o - M D P by sodium
307
TABLE I C o m p o s i t i o n of glycopeptides in phosphate buffer pH 5.00 in equilibrium
compound MDP
No.of peak
k'
% (t
isomer3 ctf.j3;P,F
)
1
4.7
26.8
P
-
P
2
8.5
53.6
a
-
P
3
9.8
7.0
/3
-
4
15.8
12.6
Of
-
P (S) P (S)
1
4.2
34.1
|3
-
P
2
6.6
59.7
a
-
P and ¡3 - F
3
8.1
6.2
Of
-
F
product of NaBH^
1
7.7
88.4
reduction of D-galacto-MDP
2
10.4
11.6
D-galacto-MDP
D-norallo-MDP
D-allo-MDP
Q
1
4.9
56.0
/3
-
P
2
5.9
20.5
of
-
F
3
6.5
22.9
af
-
P
4
8.0
0.6
ug were
peptides
and i n v i t r o
are
pronounced
tidoglycan to g r o u p s
Multiple
in vivo or
1 of
1 3 . 1 (k
streptococcus
particularly the
k'
peptidoglycan
resemble
6
in
fever
dose of
20,
individual response
the h e x a p e p t i d e ,
no
309
Glycotetrapeptide
Glycohexapeptide
(a)
(b)
/
0 12
3 4 5 6
,
Glycononapeptide (c)
-
v
.
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Hours
Glycotridecapeptide (d) 20 pq 100 pg — 500jjg
0 1 2
3
4
(a)
MurNAc-L-Ala-D-iGln-L-Lys|Ac)-D-Ala-NH2 |b): MurNAc-L-Ala-D- iGln-L-Lys-D-Ala-IL-Alal^OMe (c): MurNAc-L-Alo-O-iGln-L-Lys(Ac)-D-Ala-(Gly)5-NH2 (d); MurNAc-L-Ala-D-iGlnH_-L»sug. T h e p r o l o n g a t i o n
protein
antigens
reaction
potentiation
of was
310
recorded in humoral response as measured by the antibody answer to the antigen. Peptides were with a rare exception without effect. Thrombocytolysis of rabbit blood platelets could be provoked by glycopeptides whereas the peptides themselves had no effect or produced degranulation only. The lysis of blood platelets was dose dependent. In all three effects, in pyrogenicity,
immunoadju-
vancy and thrombocytolysis, an evident structure to function relationship could be demonstrated.
References 1. 2.
Zaoral, M., Oezek, Czech.Chem.Commun. Zaoral, M., Oezek, Czech.Chem.Commun.
0., 45, Ü., 43,
Krchnak, V., Straka, R.: Collect. 1424-1446 (1980). Straka, R., Maëek, K.: Collect. 1797-1802 (1978).
3.
Halls, T.D.O., Raju, M.S., Wenkert, E., Zuber, M., Lefrancier, P., Lederer, E.: Carbohydr.Res. 81, 173-176 (1980).
4.
Arendt, A., Kolodziejczyk, A., Sokolowska, T.: Rocz.Chem. 48, 1707-1711 (1974).
SYNTHESIS OF ANALOGUES OF PRECURSORS OF BACTERIAL PEPTIDOGLYCAN
Didier Blanot, Androniki Kretsovali, Mohamed Abo-Ghalia, Dominique Mengin-Lecreulx, Jean van Heijenoort E.R. n°245 du CNRS, Institut de Biochimie, Université de Paris-Sud, 91405 Orsay, France
Introduction
The cytoplasmic steps of the biosynthesis of bacterial peptidoglycan involve uridine diphospho-N-acetylmuramyi-peptide precursors, each step being catalyzed by a particular synthetase (1). In order to find specific inhibitors of these enzymes, which might act as antibacterial compounds, we have undertaken the synthesis of analogues of the glycopeptide part of the precursors. In this communication, we shall report the preparation of propionyl- and N-acetylmuramyl-di- and tripeptides, potential competitive inhibitors of some synthetases,as well as of Npropionyl-L-alanine chloromethyl ketone, potential irreversible inhibitor. The effect of these compounds on some of the peptidoglycan synthetases of E. coli will also be reported.
Preparation of the peptides
The propionyl-peptides Pr-L-Ala-D-Glu-OH
(I), Pr-L-Ala-D-Glu-OH (II) and L-L-Lys-OH
Pr-L-Ala-D-Glu-OH (III) were synthesized according to the scheme of Fig.l. H-D-Lys-OH Purification was carried out by preparative TLC on cellulose powder G 1805 (Schleicher and Schiill) in the solvent system n-propanol-water 2:1 (v/v) . The purity of the peptides was checked by TLC, HPLC and amino acid analysis . The N-acetylmuramyl-peptides MurNac-L-Ala-D-Glu-OH
(IV) and MurNac-L-Ala-
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
312 D-Glu-OH
(V) were prepared by mild hydrolysis (0.1 N HCl, 100°,
L(L)meso-DAP-OH 5 min) (2) of the corresponding UDP derivatives. They were purified by HPLC on y-Bondapak Cjg using 0.05 M ammonium formate pH 3.5, an eluent similar to the one recommended for the analysis of the nucleotide precursors (3). Each glycopeptide appeared as a mixture of two anomers. MurNac-L-Ala-D-Glu-NH 2
(MDP) was a gift from Dr. P. Lefrancier. H-L-Ala-
D-Glu-OH (VI) was synthesized according to Sachs and Brand (4). The chloromethyl ketone of N-propionyl-L-alanine
(Pr-L-Ala-CH^Cl) was
obtained by condensing the mixed anhydride (isobutyl carbonate) of propionic acid with H-L-Ala-C^Cl
(5). Purification was achieved by silica
gel column chromatography using CHCl^-MeOH 95:5 (v/v) as an eluent.
Pr
L-Ala
Nps .
D-Glu
, OSu
L-Lys
OBu
H
OH Nps , \
OBu OH
DCCI + HOSu -OBu
Nps ,
'OSu Nps _
H.
OH Boc
\
OH Boc
_0Bu C 5 H 5 N.HBr
OSu
\
+ indole
_0Bu .OH .Boc _0Bu OH Boc
cf 3 CO 2 H .OH
OH ^ H Fig.1
Scheme of synthesis of the propionyl-peptides
313 Enzymatic
results
The enzymatic p r e p a r a t i o n used was a crude E. c o l i e x t r a c t o b t a i n e d by the method of Mengin-Lecreulx e t a l .
( 6 ) . The enzymatic t e s t s were
out a c c o r d i n g to the published procedures 1)
UDP-MurNac-L-Ala-D-Glu s y n t h e t a s e .
carried
(6).
Contrary to the product of
the
reaction
(UDP-MurNac-dipeptide),
which had been shown to be an i n h i -
b i t o r of
t h i s enzymatic a c t i v i t y
(6),
n e a r l y no i n h i b i t o r y
the product analogue I
effect.
On the o t h e r hand, Pr-L-Ala-CH„C1, a f t e r p r e i n c u b a t i o n f o r the e x t r a c t ,
presented
t o t a l l y i n h i b i t e d the a c t i v i t y at 3.10 -3 : 14%) a t 10 M.
-2
15 min w i t h
M, and p a r t l y
(residual a c t i v i t y 2)
UDP-MurNac-L-Ala-y-D-Glu-meso-DAP Compound
synthetase.
Concentration
none
Enzymatic
I
10~3 M
88
I
10-2 M
59
IV
10~3
MDP VI Whereas the f r e e d i p e p t i d e by p r o p i o n y l b i t o r s of
(I),
activity
100
-
M
57
10" 2 M
79
10" 2
95
M
( V I ) had no i n h i b i t o r y e f f e c t , i t s
and mainly by N-acetylmuramyl
(IV),
acylation
gave good
the r e a c t i o n . On the o t h e r hand, the s u b s t i t u t i o n of
nal a-COOH by a primary amide (MDP) s t r o n g l y diminished the
inhitermi-
inhibitory
activity. 3)
UDP-MurNac-L-Ala-y-D-Glu-meso-DAP-D-Ala-D-Ala s u b s t r a t e analogues I I
(at
10~2 M), I I I
(at
presented a s i g n i f i c a n t i n h i b i t o r y a c t i v i t y
s y n t h e t a s e . None o f
10~2 M) and V ( a t towards t h i s
the
10~3 M)
synthetase.
Conclus ion
These p r e l i m i n a r y r e s u l t s a l l o w us to draw the f o l l o w i n g conclusions - The s t r u c t u r a l seem to be
requirements of
strict.
UDP-MurNac-pentapeptide
synthetase
:
314 - For the inhibition of UDP-MurNac-tripeptide synthetase, it seems necessary that the L-Ala-D-Glu moiety be acylated. The N-acetylmuramyl group gives a better result than the propionyl one. Experiments are being carried out in our laboratory in order to check the effect of
intermediary
groups such as lactyl. - The potential irreversible inhibitor P r - L - A l a - C ^ C l does inhibit UDPMurNac-dipeptide synthetase. Further experiments are necessary
to demons-
trate that this inhibition is irreversible, as it is the case for other enzymes with chloromethyl ketones
(7).
References
1. Rogers, H.J., Perkins, H.R., Ward, J.B. : in Microbial Cell Walls and Membranes, pp. 239-297, Chapman and Hall Ltd, London 1980. 2. Park, J.T.
: J. Biol. Chem. J 9 4 , 885-895
(1952).
3. Flouret, B., Mengin-Lecreulx, D., van Heijenoort, J. : Anal. 114, 59-63 (1981). 4. Sachs, H., Brand, E.: J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 75_, 4608-4610
Biochem.
(1953).
5. Thomson, A., Dennis, I.S. : Eur. J. Biochem. _38, 1-5 (1973) ; Thompson, R.C., Blout, E.R. : Biochemistry _1_2, 44-47 (1973) ; Powers, J.C., Tuhy, P.M. : Biochemistry 4767-4774 (1973). 6. Mengin-Lecreulx, D., Flouret, B., van Heijenoort, J. : J. Bacteriol., in press (1982). 7. Powers, J.C. : in Chemistry and Biochemistry of Amino Acids, Peptides and Proteins (Weinstein, B., ed.), Vol. 4, pp. 65-178, Marcel Dekker, New York 1977 ; Walsh, C. : Horizons Biochem. Biophys. 3, 36-81 (1977).
S Y N T H E S I S O F P E P T I D E S W I T H oC,n-DEHYDROAMINOACID I.
RESIDUE
S y n t h e s i s of N - p r o t e c t e d D i p e p t i d e s w i t h C - t e r m i n a l Deh y d r o a l a n i n e and
Dehydrophenylalanine
B a r b a r a R z e s z o t a r s k a , M a c i e j M a k o w s k i and Z b i g n i e w
Kubica
I n s t i t u t e of C h e m i s t r y , P e d a g o g i c a l U n i v e r s i t y ul. O l e s k a 4 8 , 4 5 - 0 5 2 O p o l e , P o l a n d
Int r o d u c t i o n N-protected dehydroamino
acids obtained via condensation
of
a m i d e s w i t h oi-keto a c i d s are of l i m i t e d v a l u e in further tide chain b u i l d i n g . In the most c a s e s N - p r o t e c t i n g (Tos, Z, A l k y l - C O )
cannot be e a s i l y split off
from A A l a ) . M o r e o v e r , no g r o u p
reactivity
pep-
group
(especially
the of,n~double bond d i m i n i s h e s the
(especially
in A P h e ) (l-5). We have
d i f f i c u l t i e s can be c i r c u m v e n t e d by c o n d e n s a t i o n of
amifound
properly
N ^ - p r o t e c t e d amino a c i d a m i d e s w i t h oi-keto a c i d s , leading N - p r o t e c t e d d i p e p t i d e s w i t h C - t e r m i n a l oi,n-dehydroamino R I X-NHCHCO-NH2
CH2R I 0CC0-0H
+
to
acid.
R CHR' I II X-NHCHCO-NHCCO-OH
X = Boc , Z , TFA R = H , CH2C6H5 R
=
, CH(CH 3 ).
H , CgHg
C o n d e n s a t i o n s mere
c a r r i e d out in b e n z e n e w i t h a z e o t r o p i c
ter removing
in some c a s e s in the p r e s e n c e of
(2,5)
s u l p h o n i c acid T o s - O H as the c a t a l y s t semiquantitatively crystalline
wa-
p-toluene
(2). We e x a m i n e d
them
by T L C . T h e p r o d u c t s w e r e i s o l a t e d in a
form from e i t h e r warm or c o o l e d r e a c t i o n
T h e w e l l s o l u b l e but h a r d l y c r y s t a l l i z i n g c i p i t a t e d as d i c y c l o h e x y l a m i n e
mixture.
compounds were
salts.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
pre-
316
Table.
Prepared N - p r o t e c t e d riipeptides and their properties Solvent for crystallization
Mp °C
1 Boc-Gly-AAla
EtOH/pet.ether
157.5-150 157.5-159(8)
2 Boc-Phe-AAla.DCHA
EtOH/EtgO/pet.ether
170.5-173.5
3 Boc-Phe-AAla
crude
149-152
4 Boc-Val-AAla.DCHA
EtOH/Et^O/pet.other
155-158
5 Z-Gly-AAla
Me0H/Ho0
6 Z-Phe-AAla.DCHA
AcOEt/pet.ether
146-149
7 Z-Phe-AAla
crude
148-149 149-150(7)
8 Z-Val-AAla.DCHA
AcOEt
143-146
51
9 TFA-Gly-AAla
crude
193.5-195
76
AcOEt
168-170
42
Nr C o m p o u n d
10 T F A - P h e - A A l a . D C H A
(lit)
Yield £f /O 19a> 19 b ) 24 C >
186-188 55 187(5 1 188-189(7) 59
11 TFA-Phe-AAla
crude
193-195
12 T F A - V a l - A A l a
AcOEt/CHpCl?
162-165
42
13 Z - G l y - A P h e
AcOEt
168-170
32
14 Z-Phe-APhe
AcOEt
193-195
35
15 Z - V a l - A P h e
MeOH/H 0
207-211.5
39
\ / B 0 C
" \
0 Nr
H
//
were isolated, respectively
\
a
9/NH
^
CH3
'
6%, 183-185°C 37%
27%,
(AcOEt)
186
' 5 - 1 9 0 ° C (Ac0Et/Et 2 0) 176-179.5°C (Ac0Et/Et"0) 2
•'•H NMR s p e c t r a d " in ppm from HMDS and (jHz) Uret.proton Pept ide Olefinic Solven t oC-proton or C F o C 0 N H proton proton(s)
2
6.0s 6.6s
5.6b
4.8m
9.1s
CDC1?
4
6.0s 6.6s
5. 7d (8Hz)
4.4m
9.1s
CDC1, DM30-D
5
5.9s 6.5s
7. 8t
4 . O d (6Hz)
9.3s
11
5.9s 6.5s
9.9d(7Hz)
5.1m
9.8s
b DMSO-Dg
12
5.6s 6.2s
8.2d(7Hz)
4.3m
8.5s
Me^CO-D
13
Both protons o v e r -
4.Od(6Hz)
9.6s
14
lapped with aromatic
4.7m
9.9s
15
protons
7 .2 - 7.9m
4.2m
9.6s
DMSO-D. D DMSO—D_ 6 DMS0-D_ b
317 esults )
The model
compounds
of the
reaction
con-
prelimi
nary o b s e r v a t i o n s . Reactivity
amino
acid amides
decreased
was the m o s t Condensation for Z - N H
of the
protected
in the o r d e r B o c > Z > T F A .
reactive amino
acid was much more )
for i n v e s t i g a t i o n
d i t i o n s w e r e c h o s e n on the b a s i s of the f o l l o w i n g
acid among
reactive
tested and
than p h e n y l p y r u v i c
with pyruvic acid. The optimum
(2) o r C I C H ^ C O - N H ^
(5)
Glycine pyruvic
one.
conditions
condensations were
inade
quate for Nf*- p r o t e c t e d the b y - p r o d u c t
formation.The
sed by d i l u t i o n of c t i o n of the prolonged discussed,
the
reaction
heating
Tos-OH seems
amino acid amide ones because side
r e a c t i o n s can be
b e c a u s e of m i n o r a m i d e
to be an e f f e c t i v e
although
catalyst
in the c o n c e n t r a t i o n
d e n s a t i o n w i t h o t h e r of-keto acids(2) by-product
formations
e v e r , the t e n f o l d sufficient favours
the s i d e
appears
to
reaction
be and
amino
acid
the y i e l d s
are
on p y r u v i c a c i d a m o u n t . F o r m a t i o n be d e a l t w i t h i n
and the
paper.
Condensation
with phenylpyruvic
protected amino-acid
zed with Tos-OH. The dipeptides lyst oven 4 3 hrs h e a t i n g
isolated
in
Z-
catalymoderate
the
cata-
g i v e s o n l y m i n u t e a m o u n t s of
of s o m e of the p r o d u c t s
thesis was demonstrated
were
In the a b s e n c e of
p e p t i d e s and s e v e r a l b y - p r o d u c t s Utility
acid. Reaction with
amides occurs smoothly when
•'ields (30 - 4 0 % , s e o T a b l e ) .
)
How-
of T o s - O H by ZnCl,,
materials
the s t r u c t u r e of the b y - p r o d u c t s w i l l next
con-
many
reaction.
reactions. When Boc-protected
lower and dependent
reaction
u s e d in the
of the p r o p e r
a m i d e s are u s e d as the s t a r t i n g
)
concentration. of the
less T o s - O H c o n c e n t r a t i o n
results. Displacement
inspe
requires
it c a t a l y z e s
as. w e l l as the m a i n
for an a c c e l e r a t i o n
gives promising
decrea
r e a c t i o n m i x t u r e and c a r e f u l time. The dilute solution
of
as
are
for f u r t h e r
follows:
the
formed. peptide
syn-
318
Boc-Gly-AAla
+
Gly-OMe
TFA-Gly-AAla
CICOOiBu
Gly-OtBu
DCCI + BtOH
Boc-Gly-AAla-Gly-OMe
TFA-Gly-AAla-Gly-OtBu
1. H 2 0 / 0 H "
NH 3 -H 2 O
2. T F A - O H
Gly-AAla-Gly-OtBu
3. NET3 Gly-AAla-Gly
+
Boc-Gly-OSu (8)
Boc-Gly-Gly-AAla-Gly-OtBu
Acknowledgment The authors acknowledge financial support for this work by Grant MR.I.12.1.6.11 from the Polish Academy of Sciences .
References 1.
Schmidt, U., Häusler, 0., Ohler, E., Poisel, H . : in Progress in the Chemistry of Organic Natural Products 37. 252-327, ed. Grisenbach, H., Kirby, G. W., 3pringer-Ver lag, Wien . New York 1979.
2.
Yonezawa, Y., Shin, Ch., Ono, Y., Yoshimura, 3 . : Bull. Chen. Soc. 3pn 53, 2905-2909 (1980).
3.
Poisel, H . : Chen. Ber. 110, 942-947
4.
Shin, Ch., Yonezawa, Y., Takahashi, M., Yohsimura, 3.: Bull. Chem. Soc. Dpn 54, 1132-1136 (l98l).
5.
Edqe, A . B. S., Weber, P.: Int. 0. Peptide Protein Res. 18~ 1-5 (1981).
6.
Wieland, T., Ohnacker, G., Ziegler, W . : Chem. Ber. 90 194-201 (1957).
7.
Srinivasan, A., Stephenson, R. W., Olsen, R. K . : 0. Orq. Chem. 42, 2253-2256 (1977).
8.
Pawelczak, K., Krzyzanowski, L., Rzeszotarska, B. : Polish D. Chem. 53, 2002-2011
(1977).
(1979).
SYNTHESIS OF DEHYDRO AMINO ACIDS AND PEPTIDES Robert H. Mazur and Daniel R. Pilipauskas Department of Medicinal Chemistry G. D. Searle & Co., Skokie, IL 60077
Present methods do not permit placing a desired a,3-dehydro amino acid into a predetermined position in a peptide.
Fur-
thermore, E-isomers are not readily available so little is known about their biological properties.
The reactions
reported here have apparently solved these problems. We adapted a versatile synthesis of dehydro amino acids''" to allow the incorporation of the Boc N-protecting group. Condensation of an aldehyde or ketone with methyl isothiocyanoacetate, obtained from glycine methyl ester, with K0Bu t 2 in THF gave the oxazolidinethione as the potassium salt. The latter without isolation was treated with t-butyldicarbonate to yield the N-Boc derivative (structure A in Table I). Reaction of intermediate A with KOBufc in THF caused conversion to the Boc-dehydro amino ester (B in Table I).
These
reactions go rapidly at below room temperature. Table I S
S
II
BocNHCC0 2 Me CO 2 Me A
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
B
320
Table I (cont.) A(%)
B(%)
Me
82
77
Me
Et
67
84(E+Z)
Me
H
46
6 5 ( Z) , 8 (E )
Me
i-Pr
H
74
6 8(Z) ,10(E)
n-Pr
H
59
6 5 ( Z) ,16(E)
MeSCH,
H
56
63 (Z)
C
H
59
73(Z) ,9 (E)
H
33
6 9(Z) ,OH
6H5 ACOC,H . b 4
Conjugate addition of phenyl or benzyl selenol allowed selective protection of the double bond. The carbon-selenium bond is stable to acid so that deblocking with HC1 in anhydrous solvents can be carried out. Whereas enamines are very weak bases so that direct coupling to the amino group of a dehydro amino ester can be difficult,^ selenium addition restores normal basicity. The selenol reaction was run in refluxing THF with a 3-fold excess of selenol and a catalytic amount of NaOMe. R^-C-H
R^CHSeBz1 B0C-NHCHC02Me
BOC-NHCCO^Me R2
R-^CHSeBzl H 2 NCHC0 2 Me-HCl CHR,
R^CHSeBzl
B0C-NHCHC0NHCHC02Me
B0C-NHCHC0NHCC02Me E/Z
1-10
The double bond was regenerated by mild oxidation to the selenoxide and spontaneous elimination of a seleninic acid. Since addition is trans and elimination is cis, the consecu-
321
tive reactions should convert a Z dehydro amino acid to an E dehydro amino acid. This has been achieved and derivatives £ of A amino acids can be obtained pure in quantity. Also, E Z protected A and A amino acids and peptides are usually easy to separate by silica gel chromatography.
The reaction was
done in chloroform at -20° using one equivalent of m-chloroperbenzoic acid.
We found that addition of triethyl amine
improved the yield and prevented equilibration so that the E:Z ratio in the dehydro product agreed with the ratio of diastereoisomers in the starting selenium adduct.
The results
of one study are shown in Table II. Table II CHCHMe 2 B0C-NHCC0 2 Me Starting Material
^ ^
Yield (%) Diastereoisomer Ratio
BzlSeCHCHMe 2 B0C-NHCHC0 2 Me E t^N
Yield
(%) Ratio
AZ
80, 8.5
+
85E, 10Z
-
6 0E, 14Z
4.3
AE
77 , 2
+
65E, 27Z
2. 4
-
44E, 33Z
1. 3
Aliphatic A
Z
and A
E
8.5
protected amino acids and peptides
saponify normally and the resulting carboxyl group coupled Z E satisfactorily. This was also true of A -Phe. However, A Phe is susceptible to base catalyzed inversion to the Z 4 E isomer. E.g., Boc-Gly-A -Phe-OMe with hydroxide yielded 2 Boc-Gly-A -Phe-OH. But, saponification with aqueous methanolic potassium carbonate gave jrunrearranged E product. Coupling experiments with Boc-Gly-A -Phe-OH using either mixed anhydride or dicyclohexyl-carbodiimide gave mixtures of tripeptides having an E/Z ratio of about 1.5.
322 R,-C-H 1
II __> BOC-NHCCO^Me
R.—C—H 1
II B0C-NHCC0 H 2
R 1
>
-C-H
II I' B0C-NHCC0NHCHC0 Me 2
Z (or E)
References 1.
D. Hoppe: Angew. Chem. internat. Edit., 12^ 656 (1973)
2.
D. Hoppe; Angew. Chem. internat. Edit., .LI, 933 (1972)
3.
E. G. Breitholle and C. H. Stammer; J. Org. Chem., 41, 1344 (1976).
4.
T. J. Nitz, E. M. Holt, B. Rubin, and C. H. Stammer; J. Org. Chem., 46, 2667 (1981).
a- HY D R OXY MET HY LA T10N OF PEPTIDES: A SYNTHETIC ROUTE TO PEPTIDES CONTAINING a -IIYDR OXY MET HY LA MI NO ACIDS
Z.J.Kamihski, Li.T.Leplawy, Urszula Slomczynska Institute of Organic Chemistry, Technical University 90-924 Lodz, Poland
Due to steric hindrance, usual coupling methods are of limited value for incorporating a-hydroxymethy1-amino acids into peptide chain. Our work on a-hydroxyme thylation of amino A
.
.
.
acids led us to develop an indirect synthetic approach to peptides containing a-hydroxymethylamino acids, avoiding the use sterically hindered a-hydroxymethylamino acids as coupling components. This approach involves transformation of amino acid already present in the peptide chain into a-hydroxymethylated analogue by selective a-hydroxymethylation of 2
C-terminal moiety. In an earlier report a number of dipeptides have been transformed into corresponding analogues containing C-terminal a-hydroxymethylamino acids, however despite of good yield of conversion, its preparative value was diminished by concomitant racemization, and what more, by lack of the method for determining the enantiomeric purity of a-hydroxymethy lamino acids and their derivatives. These complications have now been mastered, and we are able to 5describe a prep2 arative method which in case of [Aib , Leu ]-enkephalin gives consistently a over-all conversion into well defined 2 5 - 2 5 epimeric [Aib , S-Hmlr]- and [Aib , R-HmL^]-enkephalins (HmL = hydroxymethylleucine). The extention of the method enabling the use hydroxymethylated peptides for fragment condensation is also described. The general synthetic sequence illustrating the transformation of C-terminal amino acid into a-hydroxymethylated analogue is shown on the Scheme.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
324
„1
r2
? » X-Pept-NHCHCGNHCHCOOH
CH3OCOCI
Et 3 N T H F Q O
LH
Rl
X-Pfept-NHCH-
COOCHn
1
CH2O/H2O/THF picoline, 5 h
*
X-Pept-NHCH R2
O
1) resolution by gel chromatography 2) IN NaOH, 25°,6h R^ 1 X-Pept-NHCHCO-NH-C—COOH Rl
4a
ch 2 oh
R1
ch 2 oh
X-Pept-NHCHCO-NH-Ç-COOH 4b
R2
The f o u r s t e p s i n v o l v e f o r m a t i o n of 1 , 3 - o x a z o l e d e r i v a t i v e 2 a s a r e s u l t of w e l l known r e a c t i o n with methyl c a r b o n o c h l o r i d a te i n the p r e s e n c e of t r i e t h y l a m i n e , subsequent r i n g enlargement to the 4-0X0-1,3-dioxane £ by i n s e r t i o n of 2 m o l e c u l e s of f o r maldehyde ( f o r m e c h a n i s t i c i n t e r p r e t a t i o n s e e r e f e r e n c e s 2 , 3» 4 ) , r e s o l u t i o n of d i a s t e r e o i s o m e r i c 5 - p e p t i d y l a m i n o - 4 - o x o - 1 , 3 dioxanes by g e l chromatography and f i n a l h y d r o l y t i c d e g r a d a t i o n of 4 - o x o - 1 , 3 - d i o x a n e r i n g r e s u l t i n g i n f o r m a t i o n of c o r r e s p o n d i n g C - t e r m i n a l a-hydroxymethylamino a c i d 4 . At t h i s time our most e f f i c i e n t example i s p r o v i d e d by t r a n s f o r m a t i o n 2 of p r o t e c t e d [Aib , Leu ] - e n k e p h a l i n . Hydroxymethylation of Z-Ty r(Bu^)-A ib-Gly -Phe—LeuOH gave a mixture of d i a s t e r e o i s o m e r i c 4-0X0-1,3-dioxane s Z-TyriBu^-Aib-Gly-Phel iBu*
325
i n 86>o y i e l d . They were s e p a r a t e d i n t o o p t i c a l l y pure 5S- and 5R-epimers by s h o r t column s i l i c a g e l (Merck, H-60) chromatog r a p h y . O p t i c a l p u r i t y proof (GLC a f t e r c o n v e r s i o n of the h y d r o l y s i s p r o d u c t s i n t o t h e i r N-L- a - c h l o r o i s o v a l e r y l - O - t r i methylsilyl methyl e s t e r s ) , and the f u l l a n a l y t i c a l and s p e c t r o s c o p i c d e t a i l s are a v a i l a b l e . A f t e r h y d r o l y t i c degrad a t i o n of 4—oxo-1,3-dioxane r i n g , b o t h 5 - e p i m e r s of Z-Tyr(Bu^)-Aib-Gly-Phe-HmL were o b t a i n e d i n over-all yield (equimolar a m o u n t s ) . Examination of the r e a c t i v i t y of 2 - p e p t i d y l - a m i n o - 4 - o x o - 1 , 3 - d i o x a n e s r e v e a l e d t h a t 4 - o x o - 1 , 3 - d i o x a n e system i s s t a b l e enough t o s u r v i v e amino group d e p r o t e c t i o n and p e p t i d e c o u p l i n g Scheme i l l u s t r a t i n g the use of p e p t i d y l a m i n o - 4 - o x o - 1 , 3 aioxane f o r [Aib2, HmL 5 ' J - e n k e p h a l i n s y n t h e s i s by f r a g m e n t c o n d e n s a t i o n Tyr
Aib
Gly
Phe
Leu •OH
I
r^i u.—hydroxymethylation % ;: m . N H | ] t^(• 7( 777% mixture of diastereoisomers)
(epimer after resolution) ¡Bug But -OH H-
NH [
' 100%
iBu Q Bu 1
z-
,Bu
l
.NH, i bu""
u
I I
82% ch2oh NH-C-COOH ¡bu
326
conditions; this permitted the use of peptidelamino-4-oxo-1,5-dioxanes as OH and COOH protected intermediates for fragment condensation and consequent extention of synthetic potential of a-hydroxymethylation (Scheme on the preceding page) . No method for determining the enantiomeric purity of a-hydroxyme thy 1-amino- acids is reported. iVe developed GI£ system which gave satisfactory results in separation of enantiomers of a-hydroxymethylated alanine, leucine, metionine, ethylglycine, phenylglycine. Separation of enantiomers of a-bydroxymethylphenylalanine and a-hydroxymethylvaline was incomplete. The method consists in converting the a-hydroxyme thy laiaino acid to its N-L-a-chloroisovaleryl-O-trimethylsilyl methyl ester. The resulting diastereomeric derivatives were analysed on 50m 0V-101 capillary column. The method is applicable to samples contaminated by the unhydroxymethylated amino acids and in effect permits the determining optical purity of a-hydroxymethyrlamino acids incorporated into peptide chain. Other approaches including the use of chiral stationary phase and nmr spectroscopy failed. Stereochemistry of cn.-hydroxymethy 1 leucine (HmL) is not known. To assign confi2 5 guration of HmL present in [Aib , Hmlj ]-enkephalin we made use of empirical rule based on results obtained in the separation of the known a-hydroxymethylamino acids. According to it, S-enantiomers have longer retention time than E-isomers. ACKNOWLEDGMENT The authors acknowledge financial support for this work by a grant MR-1.12.1.6.10 from the Polish Academy of Sciences REFERENCES 1. Kaminski Z.J., Leplawy M.T C , Zabrocki J., Synthesis 1973. 792; Leplawy M.T., Olma A., Polish J.Chem. 353 (W/3). 2. Kaminski Z.J., Leplawy M.T., Slomczyhska TJ., Synthesis m i , (593). 3. S teg lie h '.v., HOfle G., Chem.Ber. 102. 1129 (1969). Kaminski Z.J., Leplawy M.T., Olma A., Slomczynska U., Peptides 1978, Proc. 15th Eurp. Peptide Symposium, Wroclaw Press, Poland 1979, p. 113.
L-OC-AMINOADIPIC ACID Ö-N-BENZYLOXYCARBONYLAMIDE AND ITS USE IN PEPTIDE SYNTHESIS
Bogdan Ldberek, Regina Kasprzykowska
(Jablonska)
Institute of Chemistry, University of Gdansk PL-80-952 Gdansk, Poland
Introduc tion A route to LF-0(-aminoadipic acid
(Aad) from L-lysine was pre-
sented on the l6th EPS (l). The starting material was Lys(Z) and the key intermediate the E-oxidation product I. This compound is interesting for peptide syntheses involving L-oc-aminoadipic acid. ^H^CH-COOH (CH 2 ) -CO-NH-Z
&
L-Aad(NHZj
(i)
Amino protection Highest yields of Z-Aad(NHZ) and Boc-Aad(NHZ) are obtained w i t h mixed benzyl 8-hydroxyquinoline carbonate and di-tert-butyl dicarbonate. Other procedures gave lower yields and usually mixtures of products.
Esterification of the (X-carboxylic group Methyl ester with the intact 6-CONHZ grouping can be prepared by the action of diazomethane. Attempts to prepare Aad(NHZ)OMe by typical procedures of peptide chemistry (MeOH/HCl, MeOH/ /S0C1„) gave mixtures of products. Hydrochloride of
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
328
Aad(NHZ)OBu^ was obtained by Taschner s transesterification method with tert-butyl acetate. Procedures with isobutene gave mixtures of products. Benzyl monoester with the intact 6-CONHZ was prepared only from amino protected derivative by Williamson ester synthesis using benzyl bromide and dicyclohexylamine. Boc-AadiNHZjOBu* t
could be prepared by Taschner s transesterification method followed by acylation.
Peptide bond formation; reactivity of the 6-CONHZ grouping Model peptides with L-Aad(NHZ) residue incorporated to peptide chain were prepared. For activation and coupling of amino protected Aad(NHZ), EEDQ method, DCCX + HONSu procedure or mixed anhydrides are recommended. Monoesters of Aad(NHZ) can be acylated by N-protected amino acids affording peptides with the intact 6-CONHZ grouping. 6-Benzyloxycarbonylamide is susceptible to acid and base catalysed hydrolysis. This enables the easy removal of 6-carboxyl protection in amino acid and peptide derivatives. The unmasked
6 carboxylic group can be activated and 5-peptide bond
formed. In some cases the formation of cyano derivatives was observed in the presence of dehydration and activation reagents. The 6-C0-NH-C0-0-CH 2 C 6 H 5 derivative - containing an
"activated"
6-carboxylic group - is not suitable intermediate for controlled and repeated formation of the 6-peptide bond. The nucleophilic attack, may proceed either on the 6-carbonyl or on the urethan carbonyl. For instance, base-catalysed hydrolysis gave easily benzyl urethan on an alternative pathway to the normal route of hydrolysis.
329
R-CO-NH-CO-O-Bzl
RCOOH + NH 2 -Z RCONH2+ C0 2 + BzlOH
1
A m i n o l y s i s may p r o c e e d i n t r a m o l e c u l a r l y
or
intermolecularly.
On p r o l o n g e d h e a t i n g Aad(NHZ)Bu^ a f f o r d e d t h e tert-butyl lecular
e s t e r of
6-lactam d e r i v a t i v e
condensation
—
(Aad-OBut) * I 'n
Aad-OBu*
I
NH 2 -Z
+
6 CO-NH-Z g r o u p i n g
on CX .«
NH 2 -Z
6 acyl
ted products
of
(Z-Aad(NH2), »-6
esters
Characteristic Z-Aad(NHZ),
of
of
m.p.
derivatives
HCl.Aad(NHZ)OMe,
62-64° m.p.
m.p. m.p.
Boc-Aad(NHZ)0NSu, Z-Aad(NHZ)-GlyOMe,
l4l-l42° 102-104°
67-69°
m.p. m.p.
gave only
Boc-Aad(NH2),
147-149°
HCl.Aad(NHZ)OBut,
pep-
1 M HCl/
Z - and B o c - L - a d i p a m i c
150-152° 100-102°
the
expec-
Boc-Aad).
- w e l l known f r o m
- was f o u n d .
some Aad
Boc-Aad(NHZ) , m.p.
Z-Aad(NHZ)OBzl,
Z-Aad,
a.cyl s h i f t
and g l u t a m i c a c i d s f i e l d
of
shift
( Z - A a d ( N H 2 ) 0 M e and B o c - A a d ( N H 2 ) O M e )
e v i d e n c e f o r CX
treatments
30 m i n ) .
Base-catalysed hydrolysis acid
(n+l)
(AcOH/EtOH, N E t 3 / C H 2 C l 2 ,
k M HCl/dioxan f o r
Investigation
Aad(NHZ)OBu t
survived the usual
t i d e s o l i d phase s y n t h e s i s /AcOH,
intermo-
Aad-OBu t I
The
the
product.
Aad(NHZ) OBu*"
+
respective
besides
No
aspartic
330 Z-Aad-OBzl,
m.p.
Z-Aad(ONSu)OMe,
90-92° m.p.
Z-Gly-Aad(NHZ)OBut, Z-Gly-Aad(NHZ)OMe, Z-Aad-NH2,
m.p.
Z-Aad(NHZ)NH2, Z-Aad,
m.p.
m.p.
117-120°
151-153°
129-132°
Boc-Aad(NHZ)NH2,
m.p. m.p.
73-75° l47-l49°
c i t e d compounds g a v e c o r r e c t
Rp v a l u e s were
m.p.
96-97°
l40-l42°
Z-Aad(NH2)0Bzl,
All
45-47° m.p.
(TLC)
I n 12 s o l v e n t
C,H,N
systems,
analyses; and o p t i c a l
rotations
measured.
References 1.
Liberek, B., Jablonska, EPS, H e l s i n g ^ r Denmark, p . 242.
R . : P e p t i d e s 1980, P r o c . l 6 t h S c r i p t o r , Copenhagen 1981,
SYNTHESIS OF ß-HOMO-L-PROLINE ANALOGUES OF PEPTIDE HORMONES
Krzysztof Baiikowski and Aleksandra Misicka Laboratory of Peptides, Department of Chemistry, University of Warsaw, 02-093 Warsaw, Poland
Introduction Some of (i-homo-L-amino acids have already been introduced in peptide hormones in the hope of obtaining analogues that possess the desired biological activities and are not susceptible to enzymatic degradation. In some cases expected properties were found, for example,
|]3-homo-Pro] ''-bra.dykinin appea-
red to be equipotent with bradykinin and resistent to enzymatic cleavage
(l).
In the course of investigation on chemical structure - biological activity relationship we undertook the synthesis of fi-homo-L-proline analogues of thyreoliberin (TRH), MSH release-inhibiting factor (MIF) and oxytocin (OT).
Synthesis The protected [3-homo-L-proline intermediates were obtained by homologation of the corresponding L—Pro derivatives according to the Arndt-Eistert scheme. The preparation of carbobenzoxy(Z) derivatives followed the technique described by Balaspiri et al. (2); Boc derivatives were synthesized according to Ondetti et al. (l). The following compounds were obtained: Z-[3-homo-Pro-0Me, Z-(3-homo-Pro (m.p. 72-74°C, described as an oil (2)), Z-(J-homo-Pro-NH2, Boc-fi-homo-Pro-OMe, Boc-P-homo-Pro, Boc-|3-homo-Pro-NH2. In our hands Ondetti s procedure
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
332 was more convenient; we found that purification of Boc intermediates was not necessary if final Boc-fi—homo-Pro was purified by recrystallization of its dicyclohexylammonium salt. Splitting of protecting groups from substituted amides gave (i-homo-Pro-NH„ which was used for coupling with pGlu-His by DCC/HOBt method to give [(i-homo-Pro] -TRH. Z-(i-homo-Pro was coupled with Leu-Gly-OEt by mixed anhydride procedure to give protected tripeptide used in the synthesis of [G-homo-Pro] 1 -MIF. Boc-(i-homo-Pro was used in solid phase synthesis of [(i-homo-Pro^j ^-OT. Protected nonapeptide amide Z-Cys(Bzl)-Tyr(Bzl)-Xle-Gln-Asn-Cys(Bzl)-(i-homo-Pro-Leu-Gly-NH 2 was treated with Na/NH^ liq., oxidized with I^/MeOH and purified by column chromatography on silica gel column followed by gel filtration on Sephadex G-15. Biological activities of these analogues are under investigation.
Acknowledgement This work was supported in part by the Polish Academy of Sciences within the projects No MR 1-12 and MR 11-10.
References 1.
Bala spiri, L. , Perike, B. , Papp, Gy. , Dombi, Gy. , Kova.cs, K.: Helv. Chira. Acta 58, 969-973 (1975).
2.
Ondetti, M.A., Engel, S.L.: J. Med. Chem. 18, 761-763 (1975). ""
OPTICALLY ACTIVE NEOPENTYLGLYCINE AND ITS APPLICATIONS IN PEPTIDE CHEMISTRY
Jan Pospisek and Karel Blaha Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences, 166 10 Prague 6, Czechoslovakia.
Introduction Non-proteogenic amino acids (l-3) are useful in physicochemical (4,5) and biological (6) studies. Investigations of this kind require amino acids with pronounced manifestation of single structural features (bulkiness of the side-chain, hydrophobic! ty, etc.). Neopentylglycine (IV, 2-amino-4,4-dimethylpentanoic acid, Neo) represents one of such amino acids. In comparison with tert-leucine, the bulky tert-butyl group is in IV separated by one methylene group from the backbone. Two synthetic pathways (7,8) leading to IV have been described. We report now another synthesis of IV and also some experiments which show that the neopentylglycine (IV) can be used without difficulty in peptide syntheses.
Results 2-Cyano-4,4-dimethyl-2-pentenoic acid (i) was hydrogenated over Pd-bla.ck in acetic acid to give 2-cyano-4,4-dimethylpentanoic acid (il) in 98% yield. Treatment of II with alkaline hydrogen peroxide afforded 2-ca.rbamoyl-4,4-dimethylpentanoic acid (ill), m.p, 150-151°C, in 50% yield. Hypobromite degradation oX" III produced in quantitative yield D,L-neopentylglycine (iv) which was purified by elution with 55° amino-
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
334
nium h y d r o x i d e f r o m Dowex-50 (CH3)3C-CH=C-COOH
(Scheme »-
l).
(CH3)3C-CH2-CH-COOH
CN
CN
I
II
(CH3)3C-CH2-CH-COOH
(CH3)3C-CH2-CH-COOH
CONH 2
NH2
III
IV Scheme
Table
1
1
N-Substituted derivatives Deriva t i v e
Yield
of
L-neopentylglycine
[ext., s o l v e n t o„ m.p., C
$
Calcula ted/Found
za
55
-12.5°,methanol 15^-155
Boc
90
+13.9°,methanol IO2-IO3
NPSa
87
-49.7°,dimethylformamide 163-165
3
D,L
Dicyclohexylainmoniuin
lo C
till
r 0CH 3 1 I if Pyridine N • Trt-N'VV HN03-H2N-Sr Y^ 2) H2S 0 0 H 0 0 3
2
H NH 2-N ^oEt
H
0CH3
S 0
o c h 3J
]]
och3
0
HO'N^N-Sr^
8
o
S-n
H
0 -ONb: -0-N
1) HF-ani sole 2) NEt, '
0CH3
S Loh
0
althiomycin (1)
(ii) Photoreaction with diketene.
Fig. 2. Synthesis of Althiomycin.
0
343 A c c o r d i n g to this p a t h w a y ,
f i r s t the a c t i v e e s t e r
p r e p a r e d from N,S-ditritylcysteine endo-2,3-dicarboxyimide
and
ii-hydroxy-5-norbornene-
(HONb), w a s c o u p l e d w i t h
p y r r o l i n - 2 - o n e s o d i u m salt.
(2),
4-methoxy-3-
The c o m p o u n d thus o b t a i n e d w a s
d e t r i t y l a t e d i n the u s u a l w a y to g i v e the c y s t e i n e
derivative
(£) w i t h free a m i n o a n d m e r c a p t o g r o u p s w h i c h w a s t h e n c o u p l e d Q\
w i t h the imino e t h e r of b e n z y l o x y c a r b o n y l g l y c i n e the t h i a z o l i n e d e r i v a t i v e
.
to a f f o r d
The total y i e l d from
ditrityl-
c y s t e i n e to this c o m p o u n d t h r o u g h the r o u t e m e n t i o n e d a b o v e w a s m u c h h i g h e r t h a n t h a t via
the p h o t o r e a c t i o n .
T h e f o r m a t i o n s of
the imide b o n d a n d the t h i a z o l i n e ring in the c o u m p o u n d
(50
c o m f i r m e d by the d o w n f i e l d s h i f t of the m e t h y l e n e p r o t o n s p y r r o l i n e ring
(0.3 p p m ) , a n d the l o n g - r a n g e c o u p l i n g
exo m e t h y l e n e a n d C-4 of the t h i a z o l i n e r i n g ly in N M R s p e c t r u m . pyrroline compound
(2 Hz)
A l d o l c o n d e n s a t i o n of the (5) w i t h f o r m a l i n
(35%)
between
respective-
thiazoline-
in d i m e t h y l
sulfoxide
a t r o o m t e m p e r a t u r e a f f o r d e d the m i x t u r e of the d e s i r e d methylated derivative
were
in
hydroxy-
(£) a n d its a n h y d r o c o m p o u n d . H o w e v e r , by
u s e of p a r a f o r m a l d e h y d e i n s t e a d of f o r m a l i n , this r e a c t i o n g a v e only the h y d r o x y m e t h y l a t e d p r o d u c t
(£)
quantitatively.
In the final step of the s y n t h e s i s of a l t h i o m y c i n , hydroxymethyl derivative
(6) w a s d e b l o c k e d w i t h
the
anhydrous
h y d r o g e n f l u o r i d e i n the p r e s e n c e of a n i s o l e , a n d t h e n c o u p l e d w i t h the o x i m e of t h i a z o l e c a r b o x a z i d e f o r m a m i d e a t 5 °C for 5 d a y s .
(8) in
N,^-dimethyl-
Synthetic althiomycin which was
i s o l a t e d a n d p u r i f i e d by p r e p a r a t i v e t h i n - l a y e r (chloroform-methanol
9:1)
chromatography
was identical with natural
althio-
m y c i n i n all r e s p e c t s i n c l u d i n g T L C a n d H P L C . T h e m e a s u r e m e n t s of the b i o l o g i c a l a c t i v i t y of a l t h i o m y c i n a n d its f r a g m e n t as w e l l as the
synthetic
dehydroxymethyl
a n a l o g s are now i n p r o g r e s s .
References 1.
H. Y a m a g u c h i , Y. N a k a y a m a , K. T a k e d a , K. T a w a r a , K. M a e d a ,
344 T. Takeuchi, and H. Umezawa, J. Antibiot. A 10, 195 (1957). 2.
H. Fujimoto, T. Kinoshita, H. Suzuki, and H. Umezawa,
3.
H. Sakakibara, H. Naganawa, M. Ohno, K. Maeda, and H.
J. Antibiot. 22, 271 (1970). Umezawa, J. Antibiot. 27, 897 (1974); H. Nakamura, Y. Iitaka, H. Sakakibara, and H. Umezawa, ibid. 21_, 894 (1974). 4.
H. A. Kirst, E. F. Szymanski, D. E. Dormon, J. L. Occolowitz, N. D. Jones, M. 0. Chaney, R. L. Hamill, and M. M. Hoehin, J. Antibiot. 28, 286
5.
(1975).
T. Shiba, K. Inami, K. Sawada, and Y. Hirotsu, Heterocycles 13, 175 (1979).
6.
K. Inami, Y. Saito, and T. Shiba, Peptide Chemistry 1981,
7.
T. Shiba, K. Sawada, and Y. Hirotsu, Heterocycles 10_, 133
8.
Y. Hirotsu, T. Shiba, and T. Kaneko, Bull. Chem. Soc. Jpn.
137 (1982) . (1978). 40, 2945 (1967).
PEPTIDE TRICYCLIC THIA-CYCLOLS FROM LINEAR PRECURSORS
Giancarlo Z a n o t t i , Francesco Pinnen, Gino Lucente I s t i t u t o di Chimica Farmaceutica - Centro di Studio per la Chimica del Farmaco del C.N.R. - Città U n i v e r s i t a r i a 00100 - Roma - I t a l y
S i l v i o C e r r i n i , Walter F e d e l i , Fernando Mazza Laboratorio di S t r u t t u r i s t i c a Chimica " Giordano Giacomello " , C.N.R. c.P. 10 00016 - Monterotondo Stazione - Roma - I t a l y .
The chemistry of the oligo-cyclopeptides as valuable model systems for the elucidation of protein stucture, i s s t r i c t l y related to cyclol format i o n . C y c l o l i c tautomers are apparently stable forms of the nine-membered c y c l o - t r i p e p t i d e s in which a residue of a primary amino acid i s contained. In a preceedina paper^ we reported the synthesis of a peptidic t h i a - c y c l o l a compound which i s representative of a new c l a s s of cyclopeptides related to natural E r g o t - a l k a l o i d s . The f i r s t synthetic approach, in which an N-acyl-diketopiperazine was used as key intermediate, afforded t h i a - c y c l o l (1) whose stereochemistry i s d i f f e r e n t from that found in natural oxac y c l o l s . The synthesis of stable t h i a - c y c l o l s possessing the same stereochemistry zed
which i s found in natural E r g o t - a l k a l o i d s , has now been r e a l i -
through d i r e c t c y c l i z a t i o n of 2-mercaptopropionyl-dipeptides
p-nitro-
phenylesters. The synthetic strategy to achieve these l i n e a r precursors required the use of a thiol protecting group s e l e c t i v e l y removable under mild non-oxidative conditions so as to avoid any involvment of the a c t i v a ted carboxyl function and/or of the f i n a l c y c l i c product. Use of the t e r t butylmercapto group
2
was i n i t i a l l y discarded due to the d i f f i c u l t i e s
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
346 encountered during the synthesis of 2-(S-tert-butylmercapto)-mercaptopropionic acid . The acetamidomethyl group, because of its reported attitude 3 to be easily removed by mercury ions , was then considered and adopted in a sequence of steps which led eventually to 2(-S-acetamidomethyl)-mercaptopropionyl-Phe-Pro-ONp. Unfortunately, treatment of this active ester with mercury ions did not proceed satisfactorily. The problem was solved,as shown in the Scheme, by using the acetamidomethyl group during the early steps of the synthesis and by changing to the tert-butylmercapto group in the last steps. Thia-cyclols (4) and (5) were obtained in a single step by deprotecting S-tert-butylmercapto active esters (2) and (3) with tri-nbutyl-phosphine in a dilute solution of 70% aqueous propanol. The cyclolic structure assigned to (4) and (5) is based on spectroscopic data and for compound (5) is supported by X-ray crystallographic analysis. The i.r. spectrum (CHC1 ) of the thia-cyclols show a broad OH absorption centred at 3300 cm
-1
and two carbonyl bands at 1680 and 1650 cm
-1
; no absorptions
are observed in the ranges of amide second band and sulfur-hydrogen bond.
fHjPh CR®
CH-t-Acm
.
H^tCH
CO2H
f-^^l
CO-N
.
L e o
(R.S) C H - H l .
M.
CO-NH-CM-CO-«
COjMa CO^Me Ochromateflraphic aaparation lategra* ef diaateraoieomers itaraoiM A d t p r o t K t i a n with >2
Mi CM-»«.tBii [" CO-HH-CH-CO H CH-Ph CO
D OH~ aXM«)3C•SH/o2
""I I COOWp
3) p nrtrophewl/ DCCI '
- - S ^ H WandCS) CO-NH-ipH-CO
a c t i v e .«tar R . S . S
C3) a c t i v e aatar S . S . S
tri-n-butylphoephine
4—>L (4)
O'
X
'L,^ il ^ Scheme
o
C02M.
347 In lH nmr spectra the OH signal appears as a doublet at co
O) co I
rol Z5 a) i CD
-o
o_
CM
O)
"tul I
13 a> i
cu
i c
"5. JZ 1
I ,
x: 0 1
I
O
O
o
o
NI •O O
NI -O O
I
i CM
a)
a) •a 4-1 a) a) C¡ rH •tí o. m raß ra e rao »H O o • H P. O •O a)
—
a>
T
O tí ra
t—1
NI QQ O
o reí i i_ a> co i a>
01 • H ai 4J
•H
I
cu oo
O i
4-1 i H
cid
tí o
O. o
O a>
ai T-H 0 a) 4-1 W en 00 C 0 o
1 •O 0 •H
I
I
i O i o
i
360
treatment with a large molar excess of Cbz-glycine / carbonyldiimidazole in methylene chloride.
The product was isolated by HPLC in the same iso-
propanol / 0.1% TFA gradient described above. double absorbance at 210 nm and at 260 nm.
It was identified by its
Its identity was confirmed by
amino acid analysis of acid hydrolysates.
The benzyl ester of allothreonine was coupled with Boc-serine by treatment with one equivalent each of N-methylmorpholine and dicyclohexylcarbodiimide in methylene chloride.
S-(2,3-dihydroxypropyl)-cysteine was pre-
pared by treatment of L-cysteine with glycidol at pH 9.
The material
crystallized as a half hydrate from isopropanol / water, it comigrated with aspartic acid on the amino acid analyzer (5), and it was completely destroyed by periodate oxidation.
Repeated treatments with methanolic HC1
gave the methyl ester which was treated with methanolic ammonia to obtain the amide hydrochloride as a hydroscopic, but electrophoretically homogeneous solid.
Coupling of saponified globomycin with this product has
yielded a crude globomycin analog containing S-(2,3-dihydroxypropyl)cysteine, but the material must be further purified before biological evaluation.
ACKNOWLEDGMENT:
This work was supported by grants GM-19043 and AM 10080 from the National Institutes of Health.
References 1.
Inukai, M. , Takeuchi, M. , Shimizu, K. and Arai, M. : J. Antibiotics _31 1203-1205 (1978).
2.
Inukai, M.; Personal Communication.
3.
Inouye, S., Wang, S., Sekizawa, J., Halegoua, S., and Inouye, M.; Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. US, 74 1004-1008 (1977).
4.
Maeda, T., Glass, J., and Inouye, M.; J. Biol. Chem. 256 4712-4714 (1981).
5.
Hantke, K., and Braun, V. ; Eur. J. Biochem. 34 284-296 (1973).
SEMISYNTHETIC STUDIES ON THE BOVINE TRYPSIN-KALLIKREIN INHIBITOR
Laura Biondi, Bruno Filippi, Fernando Filira, Virgilio Giormani, and Raniero Rocchi Centro di Studio sui Biopolimeri del C.N.R., Istituto di Chimica Organica dell'Università di Padova, 35100 Padova, Italia
Introduction
Bovine trypsin-kallikrein inhibitor (BTI) is a single chain protein of 58 amino acid residues containing three disulfide bridges (1, 2, 3, 4). The fully reduced inhibitor may be refo_l ded by air oxidation with nearly complete recovery of the inhi bition capacity (4). Chemical syntheses of the inhibitor have been achieved in different laboratories (for references see 5) and the partial synthesis of a fully active 52-homoserine-BTI has also been described (6, 7). Preparation of an active derivative of BTI in which the reactive site peptide bond Lys 15Ala 16 is cleaved (BTI*)(8, 9) opened the way to a series of elegant experiments through which reactive site modifications have been achieved (9). We decided to develop a semisynthesis of BTI which would allow the efficient preparation of analogs of the amino terminal region. The semisynthetic scheme used is shown in Figure 1. Since guanidination of the e-amino function of the four lysine residues and subsequent removal of the amino terminal tripeptide Arg-Pro-Asp do not affect the inhibitory capacity (10), the synthesis was designed to prepare a des (1-3) inhibitor derivative in which three out of four lysine residues (positions 26, 41, and 46) are replaced by homoarginine residues [des(l-3)-3-Guan-BTl] .
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
362
Figure 1. Semisynthesis of des(1-3)-3-Guan-BTI
363 Results Preliminary experiments showed that even the fully reduced, te traguanidinated native inhibitor (4-Guan-BTI) may be refolded by air oxidation with nearly complete recovery of its inhibiting capacity. To ascertain if truncated derivatives of 4-Guan-BTI were still able to undergo the correct refolding by air oxidation, the des(l)-, des(l,2)-, and des(1-3)-sequences have been prepared by successive Edman degradations (11) of 4-Guan-BTI. The degradation reactions were followed by determining, at each step, the amino acid composition and the inhibitory po wer of the isolated material. amino acid composition Arg
Pro
% BTI activity
Asp
A
B
4-Guan-BTI
6 .0(6)
4 .1(4) ,
5 .0(5)
100
100
Des(1)-4-Guan-BTI
5 .0(5)
4 .0(4) .
, 5 .0(5)
100
100
Des(1,2)-4-Guan-BTI
5 .0(5)
3..1(3)
4 .9 (5)
>95
> 95
Des(1-3)-4-Guan-BTI
5 .1(5)
3..1(3)
4 .1(4) .
>95
100
Table. Amino acid content and inhibitory capacity of the indicated 4-Guan-BTI derivatives before (A) and after (B) reduction and reoxidation. The reoxidized compounds have been purified by affinity chromatography on trypsinSepharose. The values denote number of residues per molecule. Only pertinent amino acids are included. All truncated sequences showed to posses nearly full inhibitory capacity against trypsin (12). Reduction followed by air oxidation yielded fully active
inhibitor derivatives. The mo-
dified inhibitor (BTI*) consists of two peptide chains linked through the disulfide bridges Cys 5-Cys 55 and Cys 14-Cys 38. The shorter segment corresponds to the sequence 1-15 of BTI and the larger one to sequence 16-58. By analogy with the nomenclature used for the ribonuclease S-peptide and S-protein (13) and considering that the selective cleavage of the
Lys
364 15-Ala 16 reactive site peptide bond has been achieved by try£ tic digestion (8), the 1-15 and 16-58 segments are respectively defined as T-peptide and T-protein. Reaction of BTI* with O-methylisourea converts essentially all lysines into homoarg^ nine residues yielding the tetraguanidinated modified inhibitor (4-Guan-BTI*). The a-amino functions of Arg 1 and Ala 16 are not significantly affected by the modification reaction,
as
shown by the amino acid analysis and determination of the amino terminal residues of 4-Guan-BTI* (14), and remain the only accessible sites of coupling with a carboxyl-activated, suitably protected peptide. The synthesis in solution of the protec ted 12-peptide hydrazide Msc-Phe-Cys(Acm)-Leu-Glu-Pro-Pro-Tyr-Thr-Gly-Pro-Cys (Acm)-Lys (Tf a) - ^ H ^ , corresponding to the sequence 4-15 of BTI [des(1-3)-T-peptide] , has been carried out through the fragment condensation procedure (Figure 2).
Msc-Phe-Cys(Acm)-Leu-N H -Boc 4 6 t Z-Glu(OBu )-Pro-Pro-Tyr-Thr-N29H29-Boc 7 11 Trt-Gly-Pro-Cys(Acm)-Lys(Tfa)-N„H -Boc 2 2 12 15
TFA
Acm Acm Tfa Msc-Phe-Cys-Leu-Glu-Pro-Pro-Tyr-Thr-Gly-Pro-Cys-Lys-N7H 2 3 Figure 2. Synthesis of 4-15 sequence of BTI
Classical carboxyl activation, carboxyl and amino protection, and deblocking procedures were used during the synthesis. Coupling experiments have been carried out by reacting, through
365
the azide procedure, the synthetic des(1-3)-T-peptide hydrazide (6 eq.) with 4-Guan-BTI* in DMF/DMSO mixture (1:1, v/v). The reaction product was isolated, treated with 1 M piperidine, and finally dissolved in 5% aqueous acetic acid. Some insolu1ble material was removed by centrifugation and the supernatant was fractionated by gel-filtration on Sephadex G 50, and purified by ion-exchange chromatography on CM-Sephadex C 25 and gel-filtration on Sephadex G 25. Comparison of the amino acid composition of 4-Guan-BTI* and of the isolated material indica ted that the a-amino group of both Arg 1 and Ala 16 have been acylated. The diacylated derivative was treated with mercuric acetate in 50% acetic acid (15), to remove the acetamidomethyl groups, and fully reduced with 1,4-dithiothreitol (DTT) in 8 M urea, pH 8.6. Gel filtration on a Sephadex G 50 column, eluted with 5% acetic acid, allowed to isolate the reduced des (1-3)-3-Guan-BTI. The protein containing fractions were combined, the resulting aqueous solution was gradually brought to pH 8.0 by extensive dialysis against 0.02 M sodium phosphate buffer (pH 8.0), and the reduced product was renatured by air oxidation. Determination of the inhibitory capacity (12) indicated that the semisynthetic 3-Guan-BTI was about 10% effective in inhibiting the tryptic hydrolysis of the N^-benzoy1-L-arginine-4-nitroanilide. Further purification by affinity chromatography raised the inhibitory activity to 40-45% but full activity was not obtained. A possible explanation of this result could be found in side reactions occurring during the removal of methylsulphonylethyloxycarbonyl
(Msc) protecting group. Deblock-
ing experiments, carried out on both the synthetic des (1-3)-T-peptide and the model compound Msc-Phe-Cys (Acm)-Leu-^I^-Boc, showed that some unidentified products are formed, together with the desired o(-amino free compounds, by treatment either with 1 M piperidine or with the mixture dioxan-methanol-4 N NaOH being 0.1 N in base (16). The use of an alternative synthetic route for preparation of des(l-3)-T-peptide is under investigation.
366 Acknowledgements Financial support by the Italian C.N.R. Target-Directed Project "Chimica Fine e Secondaria" is gratefully acknowledged. References 1. Kassell, B., Laskowski, M. Sr.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 20, 463-468 (1965). 2. Chauvet, J., Nouvel, G., Acher, R.: Biochim. Biophys. Acta 115, 121-129 (1966). 3. Dlouha, V., Pospisilova, D., Meloun, B., Sorm, F.: Coll. Czech. Chem. Commun. 31/ 346-352 (1966). 4. Anderer, F. A., Hörnle, S.: J. Biol. Chem. 241, 1568-1572 (1966) 5. Rocchi, R.: in Perspectives in Peptide Chemistry (Eberle, A., Geiger, R., Wieland, T. eds.), Karger, Basel, pp. 318328 (1981). 6. Dyckes, D.F., Creighton, T., Sheppard, R.C.: Nature 247, 202-204 (1974) 7. Dyckes, D.F., Creighton, T., Sheppard, R.C.: Int. J. Peptide Protein Res. 11, 258-268 (1978) 8. Jering, H., Tschesche, H.: Angew. Chem. Int. Engl. Ed. 13, 660-661 (1974). 9. Jering, H., Tschesche, H.: Angew. Chem. Int. Engl. Ed. 13, 662-663 (1974). 10. Kassell, B., Chow, R.B.: Biochemistry 5, 3449-3453 (1966) 11. Edman, P.: Acta. Chem. Scand. 10, 761-768 (1956) 12. Kassell, B.: in Methods in Enzymology (Perlmann, G., Lorand, L. eds.), Academic Press, New York, 19^, 844-852 (1970). 13. Richards, F.M., Vithayathil, P.J.: J. Biol. Chem. 234, 1459-1465 (1959). 14. Gray, W.R.: in Methods in Enzymology (Hirs, C.H.W., Timasheff, S.N. eds.), Academic Press, New York, 2_5, 121-138 (1972) 15. Veber, D. F., Milkowski, J.D., Varga, S.L., Denkewalter, R.G., Hirshmann, R.: J. Am. Chem. Soc. 94, 5456-5461 (1972) 16. Tesser, G. I., Balvert-Geers, I.C.: Int. J. Peptide Protein Res. 7, 295-305 (1975).
SYNTHESIS OF A HYBRID CHICKEN/HUMAN INSULIN
H.-J. Wieneke, G. Wolf, W. Wolff, E. E. Büllesbach, H.-G. Gattner, D. Brandenburg Deutsches Wollforschungsinstitut D 51oo Aachen, Federal Republik of Germany
Introduction Chicken insulin (turkey ins.) is the only known native analogue with enhanced receptor binding and in vitro activity (1, 2). The sequence differs from human insulin in positions A8-1o (HisAsn-Thr), B1, B2, B3o (Ala) and B27 (Ser). In order to detect the molecular basis for high affinity, we have set out to synthesize a series of analogues (3). The first is a hybrid insulin containing a chicken A-chain and human B-chain. In this communication we wish to describe the synthesis of the protected A-chain, its deprotection, conversion to the tetraS-sulphonate form, and its combination with semisynthetic human B1 32 327 B3oi B-chain to yield [Phe , Val , Thr , Thr J chicken insulin.
Results The synthesis was performed by segment condensation in solution. We used trityl groups for protection of the cysteines A6/A7, tert. butyl thio groups for A11- and A2o-Cys, tert. butyl etherand ester groups for the blocking of all hydroxy and carboxyl functions. For temporary protection of a-amino groups the Z- and the Bpoc groups were selected. Removal of these protecting groups was carried out respectively by catalytical hydrogenolysis, and with 80 % acetic acid in the presence of pyridine hydrochloride (4) (method A) or with HC1 in trifluoroethanol (5) (method B). Pep-
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
368
tides were purified by gel chromatography (g. c.) on Sephadex LH-2o in DMF. Plan of synthesis is outlined in the following figure: 1
2
3
U
5
6
7
8
Gly
lie
Vol
Glu
Gin
Cys
Cys
His
9
10
Asn Thr
11
12
13
Cys Ser
H
15
Leu Tyr
Gin
18
19
Leu Glu Asn
16
17
Tyr
20
21
Cys Asn
z->0Np ,But
z-
L »
z-k 2 h 3 Trt Trt l Trt c rTr.
Bpoc«
IV
fTrt rTrt
) 0) û£
4.5 5.5 6.5 7.5 8.5
pH
Fig.2 Effect of pH on the activity of the amidating enzyme in porcine pituitary The pH optimum of the enzyme was found to be 7.0 (Fig.2).
It
was observed that additi on of 0. linM cupric ion to the enzyme
384 increased its activity but higher concentrations abolished the effect.
Dialysis against ethylene diamine tetra-acetate
(lOmM, pH7.0) resulted in complete loss of activity;
however
the activity could be restored by the addition of cupric ion. To investigate the mechanism of amidation, the reaction was carried out with isotopically labelled tripeptides. D-Tyro14 sylvalylglycine was synthesized using both N-glycine and 15 N-glycine and the corresponding D-tyrosylvaline amides were isolated after incubation with the pituitary enzyme.
The
molecular structures of the products were confirmed by highland low-resolution mass spectrometric analysis of the trifluoracetyl derivatives (3) (Fig.3). Three of the ions obtained showed the single mass unit increments expected from the incorporation of the Nisotope. High-resolution mass measurements of the molecular ions at 549 and 550 AMU (atomic mass units) and the base peaks of the spectra at 346 and 347 AMU gave unequivocal evidence for the empirical formulae of these compounds. These results demonstrate that the N isotope from the glycine residue is The data support a mechanism retained in the peptide amide. involving removal of hydrogen from the C-terminal glycine and spontaneous hydrolysis of the resulting imino linkage: NH CO I R-CH I NH
CH20 I C00H
CO I R-CH I NH
X
NH, CH I C00H
CO I R-CH I NH
CHO I C0 2 H
The substrate specificity of the amidating enzyme was examined with a range of synthetic tripeptides.
It was found that
glycine was a mandatory amino acid in the C-terminal position of the tripeptide D-Tyr-Val-Gly;
substrates containing
385 leucine, alanine, sarcosine, lysine or glutamic acid in place of the glycine did not give rise to a detectable amount of dipeptide amide.
In addition amidation of the tripeptide
00
r._«5
1
standard
Oi
so
1 300
330
340
360
HA
430
450
»00
11»,
unknown troni
r-
>>ofc»'
»30
M0
560 T
N tripeptide^
1 «M -P
•H m fl 0)
170 J 300 330
i 10 340
360
430
4S0
500
530
540
560 y
•H
0 >) •H -P ai r-i «0)
standard
300
330
340
360
430
450
500
unknown from
300
330
340
360
430
450
500
530 540 560 15N tripeptide
530
540
560 j
Fig.3 Normalized partial mass spectra of the trifluoracetyl derivative of Tyr-Val amide, (a) Synthetic D-Tyr-Val-1 ''N-amide. (b) D-Tyr-Val amide formed enzymatically from Tyr-Val-1"N-Gly. (c) Synthetic D-Tyr-Val-'^N-amide. (d) D-Tyr-Val amide formed enzymatically from Tyr-Val- 15 -Gly
386 D-Tyr-Val-Gly was found to take place when the valine in position 2 was replaced by phenylalanine or glycine.
It
seems likely that the amidating enzyme in porcine pituitary will prove to be common to all tissues that biosynthesize the C-terminal carboxamide group.
References 1. 2. 3.
Bradbury, A.F., Finnie, M.D.A., Smyth, D.G.: Nature 298, 686 (1982). Jacobs, I.S., McKeel, D.W., Jarett, I., Daughaday, W.H.: Endocrinology 92, 477-486 (1973). Engelfried, C., Koenig, W.A., Voelter, W.: Spectrom. 3, 241-244 (1976).
Biomed. Mass
REACTION MECHANISM
IN TRYPSIN
INSULIN STUDIED BY
CATALYZED
SYNTHESIS OF
HUMAN
0-NMR SPECTROSCOPY.
and Kjeld Schaumburg 2
Jan MarkusserJ ^Novo Research
17
Institute,
Novo
Allé, DK-2880
Bagsvaerd,
Denmark 2
H.C. 0rsted Institute, Universitetsparken 5, DK-2100 Copenhagen 0, Denmark
Introduction Two methods
of
replacing
the
alanine
residue
B30
of
porcine
insulin with threonine by trypsin and thus achieving
a conver-
sion to
(1,2)
human
insulin
alanine residue is A (3)
resulting
are
known.
selectively
in
In
one
method
hydrolyzed with
des(Ala B 30)
porcine
the
carboxypeptidase
insulin
(DAI).
In
a
second step, DAI is coupled with a threonine ester in a mixture of water and organic solvents by trypsin, resulting in an ester of human
insulin
(HI-OR).
In the
other method
(4,5) porcine
insulin is directly transpeptidized with a threonine ester in a mixture of water and organic solvents by trypsin, resulting in an ester of human insulin under concomitant release of alanine. The pathways of the two reactions are shown in Fig. 1 in accordance with the acyl-enzyme concept (6) in which an intermediate ester (DAI-trypsin) is formed from the carboxyl group of Lys B 2 9 of DAI and the hydroxyl
group of Ser^&3
trypsin, state III and IV. transpeptidation method _i.e. transverses ponent R
and
the
returns
the active site of
In order to investigate whether the
is truly
states via
Qf
a transpeptidation
I-»-III, exchanges III+I, or
only
the
reaction, amino
apparently
comso
by
having free DAI as an intermediate state, the transpeptidation (experiment A) was carried out in a mixture of organic solvents and H 2 ^ 0 .
If
incorporated in of DAI-Trypsin
free the at
DAI
occurs
carboxyl step
as
group
IV+V, and
an of
intermediate Lys
B2
9
by
hydrolysis
transpeptidation
regarded as hydrolysis (I+VI) followed by coupling
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
is
could
(VI+I).
be
388
Trypsin + Porcine Insulin or Trypsin + Human Insulin Ester O o I. ii c •ex. / N\ _N 183 C- H
Trypsin + DAI o
VI.
/
H N'
/
cr" ,H
O'
H n N «
// B29
o
(CH ) -NH B30 N \ / 24 3 H' i ' ^Ch HN. ^ B 28 \ k
.N
0 w
O a II c/ -•Sk A _ N 183 C- H
1
II
^
C 183 C _N H I I I I H I 0'C /H 0'' //B29 ^ c > II / A183 C- N H I C \ o \/B29 H ; N _ ... yC (CH2). -NHj H' HN ^B28
V.
\ \
\/B29 H. X N---H-- -N \ / (CH2)4-NH; Ch
HN \B28 -Ala (B30) (irreversible)
\
Acyl-Enzyme Intermediates
\
46
,
H
-Ala Fig. 1
n \>/B29 C
y
\
-H,0.
\
(CH2)4-NH3
HN "^628 +Thr-OMe
S t e r e o c h e m i c a l v i e w of the s t e p s in (I+III and III+I) and coupling human insulin ester.
k-5 +H20
O V0 cs\\c / n\ A C 183 C-__N H I 1 / \ •H' C \ \ ) o-' H c \ffB29 H N" IIN\ C (CH2)4-NH3 / 46 V' HN^ ^28 IV.
183"C- ,NH H c
N
Nk-2 + Thr-OMe (B30)
o II
transpeptidation
( V I + I ) , leading to
D r a w i n g a d a p t e d from
(6).
389 The r e v e r s i b i l i t y
of
step
c o u p l i n g of DAI w i t h s o l v e n t and
H2O
the h y d r o l y s i s in L y s B 2 9 control
step
futher
in a m i x t u r e of
If
V + I V is
step
IV+V leads
C)
in
investigated
ester
B) .
consequently
(experiment
the
to
organic
reversible,
incorporation
product
by
HI-OR.
of
A
positive
17
0 - l a b e l l e d H I - O R w a s p r e p a r e d by R9Q 17 17 insulin in H 2 0 yielding DAI(Lys - 0)
hydrolyzing porcine f o l l o w e d by
a threonine
(experiment in
and
V+IV was
coupling
of
to
Thr-OMe
by
trypsin
in
a
mixture
in
H^70.
of
w a t e r and o r g a n i c s o l v e n t s , s t e p s V I + I . M a t e r i a l s and M e t h o d s A.
P r e p a r a t i o n of H I - O M e by t r a n s p e p t i d a t i o n
100 mg
monocomponent
0.5 ml
10 M a c e t i c acid.
porcine
12°C.
10
added to
mg
porcine
the
nr. 8 0 0 1 0 4 ,
proteins were
The
solutions
21.72
atom
precipitated
and d r i e d
_in v a c u o . HI-OMe.
B.
10
17
%
the
(Novo, M
were
i s o l a t e d by c e n t r i f u g a t i o n , s i o n into
p r o c e e d e d as which was
a c e t i c acid H2170.
and
the
acid with
addition
of
by
HPLC
M
and
hours 20
A,
showed
for
the
aqueous
solutions,
calcium
acetate
H P L C a n a l y s i s s h o w e d 96%
HI-OMe.
100 The
acetone,
of
mg
acetone conver-
of
DAI
preparation
reaction i.e.
were
M
12°C, the
of
92%
0.05
(Ventron
20 ml of
in H ? 1 7 0 .
except
the
at
ml
was
in ice and
H2^0
10 M a c e t i c acid.
under The
0.05
in
cooled
crystallized)
acetic
24
was
chilled
w a s h e d twice w i t h
in 0.5 ml
hours.
x
A^ter
Analysis
described
two
2
prepared
0).
by
mixture
acetate,
P r e p a r a t i o n of H I - O M e by c o u p l i n g
(3) w a s d i s s o l v e d
dissolved
to
and
trypsin
mixture.
was
added
in 0.2 ml 0.05 M c a l c i u m
calcium acetate
(Novo)
in
N,N-dimethylacetamide was dissolved
insulin
1.3 ml of 1.64 M T h r - O M e d i s s o l v e d
made
the up
time 10
M
with
390 P r e p a r a t i o n of D A I ( L y s 8 2 9 - 1 7 0 ) . s i m i l a r to
DAI 17
21.72 atom %
(3),
except
DAI(Lys829-170)
that
(Ventron
100 mg
of D A I ( L y s
acid.
The
829
-
17
0)
preparation
reaction
was
no.
800104,
b u f f e r and
Positive
was dissolved
proceeded
time
prepared for
A.
P r e p a r a t i o n of H I - O M e ( L y s 8 2 9 - 1 7 0 ) .
that the
0
was
0 ) w a s used for the 0.1 M N H 4 H C 0 3
d i s s o l u t i o n of c a r b o x y p e p t i d a s e C.
H2
17
in 0.5 ml
as d e s c r i b e d
2 hours,
control.
and
the
10 M
under
acetic
A,
aqueous
except
solutions
w e r e m a d e up in c o m m o n , d i s t i l l e d w a t e r .
A n a l y s i s by H P L C s h o w -
ed that
to the e x t e n t of
coupling
to H I - O M e
had
occurred
1 7 0 - N M R of H I - O M e p r e p a r a t i o n s . p r e p a r a t i o n s of HC1.
The
HI-OMe
solutions
were
Approximately
dissolved
the
ml
0.06
N
1.7-1.9,
The
in
2.5
3
prepara-
activity.
values
to
the
range
its
pH
2
of
w e l l b e l o w pH 3 w h e r e the t r y p s i n , still p r e s e n t in the t i o n s , loses
acquired
in
50 mg
96%.
concentrations
of
insulin
in
the s o l u t i o n s w e r e d e t e r m i n e d by amino acid a n a l y s i s , using
the
d a t a for p h e n y l a l a n i n e , of w h i c h there are 3 in b o t h insulin
and
trypsin.
are
T h e c o r r e c t i o n s due to the c o n t e n t of 10% t r y p s i n
then -(molecular 10%= - 6 0 0 0 / 2 4 0 0 0 in the
weight x
insulin/molecular
10%=
experiments
-2.5%.
A,
B
The
and
C
weight
trypsin)
concentrations
were
3.7,
3.5
of
and
x
insulin 2.6
mM,
respectively. T h e 1 7 0 s p e c t r a w e r e o b t a i n e d using a B r u k e r H X 2 7 0 with a
resonance
frequency
for
w i d t h of 36 kHz c o r r e s p o n d i n g of 30
usee c o r r e s p o n d i n g
points were
collected,
instrument was
^70
of
36.6
to 2 5 ° p u l s e s w e r e
the use
of
the s p e c t r a
natural
quadrature marked
"ghost s i g n a l "
is
abundance detection,
with 1.2%
water
x of
in
a
Fig.
that
of
used
and 16 K d a t a sample.
checked
The
on a
water refe-
"ghost the
width
The s p e c t r a are
signal
2.
spectral
Pulse
for e a c h
and the p e r f o r m a n c e
a c e t o n e s a m p l e p r i o r to the e x p e r i m e n t s . r e n c e d to the
A
to 975 p p m w a s used.
in ~ 1 0 0 , 0 0 0 scans
adjusted
spectrometer
MHz.
present.
signal"
T h e peak parent
Due
appears
height water
of
to in the
signal.
391 Results and Discussion The
17
0-NMR
in Fig.
spectra of the 3 preparations A, B and C are
2.
Only
signal arising
in the positive
from HI-OMe
200-500 ppm downfield In experiment would lead
incorporation
dance during
steps
increase of
^ ^O
The absence
of
the dominance III + I.
of
I+VI.
the B
is
one
an ^ range,
the
in
24
test
h
in 20%
period
HI-OMe
could
of
in
for
a
further place.
HI-OMe
mechanism,
the
abun-
take
ratio
support I+III and
of
IV+VI as compared to that of reaction
Provided
C
intermediate
i n Lys 29
amounts a
as an B
transpeptidation
belled DAI is dissolved in ^ 0 4.5.
experiment
in the expected
free DAI
During
detectable
Experiment
of reaction
of
incorporation
of
seen
from the water signal.
A, the existence
to
control
can be
shown
the
IV+I.
Unla-
enriched water at a "pH" of about
that the reaction VI + I proceed
fast
in compari-
son to exchange of oxygen between water and the carboxyl B
of Lys 29 f
the test
(7) that oxygen detectable
^0
is valid.
exchange
negligible under
the
a rate
orders
of
It appears
between
present
signal
oxygen in experiment
in B
from
carboxylic
the
expected
magnitude
The
range
reactions
larger
the
than
literature
for
absence
and
III+I.
Difference
related to
the
water
bond with
of
reactions
mechanism.
in
is substantiated. insulin
overall
difference
in
The
between
synthesis
of
and DAI both pass through
reaction rates
a
peptide
Furthermore, the assumption of lack of oxygen exchange from porcine
of
IV+I proceed that
IV+VI, thus supporting the transpeptidation carboxyl groups
group
acids and water is
conditions.
shows that
HI-OMe starting
rate
of
rates
is
acyl-enzyme
therefore formation,
i_.e. I+III for transpeptidation and VI+III for coupling. The reaction
rates
markedly, TN
(transpeptidation)=0.12 , TN
In Fig. states.
1, II and
expressed V
represent
the
kcal/mole.
number TN
differ
(coupling)=8, at 12°C
rate determining
Experiments aimed at determining
tion for the transpeptidation E a =12±2
by the turnover
transition
the energy of activa-
and coupling
reactions both
gave
392
H
600 Fig.
2
^O-NMR C.
500
400
300
200
s p e c t r a of the H I - O M e
100
0
ppm
of e x p e r i m e n t s A , B and
O n l y the p o s i t i v e c o n t r o l e x p e r i m e n t C r e s u l t s in a
band attributable
to
d o w n f i e l d from the H2
HI-OMe(LysB29-1 70) , 17
0 signal.
200-500
ppm
393 H e n c e the
observed
difference t e r m s of
in
Eyrings
by d i f f e r e n t _i.e.
of
the
transmission where
in
TN
values
transition
transition
~ 65'Kji,
k y
difference
energy
state
theory,
coefficients
not II
it m a y
(3
by IR, NMR
— C(CHj)j
by IR, NMR
O
-NH-CHCONHCHCO-CH,CH,OH 1 1 R' R"
analogy
422
The method elaborated can be applied to the study of the metabolism and enzymatic degradation of peptide hormones. The samples need pre-purification on SEP-PAK cartridges (Waters) with 40-80% recovery. Recently OPA-peptides separated have been used for MS peptide sequencing, too (10). The application of pre-column derivatization is growing in peptide-analysis.
Chromotagram «f »-phthalalrfohydo dorivativoi of a-MSH fumanti Column ODS HYPIRSIL-Sum Ili I 4mm Flow rata 1.4 ml/min Prouuro : 70 boi Salvonl : AtH-HjO-lFA i : IS »S : 0.1 B ' 90 : 10 : 0.1 Gradient : 1.2 *0 B/min UV profit Dotoction : W ot to .r,. H 20fluori, mo Pool«»: 1. 0 1 pi H-aOH -io-frosoni k' 6 5 2. 0.2fig H-1-NH, 1-13 »2
References
i (min)
Wilkinson, J.M.: J.Chrom.Sei. 16, 547 (1978) Hsu, K.T., Currie, B.L.: J.Chromatogr. 166, 555 (1978) Szokän, Gy., Gyenes, M., Tyihäk, E., Szende, B.: Proc. of 17th European Peptide Symposium (1982) McHugh, W., et al.: J.Chromatogr. 124, 376 (1976) Gruber, K., Stein, S., Brink, L., Radhakrishnan, A. Udenfriend, S. Proc.Nat.Acad.Sci. USA 73, 1314 (1976) Martin, W.R.: J.Chromatogr. 202, Wu, K.M., Sloan, J.W 500 (1980) Lindroth, P., Mopper, K.: Anal.Chem. 51,(11) 16 6 7 (19 79) Hodgin, J.C.: J.Liquid Chrom. 2,
1047 (1979)
Simmons, S.S. , Johnson, D.F.: J.Chem.Soc.Chem.Comm..11, 374 (1977) 10.
Larsen, B.R.: Life Sci. 30, 1007 (1982)
F A S T ATOM BOMBARDMENT MASS S P E C T R O M E T R Y A NEW T O O L FOR P E P T I D E
SEQUENCE
-
ANALYSIS
Wilfried A. König, Mitat Aydin, Uwe Schulze, Marian Rinken Institut für Organische Chemie und Biochemie der Universität Hamburg D-2000 Hamburg (F.R.G.)
Introduction Mass spectrometry has been used in peptide analysis for many years, particularly for structure elucidation of biologically active peptides. Conventional electron impact or chemical ionization techniques afford evaporation of the sample. For peptides this is only possible after conversion to volatile derivatives in a series of microchemical reactions. The use of diborane for reduction of acetylated peptides to polyamino alcohols has proved to be a valuable approach (1, 2, 3). Complete sequence and molecular weight information is available from these peptide derivatives upto a chain length of 10 to 12 amino acids (fig. 1). In 1981 a very promising new ionization technique, {¡ait
atom
bomban.drmnt
(FAB)
(4, 5), has been
sug-
gested for the analysis of high molecular, polar natural compounds. Sample molecules are dissolved in a polar, low volatile solvent, for example glycerol, and bombarded with highenergy argon or xenon atoms on a metal target in the ion source of a mass spectrometer. The molecules are ionized and evaporate spontaneously at ambient temperature.
Results Since peptides as polyfunctional compounds possess acidic and basic functions, they may form cations by proton addition or anions by proton abstraction. Therefore the spectra of positive
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
424
as well as negative ions may be recorded. rrn
pro
pro
,976
phe
, 893
\Z'
j 12
HjC-CHj^nn-^n-l,^'
phs
,610
\ **
pro
6 77
5ti
Zi
ZS
293
a
ch2
319 I
CHj
636 A7
AJ
6«« »5
S3S ?36,
i
ch3
/\ i
¿02,
A2
, CH«—I i2-HN-CHtCH2-HN-CH7CH2-otms
CH |
HjC OTMS
1236 \z9
! Oi C H , - H N - C H +t CCHH,, - N — H - C H j - N —
ij-K—vCH,-HN-CH' I CH
CHj
PRO
?H2
919. 9761 A9
7S3,
1109', aio
H
A, A2 319
a,.2, 236
*3 (02
I I * *' l u T . U u T [ „ h I V 5 , , , , i .,
-
«7 :929
(z7>
l»6> »6 :773
"5> »5 :674 758
:I0!9
t»3>
«4» (Zs>
(zt>
659
>96
h2n '• CH - C
«3 ;396
(Z3)
CH \ CHj CH3
C-0
: CH ch2 ch3 ch3
OH
366
(C,)
-p-aminophenyla.la-
|ji-p—nitrophenylalani-
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
468 neQdeamino-6-carba-oxytocin (VXIl) were prepared at the Prague Institute (2). ¡j2-[^H]Tyrosine-8-lysine] vasopressin (•'h-LVP) was prepared and purified according to (^,5). The binding of analogues to liver membranes (6) was followed by determining the ability of the individual analogues to compete for binding sites with o H-LVP (7)« The method for measuring the binding of analogues to the membrane fraction of the rat kidney medulla, and the activation of adenylate cyclase was the same as described in papers (8) and (•?)•
Results In a number of oxytocin analogues, deamina.tion and carba-substitution of the bridge leads to an increase of the natriuretic effect. The modification of the p-position of tyrosine resulted not only in an absolute change of the natriuretic effect but also affected other biological, responses. As can be seen in Table I, the modifications performed in the p-position of a. series of analogues of deamino-6-carba.-oxytocin resulted in a decrease of the affinity to the liver receptor system. Although the decrease in affinity was not dramatic at the most by 1.5 order as compared with oxytocin - the com3 pounds were found to be only weak antagonists of H-LVP binding (pKQ = 8.33) in. this system. In accordance with these data., the pressor action of the analogues was also lower than that of oxytocin ( 2 ) . The character of the dependence of the binding and the adenylate cyclase activation on the molecular structure is somewhat different in the renal system. The substitution of the hydroxyl group by methyl or ethyl groups increased the affinity and activation ability of both compounds (ill, IV), whereas the other modification decreased the affinity ten times and the activation ability in some cases even more (VI and VIII). The anti-
469 Table X Characteristics of binding and activation constants of oxytocin analogues Compound
Liver membranes
PKD I II III IV V VI VII VIII a
7.11 7.71 6.48 6.25 5.37 5.86 5.36 5.86
_
_
Renal system Binding
Adenylate cyclase
Na triuresis
D
PKD
1"
7.47 7.^9 7.80 7.60 6.28 6.39 6.62 6.57
7.21 7.^3 7.54 7.48 6.72 5.70 6.72 5.96
iooa 298 326 255 131 31 87 66
PK
The natriuretic potency of oxytocin was taken as a. basis
for calculations.
diuretic potency is in agreement
with the tendency of chan-
ges of the activation constants for the adenylate cyclase system; compounds III and IV have potencies in the range of tens of antidiuretic units per nig, the other compounds have a lower activity than that of oxytocin. As can be seen from the results presented in Table I, compounds II-IV have 2.5-3 times higher natriuretic potency than oxytocin (i), the others have 30-130% of the activity of oxytocin. In most of the structural modifications performed the lipophilic properties of the analogue molecule were enhanced; this effect was most pronounced in the case of compounds II—IV. Although these changes result in higher affinity to renal receptors and more pronounced activation of adenylate cyclase (compare the p K n and pK. values for oxytocin and compounds II and IV and
470
their natriuretic uretic
potency
(2)
action), of
the higher n a t r i u r e t i c
a b o u t by a l t e r e d d i s t r i b u t i o n and e l i m i n a t i o n p r o l o n g a t i o n of
the i n d i v i d u a l
responses,
c r e a s e d a f f i n i t y and by t h e a c t i v a t i o n in
and
t h e s e compounds i s a p p a r e n t l y
of
leading
rather
antidi-
brought to
the
than by
in-
adenylate
cycla.se
kidneys.
References 1.
ä k o p k o v a , J . , H r b a s , P . , B a r t h , T . f L e b l , M., J o s t , K . j Hormonal R e g u l a t i o n o f Sodium E x c r e t i o n ( L i c h a r d u s , B. , S c h r i e r , R.W., Ponec, J . , E d s ) , p. 103-168. E l s e v i e r , Amsterdam 1980.
2.
L e b l , M. , H r b a s , P . , A . , Barth, T . , Jost, in press.
3.
J o s t , IC., äorm, F . : 234-245 ( 1 9 7 1 ) .
4.
Pradelles, Cohen. P . , (1972).
5.
C a m i e r , M. , A l a z a r d , J . L . , Fromageot, P.s
6.
Neville,
7.
Cantau, B . , K e p p e n s , S . , de W u l f , t o r R e s . 1, 1 3 7 - 1 6 8 ( 1 9 8 0 ) .
8.
R a j e r i s o n , R.M., M a r c h e t t i , J . , Roy, C . , B o c k a e r t , J a r d , S . : J . B i o l . Chem. 249, 6390-6400 ( 1 9 7 4 ) .
9.
Butlen, D., G u i l l o n , G., R a j e r i s o n , R.M., Jard, S . , S a w y e r , W . H . , Manning, M . : M o l . P h a r m a c o l . 14, 1006-1017 (1978).
ä k o p k o v a , J . , S l a n i n o v a , J . , Ma.ch.ova, K. : C o l l e c t , C z e c h . Chem. Commun., Collect.
Czech.
Chem. Commun.
36,
P . , Morga.t, J . L . , F r o m a g e o t , P . , Bonne, D. , B o c k a e r t , J . , J a r d , S . : FEBS L e t t . 26, 189-192 ~~ R. , Cohen, P . , P r a d e l l e s , P . , Morga.t, E u r . J . B i o c h e m . ¿ 2 , 207-214 ( 1 9 7 3 ) .
D.M.: Biochim.
Biophys.
Acta. 154, H.,
Jard,
540-552 S.:
J.
(1968). RecepJ.,
SYNTHESIS AND BIOLOGICAL ACTIVITY OF NEW ENKEPHALIN ANALOGUES
Ryszard Paruszewski, Roza Matusiak, Elwira Gmitrzuk, Witold Gumulka and Piotr Janicki Dep. of Pharmaceutical Chemistry and Dep. of Pharmacodynamic Medical Academy, 02-097 Warsaw, Poland
Introduction The analogues of enkephalin containing 6-aminohexanoic acid, which molecule is flexible and its length in extended conformation is about 5-1 S, were synthesized to study influence of substitution by this amino acid on the biological activity of peptides. Activities in vitro in the guinea-pig ileum /GPI//1/, mouse vas deferens /MVD//2/, rat vas deferens /RVD//3/ and in vivo analgesic activities /4,5/ were examined. Also resistance of the obtained analogues to proteolytic degradation in vitro by rat brain supernatant was investigated. The analogues synthesized were: H-Tyr-t-Ahx-Phe-Leu-OH /l/, its amide /il/ and ester /ill/, H-Tyr-Gly-Gly-Phe-£-Ahx-OH /iv/, its amide /V/ and ester /VI/, H-Tyr-D-Met-Gly-Phe-£-Ahx-OH All/, its amide /VIII/ and ester /IX/, H-Tyr-£-Ahx-Phe-£-Ahx-OH /X/, its amide A l / and ester /XII/. Synthesis Peptides esters were synthesized by DCC/HBT solution method /6/. Peptides amides were obtained by ammonolysis and free
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
472
peptides by alkaline hydrolysis of peptides esters. All peptides were purified by ion exchange and by partition column chromatography /7/.
Table 1. Analytical data of the analogues 5T5 Compd A/jj DMF
Amino acid ratio ¿-Ahx
Gly D-Met
Leu
TLC, R f
PB:400 V 2h
Tyr BAW BPW * E Phe 4:1 : 65: ' 5 35s pH= pH=
Phe
65
1 . 8 8.6
I
-23.3
0,87
-
-
1.06 1.11 0.95 0.60 0,70 211
II
-25.0
1.13
-
-
1.05 1.05 0.78 0.41 0.72 222 1933
III
-20.8
1.03
-
-
1.06 1.08 0.82 0.54 0.75 178 2200
IV
-26.7
0.97 1.92
-
-
1,07 1,05 0.55 0,59 311
V
-21,4
1.05 1.87
-
-
1.03 1,05 0,42 0.57 198 2133
VI
-26,0
1.19 1,69
-
-
1.07 0,94 0.56 0,67 188 1933
VII
-30.9
0.95 0.98
0.97
-
1,10 0.99 0,49 0.64
71
133
VIII -27,6
1.08 1.05
0.92
-
1.11 0,95 0.50 0.63
81
125
IX
-28.7
0.95 1,09
0,98
-
1-08 0.92 0.60 0.72
92
100
X
-12.5
1.73
-
-
-
1.21 1.06 0.53 0,52
95 -163
XI
- 7.9
2.01
-
-
-
1,07 0.92 0.54 0.54
111 -200
XII
-10.5
1,90
_
_
—
1.16 1.05 0.56 0.66
92 -150
0
0
Table 2. Degradation of the analogues by rat brain supernatant Compd
Percent, of amino acid rel. after incubation /20',37°C/ ¿-Ahx
Gly
D-Met
Leu,Gly-Gly
Phe
Tyr
I
0
-
-
0
0
8
IV
0
5
-
0
0
20
VII
0
0
0
-
0
0
X
0
-
-
-
0
2
_
7
_
30
32
Leu-E
46
473
Table 3. Biological activity of the analogues Compound
Agonist potency
Analg.activ., hot pi.test
IC 50 /M/
IC5 0 / V
IC 50 /M/
GPI
MVD
RVD
n=3-5
n=3-5
n=3-5
ED50/L'lAg/ Rel.potency i.e.v.,mice i.p.,rats n=6
2x10~ 6 MAg n=6
Morphine
x10 Dalamid
4.7^.3
9*2-1.8 3
phin I II III
10"
8
V
x10"
9
7
10"
10-
-4 >10 *
>10~3
4
3
>10~3 -4 >10 4
>10"
>10~
6
>10-
x10~
>10~3
0,35
3
0.40
5
0.58
>10" 4x10~
x10~
>10~3
1.3-0.5
8
x10"
6,8il.8
>10-
-
5
-8
4.5io.6
6
-
7
-
4.2il,1
8.2-1.2
6.7io.8 _7 x10 '
x10"
x10~
7
1.00
7
0.39i0.15
5
x10~
7
x10 IV
-8
11,8i2-8 1.oio,2
9.Oil.2 x1 0"
^-Endor-
x10
0.4i0.1
-
>10
-3
0.65
4
>10"3
0.57
1.6io.4
1.13
x10 ' VI
x10" VII
IX X XI XII
8
x10
5
3
x10~
4.oio.8
12.4^3•2 1.5^0.3
9.oio,4 x10"
VIII
>10~3
5•45—1,2 6.8io.9
8
x10
3
6
x10 '
x10~
8
7
5
ND
ND
-8
7
5
ND
ND
>10~3
ND
ND
3
ND
ND
3
ND
ND
1.1x10~ 2.3x10~ 3.0x10" 2,2x10
0.73
>10~3
5.6x10~ 3.0x10~ >10"3 6
3
8.5x10~
>10~
6
1,9x10"
-5
3.0x10
>10" >10~
474
Conelusions
1.
A l l of the synthesized analogues of enkephalin w i t h 6 - a m i nohexanoic acid / c - A h x / in positions 2 - 3 , show morphine-like
2.
and/or 5
activities.
The highest activity on theJH. receptors
is shown by
peptides VI-IX , on the S and £ receptors by the peptide
VII.
The highest analgesic activity is shown by peptides VI,VII. 3.
Activity
of peptide XI on the £ receptors is at least
sand times higher t h a n activity on they«- and £ 4.
thou-
receptors.
Substitution of £ - A h x in position 2-3 or 5 protects the binding of Phe and substitution of £ - A h x in position 2-3 p r o the
binding of T y r against in vitro proteolytic
tion by rat brain
degrada-
supernatant.
References
1. 2. 3.
Kosterlitz, H.'.V., V/aterfield, A . A . : B r i t . J . P h a r m a c o l . 53, 1 31-138 / 1 9 7 5 / . Hutchinson, IJ., Kosterlitz, H.'J., Leslie, P.M., '.'/aterfield, A . A . : Brit. J . Pharmacol. 55., 541-546 IT Schulz, R., Paase, E., V/uster, Ivl., Herz, A . : Life 24, 8 4 3 - 8 5 0 / 1 9 7 9 / .
/1975/. Sci.
4.
Ueda, H., A m a n o , H., Shiomi, H., Takagi, H.: E u r . J . P h a r m a c o l . 56, 265-268 /1979/.
5.
Tyers, LI.B.j Brit. J . Pharmacol. 69, 503-512 / 1 9 8 0 / . ti Konig, ,/., Geiger, R . : Chem. Ber. KV5, 788-798 / 1 9 7 0 / .
6. 7.
Paruszewski,R., i.iatusiak, R., Gumulka, ',/., Janicki, P . : P o l i s h Patent Applications P-233416, P-233417, P - 2 3 3 4 1 8 /1981/.
BIOCHEMICAL AND BRAIN
AND PHARMACOLOGICAL
¿"OPIATE
A NEW FULLY
RECEPTORS
SPECIFIC
INVESTIGATIONS
USING
ON PERIPHERAL
TYR-D-THR-GLY"PHE"LEU-THR,
6-LIGAND.
Bernard P. Roques, G i l l e s Gacel, P i e r r e Dodey, Jean-Marie Zajac, MarieClaude Fournié-Zaluski Département Biologiques,
de Chimie 4 avenue
Organique, VER des de l'Observatoire,
Sciences Pharmaceutiques 75270 Paris cedex 06,
et France.
Jean-Louis Morgat Service
Biochimie,
CEN Saclay,
91190
Gif
Sur
Yvette,
France.
Jean Costentin, Hélène Marçais-Collado and P i e r r e Chai 1 l e t . Laboratoire du Rouvray,
de Pharmacodynamie, France.
Université
de Rouen,
76800
Saint
Etienne
Introduction
The m u l t i p l e pharmacological
responses e l i c i t e d by morphine administration
could be r e l a t e d to heterogenous receptors s t i m u l a t i o n .
Indeed, from phar-
macological and binding experiments three kinds of binding s i t e s were well characterized i n the CNS (1) : i ) y-receptors i n t e r a c t i n g with morphine and surrogates, i i )
preferentially
6-receptors e x h i b i t i n g a highest
f o r enkephalins and peptide s t r u c t u r e s , i i i )
affinity
K-receptors corresponding to
ethylketocyclazocine and dynorphin b i n d i n g - s i t e s . These r e s u l t s are supported by a large number of d i f f e r e n t studies (rev i n 2). However i t
remains
to demonstrate : i ) the s p e c i f i c pharmacological responses r e l a t e d to a s i n g l e receptor a c t i v a t i o n , d i s t i n c t proteins,
iii)
ii)
the l o c a l i z a t i o n of each binding s i t e on
the p o s s i b l e occurrence of a l l o s t e r i c a l l y
coupled
u and 6 receptors accounting f o r p o t e n t i a t i o n of morphine analgesia by Leu-E (3). Such i n v e s t i g a t i o n s e n t a i l i n g ligands of high a f f i n i t y and complete s p e c i f i c i t y , were done using a new f u l l y s e l e c t i v e
6-agonist.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
476 Materials and Methods Tyr-D-Thr-Gly-Phe-Leu-Thr (DTTLE) was prepared by liquid phase method as described for DSTLE (4). Binding and pharmacological assays were performed as described (4, 5). Analgesic experiments (hot plate test) were done on mice (9). Bestatin is a gift of Roger-Bellon laboratories.
Results and discussion As proposed (6), changes in Leu-E sequence allowing enhanced 6-receptor recognition are : i) an hydrophilic D-aminoacid in 2 decreasing p interaction, ii) a peptide-lengthening with hydrophilic residues leading to a more extended conformation . Using these features, Tyr-D-Ser-Gly-Phe-LeuThr (DSTLE) was recently proposed (5) as a much better 6-ligand than the 2 5 commonly used D-Ala -D-Leu -E. In order to still decrease the cross-reac2 2 tivity of DSTLE (Table I) we replaced D-Ser by D-Thr in order to enhance receptor-affinity without change in 6-selectivity. Tyr-D-Thr-Gly-Phe-LeuThr (DTTLE) was synthesized by liquid phase method as schematized below (11),
TYR
D-THR
GLY
PHE B o c _ L OH Boc_
Boc_
OH
0CH 3 . 0CH 3 OH
OH
H_
LEU H J OCHOCH. OCH-
Boc.
OCH,
BOC_
OH
BOC.
THR
H
OBzI OBzI OBzI OBzI OH
477 y or & selectivity on peripheral
and brain receptors. As shown in table 1,
the proposed changes in Leu-E sequence lead to a large decrease in IC^q on MVD (rich in ô-receptors) with a concomittant increase in IC^q on GPI (yreceptors). So as evidenced by the ratio of IC 5 Q on both organs, DTTLE is 3000 more potent on peripheral 6 than on y-receptors. Table I. Inhibitory effects of morphine and opioid peptides on the electrically induced contractions of guinea-pig ileum and mouse vas defe3 rens and on the binding in rat brain homogenates of H DAGO (1 nM) and 3 H DSTLE (2 nM).
I C , . (GPI) nH
TYR-GLY-GLY-PHE-LEU (LEU-E)
I C . . (MVD) nK
I C , (GPI) —-I C , - (MVD)
393.
6.2
48.
«8.
0.55
88.bo
,
K. (nB) , "
H Df-"
2.40
0.31
TYR-D-SER-GLY-PHE-LEU-THR
(DSTLE)
406.
0.40
1015.
31.
4.80
0.15
TYR-D-THR-GLY-PHE-LEU-THR
(DITLE)
460.
0.15
3067.
25.30
1.35
0.0s
TYR-D-ALA-GLY-PHE-D-LEU
(DADLE)
lTYR-D-ALA-GLY-PKE-NH-(CH2)6-]2 TYR-D-ALA-GLY-KEPHE-GLY-OL
(DAGO)
" 11.5
. 76.1
.
43.
0.15
The IC^Q values are the mean of 3-5 observations.
7.70
3.9
Methionine
11.50 1300.
0.23 333.
enkephalin
was
used in each assay as internal standard. The Kj values are the mean of three determinations.
Each Kj values was calculated from Hill plots with 9 concen-
trations of unlabelled
ligand.
As expected the same pharmacological profile occurs on rat brain membranes, 3 since from displacement experiments of H DAGO (Tyr-D-Ala-Gly-MePhe-Gly-ol) (7) and 3 H DSTLE, the cross-reactivity falls from 30% for DADLE to 5% for DTTLE. Therefore, DTTLE behaves at this time as the more specific 6-probe, largely better than the recently claimed (8) "extraordinarily 6-selective dimeric-enkephalins" which were not studied on a homogenous preparation as -5 required. Moreover DTTLE is poorly recognized by K-receptors (KT ~ 3 x 10 M 3 from H ethylketocyclazocine displacement).
Binding experiments
of
3 H DTTLE on brain tissue. According to the high selec-
tivity of DTTLE, this peptide was tritiated by exchange from its dibromo-Tyr precursor, synthesized through the same scheme as DTTLE itself. As expected,
478
Figure 1. 3 on crude rat brain membranes,
H DTTLE (35 Ci/mmole) binds to a single
classe of sites (6-receptors) with a high affinity, K^ = 1.45 nM and B
max
=
° ' 1 0 5 P m o l e / m 9 (Fi9-
Analgesic
activities
of y and 6 selective
ligands.
The very high difference
in y-recognition of DAGO (Kj = 3.9 nM) and DSTLE or DTTLE (Kj = 31 and 25 nM) allowed for the first time to evidence a significant correlation between y-affinity and analgesia since,measured on hot plate test in mice after i.c.v. administration, the ED 5 Q of DAGO = 0.5 nM is more than 50 times lower than those of DSTLE, 100 nM, and DTTLE, 25 nM. Obviously, these effects are naloxone-reversible evidencing for all compounds a y-receptor activation.
Studies
on y and 6 receptors
coupling and enkephalins
autoreceptors.
As
shown in table 2, subanalgesic doses of DTTLE do not potentiate the analgesic effect elicited by DAGO or morphine. These results seem to exclude an allosteric coupling of y and 6 receptors at least for antinociceptive regulation. Finally, as previously shown ( 9 ) , the analgesic effects induced by endogenous enkephalins can be studied following the protection of these natural peptides from enzyme degradation by Thiorphan
(enkephalinase
inhibitor (10) and Bestatin (aminopeptidase inhibitor). So, using these two
inhibitors,a strong analgesia is obtained (Table 2). Moreover, i.c.v.
479 Table 2. Analgesic effects in mice (hot-plate test) of simultaneous i.e.v. administration of DTTLE, DAGO, Bestatin (B) and Thiorphan (T).
Treatment (n=10)
Jump latency time (s)
Sai ine
59 ± 6
DTTLE (1 ng)*
63 ± 4
DAGO (1 ng)
151 ± 19
DTTLE (1 ng) + DAGO (1 ng)
140
DAGO (0.01 ng)*
*
14
66 ± 7
B (50 ng) + T (10 ng)
157 i 15
B (50 ng) + T (10 ng) + DTTLE (1 ng)
154 ± 18
B (50 ng) + T (10 ng) + DAGO (0.01 ng)
150 ± 18
p < O.OOl ;
A
*
subanalgesia
*
dose.
injection of subanalgesic doses of DAGO or DTTLE does not change the previous analgesic response indicating that enkephalins level is not significant modified in the synaptic cleft suggesting lack of autoreceptors of y or 6 types.
Acknowledgments. ille are indebted to Annick Bouju for typing
the manuscript. This work was
supported by grants from Rhône-Poulenc S.A. (Doctor J.M. Zajac is a research fellow from R.P.), the Université René Descartes, The Ministère de le Recherche et de la Technologie and the Fondation pour la Recherche Médicale Française.
480
References 1.
Kosterl i t z , H.W., Lord, J . A . H . , Paterson, S . J . , Waterfield, A.A. : Br. J . Pharmacol., 68, 333-342 (1980). 2. Roques, B.P., Fournie-Zaluski, M.C., Gacel, G., David, M., Meunier, J . C . , Maigret, B., Morgat, J . L . : in Regulatory Peptides from Molecular Biology to Function, E. Costa and M. Trabucchi, Eds, Raven Press New York, pp 321-331 (1982). 3. Vaught, J . L . , Rothman, R.B., Westfall, T.C. : Life Sei. 30, 1443-1455 (1982). 4. Gacel, G., Fournie-Zaluski, M.C., Roques, B.P. : F.E.B.S. Lett. 118, 245-247 (1980). 5. David, M., Moisand, C., Meunier, J . C . , Morgat, J . L . , Gacel, G., Roques, B.P. : Eur. J . Pharmacol. 78, 385-387 (1982). 6. Fournie-Zaluski, M.C., Gacel, G., Maigret, B., Premilat, S . , Roques, B.P. : Mol. Pharmacol. 20, 484-491 (1981). 7. Handa, B.K., Lane, A.C., Lord, J . A . H . , Morgan, B.A., Ranee, M.J., Smith, C.F.C. : Eur. J . Pharmacol. 70, 531-540 (1981). 8. Shimohigashi, Y . , Costa, T . , Chen, H., Rodbard, D. : Nature (London) 297, 33-335 (1982). 9. Fournie-Zaluski, M.C., Chaillet, P., Soroca-Lucas, E . , Margais-Collado, H., Costentin, J . , Roques, B.P. : J . Med. Chem. in press. 10. Roques, B.P., Fournie-Zaluski, M.C., Soroca, E . , Lecomte, J.M., Malfroy, B., Llorens, C., Schwartz, J . C . : Nature 288, 286-288 (1980). 11. Patent 80.17,523, August 8, 1980.
DOUBLE OPIATE PEPTIDES. A HYPOTHESIS OF TWO DIFFERENT MECHANISMS OF OPIATE ACTIONS
Andrzej W. Lipkowski and Miroslawa Konopica Laboratory of Peptides, Department of Chemistry, University of Warsaw, 02-093 Warsaw, Poland Beata Osipiak and Witold S. Gumulka Department of Pharmacodynamics, Warsaw Medical Academy 00-927 Warsaw, Poland
Introduction Since the isolation from the brain of endogenous opiate like peptides, Met- and Leu-enkephalin (l), numerous analogs of these substances have been synthesized. It is now apparent that 2-substituted analogs retain their analgesic activity with a variety of substitution or even deletion (2) at position 5 suggesting that this position might not be obligatory for opiate receptors affinity. The conclusion that a necessary element for opiate receptors interactions are elements from Tyr to Phe was a basic assumption for synthesis of an analog in which two of these elements were connected by hydrazide bridge, giving analog with high analgesic activity (3)» In 1979 Henschen et al. (k) isolated heptapeptide fragment of /3-casein with some opiate-like effect in G.P.I.
This hepta-
peptide, /3-casomorphin , shows no effect in the M.V.D. assay. In 1980 Erspamer group ( 5 ) isolated peptide with opiate-like activities from the amphibian skin. Both these peptides and enkephalins have almost completely different sequences. N-Terrainal Tyr and closely located Phe are the only two common residues. The consequent conclusion which could be drawn is that necessary elements interacting with opiate receptors
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
482 in the case of /3-casomorphin and dermorphin are N-terminal tripeptides and a D-amino acid or proline residues in those peptide replace dipeptide -Gly-Gly- which is present in enkephalins» This hypothesis is confirmed also by: (i) The synthesis of morphinoceptin with high specifity
toyu-receptors
which is reduced to tetra.peptide amide fragment of /3-casomorphin (6). (ii) The synthesis of tetrapeptide analogs of enkephalin (7) in which the removal of -Gly- in position 3 from enkephalin analogs, giving general formula Tyr-aa-Phe-Met-NHg (where aa - D-amino acid) preserves affinity to ^x-receptors. A fall of activity in the case of /3-casomorphin where sequence have been reduced to N-terminal
tripeptide
could be a. result of the peptide reducing into a, molecule too small for interacting with receptors or/and with transport biosystems. To check this suggestion we have synthesized analogs in which two necessary elements of dermorphine, /3-casomorphin , enkephalin and their analogs are connected by a hydrazide bridge, giving general formula
where —I
Tyr—{
I— Phe-NH I
Tyr-f
I—Phe-NH
h- means amino acid or dipeptide.
Materials and Methods Double opiate peptides were synthesized in solution by step by step elongation starting from (Phe-NH-) 2 (3) using DCC+ +HOBt as a coupling reagent. The final peptides were purified by absorption chromatography on silica gel followed by molecular sieve chromatography on Sephadex LH-20. Two of the assays were based on pharmacological responses: The depresión of the electrically - evoked contractions of the guinea-pig ileum (G.P.I.) and of the mouse vas deferens (M.V.D.). Antagonist potencies were characterized by ability
483
of
analogs
to reduce
pharmacologically
effect
stable
on M . V . D .
opiate
a n d on G . P . X .
agonist
of
the
(Tyr-D-Ala-Gly-Phe-
-NH-)2.
Results The p h a r m a c o l o g i c a l are
present
in Table
with glycine residue activity
in
1.
All
ly
as a g o n i s t
in peptide
of
residue
Table
agoof
synthesized double
on G . P . I .
amino a c i d s
I n M.V.D.
test
of
agonistic
antagonistic
but
significant-
all
activities.
activities
peptides
enkephalins
high
tests without low
in position
to
express
-Gly- are
and a n t a g o n i s t
to antagonist
related
chains
and M . V . D .
compounds w i t h o u t
pounds e x p r e s s a g o n i s t tions
of
Double p e p t i d e s
both G . P . I ,
activity. active
activities
analogs
these The
com-
rela-
depend
on
2.
1
Pharmacological
activities
of
Agonist Compound
M-
Tyr-D-Ala-Gly-Phe-Met-NH2
22.8
(Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-NH-)2
600
(Tyr-D-Thr-Phe-NH-)2 (Tyr-D-Thr-Gly-Phe-NH-)2 (Tyr-Pro-Phe-NH-)2
opiate
potencies
G-
IC5Q(nM)
(Tyr-D-Ala-Gly-Phe-NH-)2
double
1.94 1^30 6.40 1^50
Rel.x act."
763 29 8969 12 2718 ,0 12
in
IC„0(nM) V
17.1 6500 11.7 10.2 -
peptides
D
Inhibitory '
e
Rel. act.x
f , f i V ^ xj 0
n
191 0.26
weak
278 weak*1
+
319 , xxx weak
++
P o t e n c y r e l a t i v e t o M e t - e n k e p h a l i n = 100, n I8?b o f t w i t c h i n h i b i t i o n f o r c o n c . 30 . u M ; * * * 10$ o f t w i t c h i n h i b i t i o n f o r c o n c . 3 ° A»M. '
x
484
Discuss ion Ones of the well characterized isolated tissues are M.V.D, containing mainly 6 receptors and G.P.I, containing generally jw receptors. Both morphine like drugs and enkephalin analogs have affinity to both types of receptors. Nevertheless, morphine like drugs are considerably more potent than the enkephalin analogs in the G.P.I, but the opposite is true in the M.V.D. Additionally, opiate peptides generally better displace the bound enkephalin than narcotics but the opposite is true for morphine like thmgs. To elucidate these results the hypothesis have been proposed that narcotics and opiate peptides are interacting -with overlapping, but slightly different portions of the opiate receptors (8). We present a different point of view. The morphine like compounds are not flexible but opiate peptides have very flexible peptide chain. The preservation of a high agonistic activity on "typical" peptide receptors 3 requires of saving a flexible center -Gly -. The replacement of glycine residue in position 3 by D- or L-amlno acid residues (9), or abolishing this residue, and in consequence "freezing" molecules resulted in a dramatic reducing of agonistic activity on ¿receptors, but the agonistic activity on yu-receptors in most of the cases is maintained. On the other hand we found that double opiate peptide analogs composed from "freeze" elements express antagonistic activity on 6 receptors without antagonistic activity onyu receptors. Basing on these results we propose that general difference between 6 and yu receptors are concerning two different mechanisms of interactions with morphine like drugs and peptides. The classical "lock-and-key" mechanism (lO) is a way of interaction of molecules withyu receptors. In this mechanism the active site of the receptor by itself is complementary in shape to that of the morphine structure or some from the packed opiate peptide conformations. The interaction of peptides with 6 receptors is realized rather by "zipper" mechanism in which receptors
485
m a c r o m o l e c u l e s and p e p t i d e m o l e c u l e s action.
T h i s mechanism i s
s t a t e s of
receptor-peptide
les with a b i l i t y for
of
change shapes upon
characterized
binding with a lower
changing c o n f o r m a t i o n s i n p e p t i d e - r e c e p t o r activity.
The r i g i d
phine drugs a r e p r o b a b l y i n t e r a c t i n g by m o d i f i c a t e d
"induced-fit"
c h a n g e s shape upon b i n d i n g shape c o m p l e m e n t a r y substrate i s
to
that of
molecu-
possibility
complex
could
c o n f o r m a t i o n s of
w i t h t h i s kind of
mechanism i n w h i c h
substrate.
inter-
transient
complex. T h e r e f o r e p e p t i d e
receptor
express antagonistic tors
by s e v e r a l
The a c t i v e
the s u b s t r a t e
mor-
recep-
receptor
s i t e has a
only a f t e r
the
bound.
Acknowledgement T h i s w o r k was s u p p o r t e d i n p a r t
by t h e P o l i s h Academy
of
S c i e n c e s w i t h i n t h e P r o j e c t n2 1 0 . 4 .
References 1.
Hughes, J . , A . , Morgan,
Smith, T . t f . , K o s t e r l i t z , H . V . , F o t h e r g i l l , L . B . A . , M o r r i s , H . R . s N a t u r e 258, 577-579 ( 1 9 7 5 ) .
2.
McGregor, V . H . , S t e i n , 1371-1378 ( 1 9 7 8 ) .
3.
Lipkowski, A . V . , Konecka, 3 (1982), i n press.
L. , B e l l u z z i , A.M.,
J.D.:
Sroczynska,
Life
Sei.
I.:
23,
Peptides
Henschen, A . , L o t t s p e i c h , F . , B r a n t l , V . , T e s c h e m a c h e r , H.s Z . P h y s i o l . Chem. 360, 1211-1216 ( 1 9 7 9 ) . 5.
Erspamer, V . , M e l c h i o r r i , P . : i n " G r o w t h Hormone and Other B i o l o g i c a l l y A c t i v e P e p t i d e s " , P e r c i l e , A . , M u l l e r , E . E . , e d s . Exepta M e d i c a , Amsterdam 1980, p p . 1 8 5 - 2 0 0 .
6.
Chang, K . J . , K i l l i a n , A . , Hazum, E . , S c i e n c e 212, 75-77 ( l 9 8 l ) .
7.
C h i p k i n , R . E . , M o r r i s , D . H . , E n g l i s h , M . G . , Rosamond, J . D . , Stammer, C . H . , Y o r k , E . J . , S t e w a r d , J . M . : L i f e S e i . 28, 1517-1522 ( 1 9 8 1 ) .
8.
Lee, N.M.,
Smith,
A.P.s
Life
Sei.
26,
Cuatrecasas,
1459-1464
P.:
(1980).
486 9.
10.
Miller, R.J., Chang, K.J., Cuatrecasas, P., Wilkinson, S., Lowe, L., Beddell, C., Follenfant, R.: in "Centrally Acting Peptides", Hughes, J., ed. University Park Press 1978, pp. 195-213. Burgen, A.S.V., Roberts, G.C.K., Feeney, I.s Nature 253 753-75^ (1976).
SYNTHESIS AND ACTIVITY OP KYOTORPHIN AND ITS ANALOGS Lagos Balaspiri, Kaiman Koväcs, Institute of Medical Chemistry, Medical School of Szeged, Hungary Arpad Geese, Gyula Telegdy, Institute of Pathophysiology, Medical School of Szeged, Hungary Klaus Neubert, Section of Biosciences, Martin Luther University, Halle-Wittenberg, German Democratic Republic
Introduction In 1979, Takagi et al. [ l ] isolated and identified a morphine-like dipeptide from bovine brain by means of an in vivo assay utilized for evaluating analgesic activity The new analgesic dipeptide Tyr-Arg was named kyotorphin meaning an endorphin-like substance which was discovered in Kyoto. Using the sensitive analgesic bioassay method this novel opioid dipeptide administered intracisternally to mice has the analgesic effect /ED^Q 34.5 nmol per animal/ which is about 60 times less than that of morphine /ED^Q 0.61 nmol per animal/ but is about 4.2 times higher than that of Met-enkephalin /ED,-q 146 nmol per animal/ and is completely abolished by pretreatment with the narcotic antagonist naloxone f1, 3j. Kyotorphin did not bind to the specific opiate receptors, but did have a Met-enkephalin releasing effect from slices of guinea-pig striatum [ 3 ] and this effect is considered to be related to the analgesic action of the dipeptide. These findings suggest that the naloxone-reversible analgesic effect of Tyr-Arg is mediated by enkephalins or /3-endorphin. Therefore, it acts either as an enkephalin- or /S-endorphin-rele^sing factor or as an inhibitor of the degradation enzymes of enkephalins /aminopeptidase and enkephalinase/. The relatively long-lasting analgesia induced by Tyr-Arg may be attributed to a stabilising
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
488
effect on the released Met-enkephalin because it weakly inhibits enkephalin degradation enzymes. Thus, Tyr-Arg seems to be a Met-enkephalin-releasing factor, and its presence suggests the existence of a regulating mechanism for the release of Met-enkephalin. The regional distribution of kyotorphin in the rat brain and spinal cord [4] and effects on single neurons in the spinal dorsal horn of rabbits and the nucleus reticularis paragigantocellularis /NRPG/ of rats [5} suggest that kyotorphin has qualitatively similar actions as enkephalins and may play a physiological role in pain control in the CNS. According to Kastin et al. the kyotorphin as some other peptides can also affect behavior in chicks after peripherial administration. In a short time after isolation and identification of kyotorphin, this dipeptide, its long-lasting D-Arg analog and their retro isomers were synthesized by Yajima and his coworkers [6] . The same group synthesized eight Met- and Leu-enkephalin analogs [7] substituted with L- and D-Arg at position 2 containing the dipeptide unit kyotorphin or its analogs. The long-acting D-Arg analog and the two retro isomers, further four Met- and Leu-enkephalin analogs had higher analgesic activity than that of Tyr-Arg. The same data of synthetic Tyr-D-Ala and Tyr-D-Phe J8J have not been published.
Results Studying the structure-activity relationships in analgesia and/or Met-enkephalin releasing activity we have synthesized the kyotorphin and sixty-seven protected and unprotected structure analogs of it with a conventional and the solid phase peptidesynthesis methods. Optically active mainly natural but also unnatural amino acids were substituted mainly instead of L-tyrosine. With ^ C - and ^H-labelled derivatives of L-Tyr-L-Arg and L-Tyr-D-Arg were also prepared. Protected or partly protected, especially by carbobenzoxy-group blocked analogs were
489
synthesized on conventional way, in solution phase, starting from at the guanidine function by protonation blocked Arg or D-Arg, using the C-terminal amino acid a3 HONSu-esters 10 /Figure I./. Purification of the protected intermediates or analogs was effected by silicagel column chromatography. After deprotection by 10 % Pd-C/H2 the free peptides were treated with Amberlite CG-4B /acetate fom/ and purified by column chromatography on CM-cellulose.
1 Classical w a y Arg
Tyr OBu* OSu rOBut
H-|-0H TEA pH 8.5 AcOH/HCI fcKVH2 1.amberlite CG AB 2. CMC
-OH -OHxHCl OHxHCl OH
2. Solid phase w a y
-TOS Bil, BOC- A r g - O - C H2 - ( R e s i n ^ I
Ì
A c OH/MCI
®V rTOS T ' TtBfC^ r'"a ^ ^ »CCI BOC—Tyr- A r g - 0 - CH? - ( R e s i n
i
* Ma»«*
'
cnc
H-Tyr-Arg-OH
Figure I. Synthesis schemes of Kyotorphin and its analogs
490
At C-terminal amino acid by Boc-group blocked dipeptidea were prepared on original Merrifield-resin. After removing the protec ting-groups and the peptide from resin by HF/anisol the crude peptides were also treated with Amberlite CG-4B and purified by column chromatography on CM-cellulose. The homogeneity of the synthetic kyotorphin analogs and derivatives was assessed by TLC, HPLC and was characterized by amino acid analysis, NMR-data, melting points or optical rotation-data. Determination of analgesic activity was carried out on male CFLP-mice /25-35 g/. The peptides were administered intracerebroventricularly in 5 Jul saline under light ether anaesthesia. Two minutes later the animals were tested for analgesic activity on hot-plate [llj described by Ankier and the ED^Q values were compared /Table I./. We also examined naloxone antagonism with some of our peptides pretreating the animals with naloxone /I mg per kg/. Twenty minutes after i.p. injection analgesic effects of the peptides were tested on the same way.
Table I.: The Analgesic Effects of Synthetic Kyotorphin and its Analogs /intracisternally administered to Mice/ Hot-plate Test Compound Kyotorphin Me t-enkephalin Leu-enkephalin C b z-Tyr/Bu^/-Arg Cbz-Tyr-Arg.HCl Cbz-Tyr/BuV -D-Arg C b z-Tyr-D-Arg.HC1 L-Tyr-D-Arg Cbz-Gly-Arg Cbz-Gly-D-Arg Gly-L-Arg Gly-D-Arg
ED^Q ¿)g/animal 5.3 84.0 123.0 >20 >20 >20 >20 2.2 7.70 4.85 >20 11.6
Naloxone antagonism + + + n.i. n.i. n.i. n.i. + + + n.i. +
491
Cbz-Phe-Arg Cbz-Phe-D-Arg
17.0
.
+
+
Cbz-D-Phe-D-Arg L-Phe-L-Arg
1.95 >20
n.i.
>20
n. i.
L-Phe-D-Arg
>20
n. i.
D-Phe-L-Arg
> 20
n.i. +
D-Phe-D-Arg Cbz-Pro-Arg Cbz-Pro-D-Arg
4.9 2.65
L-Pro-L-Arg
2.65 >20
?
L-Pro-D-Arg
> 20
9
D-Pro-L-Arg
> 20
n.i.
Boc-Ser/Bzl/-Arg
11. i.
n.i.
S er/Bzl/-Arg.HC1
> 20
n.i.
Bo c-S er/Bz1/-D-Arg
n.i.
Ser/Bzl/-D-Arg.HC1
11. i. > 20
n.i.
L-Ser-L-Arg
> 20
n.i.
L-Ser-D-Arg
> 20
n.i.
Cbz-Tlir-Arg Cbz-Thx-D-Arg
4-97
L-Thr-L-Arg
6.4 > 20
L-Thr-D-Arg
> 20
+ + n.i. n.i.
Cbz-Pip-Arg
1.2
n. i.
Cbz-Pip-D-Arg Cbz-D-Pip-Arg
1.8
n.i.
8.25
n.i.
Cbz-D-Pip-D-Arg
4.45 7.6
n.i.
L-Pip-L-Arg
n.i.
L-Pip-D-Arg
>20
D-Pip-L-Arg D-Pip-D-Arg
> 20
n.i.
> 20
n.i.
Cbz-Pab-Arg
n.i.
n.i.
Gbz-Pab-D-Arg
inactive inactive
Pab-L-Arg
inactive
n.i.
Pab-D-Arg Boc-D-Tyr/Bzl/-Arg Boc-D-Tyr/Bzl/-D-Arg
inactive > 20 > 20
n. i. n.i.
Boc-Tyr/Br2/-Arg
> 20
n.i.
n.i. n.i.
492
Bo c-Tyr/Br 2 /-D-Arg L-Tyr/Br 2 /-L-Arg L-Tyr/Br 2 /-D-Arg 14, •^C-Tyr-L-Arg 3
H-L-Tyr-L-Arg
3
H-L-Tyr-D-Arg
>20
n.i
>20
n.i
>20
n.i + +
5.3 5.4 2.4
L-Tyr/B^/ L-Pip, D-Pip Pab
+
3,5-dibromo-tyrosine optically active pipecolic acid
p-amino-benzoic acid
Up to now,fifty-two of our synthetic peptides have been tested for analgesic activity and fifteen analogs have similar and/or better activity; some of them with longer-lasting effect. Amo;ig the peptides examined for naloxone antagonism some can be antagonised, some of them probably not. Nine of the eleven new active analogs are partly protected peptides. Further biological examinations are necessary to know more about chemical structure —biological activity relationships and biological role of kyotorphin and its analogs. Fourteen new synthetic analogs which have not been tested up to now are under
analgesia test. A number of analogs are under releasing and behavior effect studies. The radioactive derivatives of kyotorphin and Tyr-D-Arg analog help us to learn more about this new group of opioid peptides.
Acknowledgements We thank P. Eva Henyhart for chemical technical assistance, and Dr. Anna Ottlecz for tremendous help in biological tests.
493
References 1. Takagi, H., Shiomi, H., Ueda, H. and H. Amano: Eur. J. Pharmacol.
109 /1979/.
2. Satoh, M., Kawajiri, M., Yamamoto, M., Akaire, A. and H. Takagi: Ueurosci. Lett. 16, 319 /1980/. 3. Takagi, H., Shiomi, H., Ueda, H. and H. Amano: Nature 282. 410 /1979/. 4. Ueda, H., Shiomi, H. and H. Takagi: Brain Res. 198. 460 /1980/. 5. Ueda, H., Amano, H., Shiomi, H. and H. Takagi: Eur. J. Pharmacol. ¿6, 265 /1979/. 6. Yajima, H., Ogawa, H., Ueda, H. and H. Takagi: Chem. Pharm. Bull. 28, 1935 /1980/. 7. Kubota, M., Uagase, 0., Amano, H., Takagi, H. and H. Yajima: Chem. Phaxra. Bull. 28, 2580 /1980/. 8. Kastin, A. J., Honour, C. H. and D.H. Coy. Phys. Behavior 27, 1073 /1981/. 9. Balasiri, L., P. Menyhart, É., Geese, A., Ottlecz, A., Kovaca K. and Gy. Telegdy: Hungarian Patent announcement 1374/82, 5.30.1982 Budapest. 10. Voskuyl-Holtkaop, I., C. and Schattenkerk; Int. J. Peptide Protein Rea. 1^, 185 /1979/. 11. S. I. Ankier; Bur. J. Phannacol, 2J, 1 /1974/.
OPIOID ACTIVITY OF SYNTHETIC "SMALL DERMORPHINS»
Roberto Tomatis, Severo Salvador! and Gianpietro Sarto Institute of Pharmaceutical Chemistry and Pharmacology, University of Ferrara, Ferrara, Italy
Introduction We previously reported part of our investigation on dermorphin (H-Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-Tyr-Pro-Ser-NH^),
leading to oligo-
peptides which are potent analgesics in vivo following subcutaneous administration (l). Sixty "small dermorphins" have now been prepared and tested for opiate activity in vitro and in vivo. Synthesis.
All peptides were prepared by solution methods
following procedures previously reported for H-Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-NH 2 and H-Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-Tyr-NH,, (l). Guanidino derivatives and aminoxy analogues were obtained according to reported procedures (2,3)« Th© purity of each sample was established as
> 95$.
Biological evaluation.
In vitro methods. The peptides were
examined for their ability to inhibit the electrically induced contractions of guinea-pig ileum (h) (GPI) and mouse vas deferens
(5) (MVD).
In vivo method.
The mouse tail flick assay
was essentially that of Janssen et al. (6) and analgesia was determined as previously described (l). All effects were completely blocked by naloxone. The activities of H-Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-NHg
(l) (Table I) and H-Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-Tyr-NH 2
(37) (Table II) were considered equal to 100, those of the analogues being expressed in percent, on a molar basis. The potency of reference compounds (Table I and II) in the tests were as follows (l): GPI (IC 5 Q a
5.2 + 3.19 nM and 5.38 +
0.06 nM); MVD (IC 5 Q = 510 + 31.82 nM and 86.28 + 6.16 nM); tail-flick test (ED _ = 68 pM/mouse and 22 pM/mouse).
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
496
Table X N° 1
Biological Da ta, of Dermorphin Tetrapeptid.es (On a molar basis) Structure
GPI
MVD
Tail-Fl:
H-Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-NH2
100
100
100
2
H-D-Tyr-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-NH^
0.03
0.03
0.03
3
H-Phe-D-Ala-Phc-Gly-NH^
0.8
1
0.7
4
H-Cly(Ph-4-OH)-D-Ala-Phe-Gly-NH^
0.5
0.4
0.2
5
H-Tyi—Gly-Phe-GlyNH^
0.7
1
0.6
6
H-Tyr-OAla-Phe-Gly-NH^
0.1
0.1
7
H-Tyr-DOAla-Phe-Gly-NH^
0.1
0.1
8
H-Tyr-D-Met-Phe-Gly-NH^
3
6
0.1
9
-
H-Tyi—D-Ala-Phe-Sar-NH^
130
8 6.7 • — O-Pro • OH i 4.03 150 (doc.) + 71.6° «2.4 * |o-*ro | OH 1.2 7.10 167-170 • 16.4° + 1 3»] D-Pro D-Pro OH 1 NO 169-172 «131.7° «2.4 OH — IfrPhQl 1 6.64 210 (dec.) - 55.5° • 1 200 1 O-Tyr - OH 1 3.60 212 (doc.) -122.3° «2.4 • D-Tyr O-Phe OH 1 5.03 214-218 -143.4° no activc — — Phe(Cl) — — OH 2 5.0 3.95 202 (dec.) - 53.5° Phe — - • — — OH 2 7.71 202-209 - 14.4° no active -
;;II XIII ;:iv
Tyr—Pro —Phe —Pro-OH • 1 5.52 • • • • one » 1 11.06 — N H 2 8 l" 3.91
No. coap. I II III
Structure
173-17G 160-173 17G-1C3
- 56.9° -
00.0°
- 55.5°
3.C 14.0 2.4 / 55*#)
«
•
'All compounds were characterized as hydrochlorides, except IV - free base. Homogeneity of the peptides wa.s verified by HPLC and by TLC on silica, gel plates (SilufolR, Kavalier, Czechoslovakia) in four different solvent systems. Amino acid analysis after acidic hydrolysis showed the expected composition. )For III and XIV the Boc-tripeptide and Boc-dipeptide methyl ester, respectively, was converted into the amide. ^Reversed phase HPLC (HPLC-Hewlett Packard 1084D) was performed on a RP 8 column and eluted with 0.025 M KHoPO^, pH 3.0 / methanol (65:35) at a flow rate of 1.2 ml/inin, UV detector at 210 nm. ND - not determined. 3) 'For the determination of the analgesic activity the tail flick test on male Wistar rats was used (electrical stimulation) measuring the effective dose for doubling the pain threshold 30 min/**)10 min after icv. administration of the peptide. For morphine a dose of 6.0 nmol/rat, icv. was determined. The relative activity of morphine is assigned as 100 and peptides are compared to it on the molar basis. k) 'For enzymatio degradation in vitro peptides were incubated at 30°C (pH 7.6) with the peptidase and the hydrolysis of the peptides was followed by TLC as a function of time: (+) = degradation, (-) = no degradation. - These pharmacological results demonstrate, that the introduction of D-Pro and D-Phe , respectively, in the p-CM-5 sequence leads to analogues with remarka.bly high analgesic
508
potency and enhanced s t a b i l i t y tion.
towards enzymatic
2
- Replacement of
Pro
g i v e an i n c r e a s e i n - The change o f
by i t s D-enantiomer, however, does n o t potency.
the C - t e r m i n a l carboacyl group by amida.tion
causes a marked i n c r e a s e i n a n a l g e s i c The
degrada-
activity.
h i g h e s t a n a l g e s i c a c t i v i t y wa.s f o u n d f o r compound V,
deprolorphin
(7).
A l r e a d y 0 . 5 nmol i c v .
significantly
sed the p a i n t h r e s h o l d . The e f f e c t i s dosedependent, maximal v a l u e s a t about 10 nmol i c v .
increareaching
1 . 6 8 nmol d e p r o l o r p h i n
proved t o be e q u i p o t e n t t o 6 . 0 nmol morphine and 1 7 . 0 nmol morphiceptin ( 6 ) ,
d o u b l i n g the pa.in t h r e s h o l d . A f t e r i c v .
m i n i s t r a t i o n of 5 . 0 nmol d e p r o l o r p h i n a. s i g n i f i c a n t
ad-
analgesic
potency c o u l d be o b t a i n e d up t o 90 min. T h i s a.ction was comp l e t e l y b l o c k e d by i c v .
pretrea.tment w i t h 2k,0
15 min b e f o r e p e p t i d e a d m i n i s t r a t i o n .
nmol n a l t r e x o n
Furthermore
deprolor-
phin r e v e a l e d an a n a l g e s i c a.ction even a f t e r i n t r a v e n o u s
ad-
m i n i s t r a t i o n - 7«0yumol/kg w e r e e q u i p o t e n t t o 4.0yumol/^cg morphine. Consequently,
[3-casomorphin analogues a r e a b l e t o produce
a n a l g e s i c a c t i o n s w i t h a p o t e n c y a t l e a s t as h i g h as by p o t e n t e n k e p h a l i n s , action with^u-receptors
obtained
but proba.bly due t o a. s e l e c t i v e
inter-
(2,6,8).
Further s t r u c t u r a l m o d i f i c a t i o n s of
the (3-oasomorphin m o l e -
cule are i n preparation to g e t a d d i t i o n a l information i n f i e l d of s t r u c t u r e - a c t i v i t y
the
relationship.
References 1.
Henschen, A . , L o t t s p e i c h , F . , B r a n t l , V . , H . : H o p p e - S e y l e r ' s Z. P h y s i o l . Chem. 360, (1979).
Teschemacher, 1217-1224
2.
B r a n t l , V. , Teschemacher, H, , B l a . s i g , J . , Henschen, L o t t s p e i c h , F . : L i f e S c i . 28, 1903-1909 (1981).
A.,
509 3.
G r e c k s c h , G. , S c h w e i g e r t , C h r . , L e t t e r s 27, 325-328 ( l 9 8 l ) .
k.
H a r t r o d t , B . , N e u b e r t , K . , F i s c h e r , G. . S c h u l z , B a r t h , A . : P h a r m a z i e 37, 165-1Ö9 ( 1 9 8 2 ) .
5.
H a r t r o d t , B . , N e u b e r t , K . , F i s c h e r , G . , Derauth, U . , Y o s h i m o t o , T . , B a r t h , A . : P h a r m a z i e 37, 7 2 - 7 3 ( 1 9 8 2 ) .
6.
Chang, K . - J . , Chang, J . - K . :
K i l l i a n , A , , Ha.zum, A . , Cua.treca.sas, S c i e n c e 212, 75-77 ( l 9 8 l ) .
P.,
7.
Matthies, Hartrodt,
Rüthrich, H . - L . , Barth, A., Neubert, Europ. J . P h a r m a c o l , ( i n p r e s s ) .
K. ,
8.
Zhang,
H., B,:
A.-Z.,
Chang,
28, 2829-2836 ( 1 9 8 1 ) .
J.-K.,
Matthies,
Pasternak,
H.:
G.W.:
Neurosci, H.,
Life
Sei.
SUBSTANCE P:
THE "YIN-YANG" OF BEHAVIOR?
John M. Stewart and Michael E. Hall
Department of Biochemistry, university of Colorado School of Medicine Denver, Colorado 80262 USA
It is generally accepted that substance P (SP) may play a variety of roles as a neurotransmitter or neuromodulator in addition to its longstudied actions in causing smooth muscle contraction, vasodilatation and salivary secretion (1). Its widespread occurrence in both the central (CNS) and peripheral (PNS) nervous systems has been esiablished in recent years, long since the original observation by Lembeck (2) of a high concentration of SP in dorsal roots of spinal cord. On the basis of that observation, he proposed in 1953 that SP is a neurotransmitter of sensory impulses in the spinal cord.
This prediction has been
confirmed, at least as far as thermal sensory neurons are concerned.
It
appears that red pepper (Capsicum app.) is "hot" (piquant) because its active principle, capsaicin, causes release of SP from these neurons (3). the past work with SP has established that the C-terminal pentapeptide, -Phe-Phe-Gly-Leu-Met-NH2, is the "active core" for all the biological activities of SP described so far; the N-terminal hexapeptide, Arg-Pro-Lys-Pro-Gln-Gln-, has been considered to have no inherent activity, but to increase potency by protecting against degradation or increasing receptor affinity. number of behavioral responses.
SP is known to produce a
SP-induced tranquilization was
described in 1957 (4), and its antinociceptive action in 1976 (5). In this latter work the suggestion was first made that SP might require metabolism to an active fragment before it exerted its antinociceptive effect. We wish to describe our experiments which further support this idea and show that antinociception (analgesia) is produced by peptides related to the N-terminus of SP. Such N-terminal peptides also shew other kinds of biological activity, in certain cases producing effects on behavior opposite to those produced by C-terminal SP fragments.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
512
IVo brain enzymes have been described which cleave SP: the "post-proline cleaving enzyme" (6) which cleaves SP between residues 4 and 5 and the enzyme described by Benuck and Marks (7), which cleaves SP between the two phenylalanine residues. Considering that the latter enzyme would completely inactivate SP for the previously described activities, we thought it might prove to be in fact a processing enzyme which would selectively activate SP for antinociceptive action. Thus we tested SP(17), a product of the action of this enzyme of SP, and found this fragment to possess the full antinociceptive potency of SP (8). Consistent with the processing hypothesis, SP(l-7) antinociception was rapid in onset and short in duration of action, whereas intact SP produced an antinociception of long duration, following a long lag period (even after intracerebroventricular injection). Remarkably, the SP(l-7) antinociception was also seen following peripheral administration (as was that produced by intact SP), and the ratio of intracerebroventricular to subcutaneous dose for production of an equivalent effect suggested that the peptide was acting centrally in each case. The dose-response curve, like that of SP, was bell-shaped; antinociceptive action was seen only within a relatively narrow dose range and disappeared at higher doses. The SP(l-7) analgesia, like that elicited by SP, was blocked by the opiate antagonist naloxone. In studying SP-induced antinociception we observed a marked interaction with stress reactions. When mice treated with SP rested quietly following peptide administration they showed antinociception, but when they were excited by agitation conccmitant with group housing, no antinociceptive action of SP was seen. It is known that restraintinduced stress produces a naloxone-reversible ("cpioid") analgesia in mice, while the acute stress of brief electrical foot-shock produces a very strong analgesia not reversible by naloxone ("non-opioid"). We found that SP blocked the opioid type of stress-induced analgesia but had no effect on the non-opioid type. It has been suggested that SP produces analgesia by stimulating release of Met-enkephalin in the CNS(9); it now appears that during restraint-induced stress SP can inhibit release of endogenous opioids.
513
Arg-Pro-Lys-Pro-Gln-Gln-Phe-Phe-Gly-Leu-Met-NH2 Substance P Post-Pro / enzyme /
\ Marks' \ enzyme
Arg-Pro-Lys-Pro SP(l-4) + Gln-Gln-Phe-Phe-Gly-Leu-Met-NH2 SP(5-11)
Arg-Pro-Lys-Pro-Gln-Gln-Phe SP(l-7) + Phe-Gly-Leu-Met-NH2 SP(8-11)
Having discovered this biological activity of SP(l-7), we then examined other behavioral models for effects of SP, SP(l-7) and the potent Cterminal fragment analog, pyroglutamyl-Phe-Phe-Gly-Leu-Met-NH2 ( to X u C O C O
( • L O
S
oo i O rH L O r~t
1 O rH
00 •
o rH
I
§
« N r. 1 X « I I X o——o — o —y 1
H C O co o co a UJ h H O u H H Q O s
P U E 1 < D C O
00
to S C U O
o C T .
e 3 0) T — ( • rH M •H O. cfl < D C •H 3 M C o
(1) fi E I _ I I Ì y—O—O—O—O
C i-H
+
\D 1 O i-H O
1 — 1 C M O
A o\° C •H
H CJ O 1 o
c¿ Et/3 I X I X X o —o — o — o — o
< D
T
ru
Z
V D L O
tu j
X p •r-t G •H 4H 4-1 al a)
>
co < H
O < X I I X y — < r > — o — o — o
P a >
S
O o ^
O ^
•H P ai rH (U tu tn •rH
•rH
Ul P O tu < D ai -o -(H X O p u P •H •H Pu t/l P 1) O Q J C P. 3 •H i—i H P U ai p p O C c 1 •H o o 0) X O i—l co ai rH ai Ci 3 4h e •H U •o O "O X c
t a > (D tn •H o tu M X < D 3 o t-4 < D p ai X 3
— 1 e p X 1 ai o CD e a > X ai f-t P
ra
ra ra ra < >
>
ra ra
1 . 3
+
0 . 1 1
0 . 7 5
1
0 . 0 8
5.82
SP(l-ll)
6 . 3 0 / 6 . 6 0 0
ILEIM.
: RAT BLOOD PRESSURE. G.P.T.
5.96
10
6.00/6.000
10
6 . 6 3 / 6 . 9 0 «
SPC6-U)
R.B.P,
10 10
SP(6-11)
L
IL
2
6.30/6.50#
R.H. = RABBIT ISOLATED PERFUSED HEART,
D.C.A.
= DOG CAROTID ARTERY,
G.P.I.
•• GUINEA PIG
S GUINEA PIG TRACHEA,
N
: NUMBER OF DETERMINATIONS,
"
: I D 5 0 IN MICROGRAMS/IOOG BODY WEIGHT.
I
•• THE PA2 VALUES ARE CALCULATED IN PRESENCE OF ATROPIN (IOOO/NG/MJ .
PRODUCTSAND_Z
PA2-FA 1 0 I S ALWAYS 0 . 9 8 ± 0 . 0 7 (TRUE C C W E T I T I V I T Y )
ARE A V A I L A B L E
"
FROM BACHEM,
•• I D 5 0 IN HICROGROTS/M/MIN.
SWITZERLAND.
The synthetic procedures are not yet ideal for the production of exotic poly-Trp peptides containing Met, too many sidereactions occur and lower the product yields.
We believe
that the t-butylalkylation of Trp during the TFA cycle is the main reason, because most by products have higher lipophilicity and have the same amino acid analysis as far as Trp can be monitored quantitatively.
References 1.
U.S. von Euler and J.H. Gaddum, J. Physiol. Land. 72 : 74 (1931).
2.
S. Rosell and K. Folkers, Trends in Pharmacol, sci. 211 (1982).
3.
S. Caranikas, J. Mizrahi, P. D'Orléans-Juste and D. Regoli, Eur. J. Pharmacol. 77_: 205 (1982).
SUBSTANCE P: INACTIVATION
IN CNS, ENZYMATICALLY RESISTANT ANALOGUE AND
DEVELOPMENT OF "BRAIN SELECTIVE" AGONIST
Bengt
E.B.
Sandberg,
Michael
R.
Hanley,
Leslie
L.
Iversen,
John
E.
Maggio, Robert R.D. Pinnock, Stephen P. Watson MRC Neurochemical Pharmacology Unit, MRC Centre, Hills Road, Cambridge CB2 2QH, United Kingdom
Substance P (SP) is present in neurons of the mammalian central nervous system
and
is
widely
Recently we reported
regarded
bound metalloendopeptidase Phe7-Phe®
a
putative
neurotransmitter
(1).
from human brain with a high specificity for
SP which cleaves the peptide Phe 7 ,
as
the isolation and characterization of a membrane-
and
in one of the following positions; Gln^-
Phe®-Gly^
(2).
Based
on this cleavage
pattern a
number of SP analogues were synthesized with the aim of protecting these peptide bonds in SP while retaining biological activity.
One of these
"DiMe-C7" is metabolically stable to rat brain both in vivo and in vitro (3.4).
It is virtually equipotent to SP in the rat brain binding assay
(3.5) as well as in its ability to excite neurons in the rat substantia nigra (6). guinea
Although "DiMe-C7" is metabolically stable in the isolated
pig
ileum
observations test
that
systems
attention
than
on
the
the potency
is only 4% of that of
N-terminal in
any
fragments
of
possibility
the of
of
SP.
SP were more
peripheral developing
Furthermore
potent
in CNS
bioassays
focussed
"brain
selective"
our SP
analogues (7).
In peripheral tissues we have postulated two sub-classes of SP receptors ("SP-P"
and
"SP-E")
based
on
different
rank
order
of
potency
tachykinins as well as on different cross-desensitization (8).
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
of
536 Methods
BocArgProLys(Boc)GlnGlnPhePheGlyLeuMet-OCH2—CO-Ala-polyamide was
synthesised
presence each
a
step-wise
of H 0 B t ( 4 e q )
amino
acid
reactions peptide resin
in
in DMF.
complete
although
within
resin with DCC(6eq)
in
the
alkylesters methyl
presence and
ester
aminoethyl
with
purified
on
an
analytical
HPLC
peptide
the
and
in
as
on
report
into " S P - P "
(guinea-pig
(rat
we p r o p o s e d
duodenum,
one
of
the
tentative
analogue
with (Fig.
results
bioassays the also
of
native the
or
(l:l,v/v)
C-8
SP
peptides
TLC
peptide
protected
SP
protected
SP
gave
the
analogues
column
were
systems.
the
the
2were
(2.2x25cm),
and d e s a l t e d
on a
found h o m o g e n o u s
Molecular
weights
on
were
mass-spectrometry
with
considerably 2). from the
The
bladder)
SP-E in
hydrophobicity
S P - P s y s t e m s , but
sub-division
type, SP-P of
the
namely
the
of
(7,8).
SP-P
corresponding
increased
decrease
SP
receptors
while
it
alkyl
SP the
is
We
type.
for
methyl
the
ester
the
reduces
SP-P
the an
type the
of SP-P
analogue
equipotent size
the
for
yielded
for
this
approximately
s e e m s to h a v e o n l y a m i n o r
and
report
Replacing
ester
ester
p o t e n c y of
Increasing
now
the s e l e c t i v i t y
methyl
selectivity of in
systems. the
subtypes
P itself can increase
selectivity
a large
peptide
a tentative
sub-classes,
carboxamide
receptor sites
resin
Boc-protected Zorbax
of
test
to
i l e u m , g u i n e a pig v a s d e f e r e n s , rat b l a d d e r ) hamster
t h a t m o d i f i c a t i o n of s u b s t a n c e
methionine
ninhydrin coupled
desired
of e t h a n e d i t h i o l
The
two
the
methanol
The
column.
the was
Discussion
In a r e c e n t
"SP-E"
same
1).
c o n f i r m e d b y fast a t o m b o m b a r d m e n t
Results
from
Boc-Arg
of
in the p r e s e n c e
well
for
Transesterification
Semi-preparative
as
time of 60 m i n w a s a l l o w e d
gave
(Fig.
(1.6x90cm)
the
judging
in D M F .
resin in
min.
diaminoethane
with TFA
G-15
30
Fmoc-AA-0NP(4eq)
triethylamine
treatment
derivative
deprotected Sephadex
of
using
A coupling
derivative
were
manner
and
in
with
thereby
potency
e f f e c t o n the a l r e a d y
in
the
low
537
*,E-diBoc-SP-OCH2 ^o^-CO-X-resin
O • A A
GPI Guinea pig ileum * HB Hamster bladder GPB - bladder • RD Rat d u o d e n u m GPV •• vas deferens RB Rat bladder O RBB Rat brain binding
538 potencies
in
the
SP-E
systems
(Fig.
2).
The
selectivity
of
the
substance P alkyl esters for the SP-P systems is not likely to be due to a
different
rate
of hydrolysis
of
the
esters
since
(1l-desamido)-SP
which would be the obvious result of such a process is about 10 times more potent than substance P methyl ester in the two SP-E systems (8) . It is not clear if the postulated subclasses of peripheral SP receptors Substance P methylester
are also present in the central nervous system.
is equipotent to subst ance P both in the rat brain binding assay and in depolarising
locus
coeruleus
tissues of the SP-P type.
neurons
(9),
thus
However, increasing
resembling
peripheral
the size of the ester
moiety increases the potency in the rat brain binding assay reaching a maximum potency for the propyl ester.
"DiMe-C7" exhibit
(Glp-Gln-Phe-MePhe-MeGly-Leu-Met-NH2)
a high metabolic
vivo (4).
resistance
been
shown
to
in CNS, both in vitro (3) and in
It is also highly resistant to enzymatic degradation in the
guinea pig ileum assay (Fig. 3). using
has
Protection of the main cleavage sites
substance P degrading enzyme as a model
achieved
by
positions.
incorporation
of
N-methyl
for SP inactivation was
amino
acids
in
appropriate
Replacement of Gly^ with N-methyl glycine did not affect the
potency of this analogue in the peripheral bioassays or in the CNS test systems.
An analogue
corresponding
N-methyl
where both Phe® amino
and Gly^ were replaced
acids retained
virtually
full
by the
biological
activity in the CNS test systems but its potency in peripheral bioassays was reduced about 10-20 fold (3,8).
Because methylation of the amide nitrogen of a peptide bond makes the cis-
and
observed.
transFor
conformers example,
nearly
equal
in
in the heptapeptide
energy, both
isomers
Glp^MeGly^SPj_j^,
are
^H-NMR
spectroscopy clearly shows the cis- and the trans- isomers of the PheMeGly peptide bond (Fig. 4), with N-CH3 resonances at 2.78 and 2.91 ppm respectively; the cis-/trans- ratio is about 40/60 at room temperature. From line shape analysis the rates of interconversion of the isomers can be calculated, and the activation energy (AG? = +21.7 kcal) derived from
539
Time (min)
Fig. 3. Tritiated peptides (4-, 5) were incubated in a 2 ml organ bath with guinea pig ileum (10% of the bath volume) and aliquots were taken at different time points and assayed by TLC. The TLC plates were scraped at the level of the appropriate standards and counted by liquid scintillometry. Each point is the mean + SEM (N=3).
solvent MET S-CH„ transN-CH,
Fig
cisN-CH.,
W O MHz ^ - N M R spectrum of [pip 5 ,MeGly^] substance P (5-11) dg-DMSO, 25
540 an Arrhenius p l o t . temperature. methyl
DiMe-C7 a l s o
peptide
isomers
Each isomer has a h a l f - l i f e of a few seconds at room
bonds.
is m e t a b o l i c a l l y
a c t i v e at the
Results
a
series
for
more
relative
rat
potent
of
However,
since
derivative
in
retained.
these the
None of
peripheral
two N-
possible
know which of
them i s
extensions
of
substance
P
2-aminoethyl
derivative
being
CNS
than
peripheral
bioassays,
in
the
are
500-1500 all
less
bioassays
amine or b l o c k i n g
rat
brain
potent the
binding
than the
The
seems
to
neither
substance
seem u n l i k e l y
In order
and
substituent
to
substance increase
size be
as
of
these
of
it
assay.
2-aminoethyl
analogues in v a r i o u s
to be due to a higher
account
for
differences
P by metabolism in
well
important
P propyl
same degree
degree
The low potency of
would
a thousand-fold
the
are
the
is
analogues
the
in
SP-
tissues.
SP.
potency
selectivity
bioassays
of
f u n c t i o n to a t e r t i a r y
the
peripheral
of
exhibits
its
four
these analogues showed any p r e f e r e n c e f o r SP-P or
degradation.
that
yet
the
the
rat
derivatives
enzymatic
to
2-aminoethyl
CNS,
in
decrease
E in p e r i p h e r a l
these
we do not
of
The r e s u l t s of these analogues show a remarkable
the 2-aminoethyl
acetylation
postulate
isomers at
to substance P.
Converting by
of
none
receptor.
from
selectivity
a mixture
we know that
degraded,
summarised in Table 1.
times
exhibits
While
the r a t e as
for
ester
selectivity.
alone,
the
chemical CNS
the
in
nature
structural
to
of
the since
derivative
The CNS s e l e c t i v i t y set of
has
relative
selectivity
N-methylamide
of
potency
one
degradation
a high
nor
analogues may suggest a s l i g h t l y d i f f e r e n t
of
rate
of
these
requirement
541
Table 1 Relative potencies of substance P analogues with selectivity for CNS (MetNHR 1:L )-.SP
3
H-SP
Rat
Rat
substantia
spinal
nigra
cord4*
100
100
100
0.05-0.16
750
750
100
0.05-0.08
120
-c2h4nhcoch3
0.06-0.07
63
"DiMe-C7"
4-10
40
Peripheral bioassays
R 100
-ch3
13
8-100 +
-C2HitNH(CH3)2
a
Ra t bra in binding
-H -c2h4nh3
3
+
100
Potencies were determined relative to substance P using a
2x2 assay and represent the mean of at least three determinations. The highest and the lowest potencies among the following bioassays are given; Guinea pig ileum, Guinea pig vas deferens, Rat bladder (representing the SP-P type) and Rat vas deferens, Rat duodenum, Hamster bladder
(representing
the SP-E type). b
3 Peptides were tested against 2 nM
H-substance P and compa-
red with substance P by the ratio of
for
peptide. Q Extracellular recording the number of spikes during the peptide response was compared with the number during the substance P response (N=10 cells). The amounts of SP-C 2 H^NH^ + discharged from microelectrodes by micro-pressure were measured directly by radioimmunoassay in parallel experiments. ^ The ventral root potential was recorded in immature rat hemisected spinal cord. The relative potency of the analogue was determined from parallel dose response curves (N=6), see ref. 11.
542 for
substance
spinal
cord
P
in
its
receptors
interaction with compared
with
a sub-class
the
of
receptors
in
rat brain the
This notion has received some support from other observations
and
periphery. (12).
Acknowledgements
We
thank
the
University
Chemical
Laboratories,
Williams for access to the NMR and Mass
Cambridge
and
Dr
D.H.
spectrometers.
References
1.
Ciba Found. Symposium no.91: Substance P in the Nervous System, ed. , in press.
2.
Lee, C.-M., Sandberg, B.E.B., Hanley, M.R., Iversen, L.L.: Eur. J. Biochem. 114, 315-327 (1981).
3.
Sandberg, B.E.B., Lee, C.-M., Hanley, M.R., Iversen, L.L.: Eur. J. Biochem. IIA, 329-337.
4.
Sandberg, B.E.B., Hanley, M.R., Watson, S.P., Brundish, D.E., Wade, R. , Eison, A.S.: FEBS Lett. 137, 236-240 (1982).
5.
Hanley, M. , Sandberg, B.E.B., Lee, C.-M., Iversen, L.L., D.E., Wade, R.: Nature (Lond.) 286, 810-812
6.
Pinnock,
R.,
Sandberg,
B.E.B.:
The
Brundish,
(1980).
International
Symposium
on
Brain-Gut Axis, Florence, Italy. 7.
Sandberg, press .
B.E.B.,
8.
Lee, C.-M.,
Iversen,
L.L.:
"Perspective"
J.
Med.
Chem.,
Iversen, L.L., Hanley, M.R., Sandberg, B.E.B.:
Schmiedebergs Arch. Pharmacol. 318, 281-287
in
Naunyn-
(1982).
9.
Pinnock, R.: unpublished
10.
Eison, A.S., Iversen, S.D., Sandberg, B.E.B., Watson, S.P., Hanley, M.R., Iversen, L.L.: Science 215, 188-190 (1982).
11.
Brown, J., Tyers, M.B.: unpublished
12.
Piercey,
M.R.,
Dobry,
results.
P.J.K.,
results.
Einspahr,
Masiques, N. : Regulatory Peptides _3_, 337-349
F.J.,
Schroeder,
(1982).
L.A.,
SOME PHARMACEUTICAL ASPECTS OF PEPTIDE RESEARCH Lajos Kisfaludy Chemical Works of Gedeon Richter Ltd. 1475 Budapest, P.O.B. 27., Hungary
The present review is an attempt at giving a brief survey
of
the practical results attained so far and the expected future trends in peptide chemistry; the underlying principle is that all achieved goals pave the way for further successful research. This way is not easy: the clinicians expect compounds useful in the treatment of diseases which are noncurable or hardly curable today; in addition economical aspects must also be considered. Peptide research is thus part of the general pharmaceutical research, and as such, it is multidisciplinary; it is only a creative and cooperative effort of chemists, biologists and physicians which can result in success. Table 1 lists synthetic peptides already on the market, giving the names, the number of amino acid residues, manufacturers, the year of marketing and, finally, the application. Table 1. Marketed synthetic peptide drugs Amino Manufacturer/s/ Year of Application : Name acids Y~orrT cf i nn registration Oxytocin
9
Sandoz,Richter
1955
obstetrics
Vasopressin
9
Sandoz,Ferring
1961
diabetes
Hypertensin
8
Ciba-Geigy
1959
shock-state
Ciba-Geigy,
1965
ACTH-therapy
Ferring,Spofa Spof a
•insipidus
Synacthen
24
Alisactide
17
Hoechst
1982
ACTH-therapy
Humachtid
32
Richter
1983
ACTH-therapy
ICI
1969
diagnostics
Nippon Kayaku
198o
Organon
Pentagastrin
5
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
544 Table 1. /Continued/ Name
Amino
Manufacturer/s/
acids
Year of
Application
registration
TRH
3
Roche
CCK-OP
8
1974
diagnostics
Calcitonin
32
Squibb Sandoz
1974
Ca-metabolism
Somatostatin"*"
14
Serono
198o
8
Norwich
198o
haemorrhage diagnostics
9
Hoechst
1981
Squibb
1981
Saralasin Buserelin
2
Captopril"^
diagnostics
as contraceptive hypertension
The therapeutic value of the compounds can be characterized by the fact that such old drugs like oxytocin and vasopressin are still indispensable in obstetrics and in the treatment of diabetes insipidus. Compounds with diagnostic use are also of importance, while the real value of the newly marketed ones will show in the years to come. Table 2 contains potential peptide
drugs of the future, selected for development, mainly
on the basis of data supplied by Scrip, Pharmaprospects, Drugs of the Future, etc. Table 2. Peptides under development Peptides TRH analogs
Manufacturer / s /
5
LH-RH analogs
Takeda,Merck,Richter Reckitt-Colman Syntex,Takeda-Abbott
ACE inhibitors
Merck,Squibb,Santen,
Proposed action CNS stimulant contraceptive,anticancer antihypertensive
Am.Cynamid,Schering, Revlon,Yoshitomi,Dainippon Thymus hormones^ Roche,Ortho,Janssen g
immunostimulant
Richter,Hoechst
Ang-II analogs
Norwich,Kowa,Daiichi,
Somatostatin 9 analogs
Merck,Ciba-Geigy,UCB Wyeth
antihypertensive
Seiyaku,Richter control of diabetes, haemorrhage
545
Table 2. /Continued / Manufacturer/s/
Peptides
Enkephalin analogs ° Wellcome,Sandoz
Proposed action neuroleptic,narcotic
Roche,Lilly,Reckitt Richter,Am.Home
11
Ayerst,Abbott,
antidepressant,control
Hoechst
of parkinsonism
Vasopressin 12
Searle,Organon,
diuretic,memory
analogs
Ferring
improvement
Organon
neuroleptic
Organon
memory improvement immunostimu1ant
MIF analogs
Des-Tyr1- ^ -endorphin"*"^
14
ACTH fragments Muramyl-dipeptides
Thiorphan
16
15
Syntex,Daiichi Seiyaku Ciba-Geigy Janssen-Lebrun
enkephalinase inhibitor
The information in the Table 2 allows some conclusions concerning the international trends and the importance of the basic research. 1. The research of protease inhibitors
has met with success
in the recent years. It is known that certain proteases such as human leucocyte elastase, cathepsin G, collagenase, etc. have to important role in the development of chronic diseases, like arthritis, emphysema and some inflammatory diseases. Inhibition of these enzymes by natural or synthetic compounds may have significant therapeutical value. These compounds should have functional groups capable of effective regio-, and stereospecific interaction with the active center of the enzyme. These interactions are essentially ionic, hydrogen and hydrophobic bonds and, in the case of metal-containing enzymes, metal-ion bonds. The more selective this interaction, in other words, if only one type of enzyme is inhibited, the better the expected therapeutical value, possibly without side effects. An excellent example of putting theoretical considerations
546 into practice is the research of inhibitors of the angiotensin converting enzyme, of whiche one compound is already on the market /see Table 1./. 2. The research of thymus hormones
seems to be a new trend,
especially from the therapeutical point of view. The immunomodulating properties of these compounds enable them to ameliorate immunodeficient states and to treat some cancer diseases. Representatives of them are thymopoietin, thymosin, and their fragments, some of which are in the stage of clinical trial. Though in the case of these compounds - similarly to other hormones - it has been shown that shorter fragments also exhibit biological action in some tests, according to our own results the principle of "active center" should be revised here. 3. Evaluation of the results of the recent years has also confirmed the importance of methodological developments. /a/ The newly introduced and refined biological techniques, such as RIA, immunohistochemical, immunofluorescent, etc. methods led to the discovery of more than 25 regulatory peptides. It was possible to detect them not only in their original place, i.e. in the brain or in the gastrointestinal tract, but practically in the whole body. This observation gave new impetus to research because it immediately raised the question about the role of a typical gut peptide in the brain and vice-versa. In several cases it has been confirmed that the same hormone may have different effects, and in some instances the new effects may have a greater practical importance. Table 3 lists these new effects and their expectable applications. Table 3. Newly discovered actions of peptides and expected applications Peptides
Original action
New action
TRH and analogs
TH and Prolaction release
CNS actions
CCK peptides 17
gall-bladder contract, anticonvulsive,anorexigenic,antischisophrenic
547
Table 3. /Continued/ Peptides
Original action
New action
c ytostatic
LH-RH analogs
LH release
Ang-II analogs
hypertensive
hypotensive
Vasopressin
antidiuretic
memory improvement
Somatostatin
GH,insulin,glucagon
antihaemorrhagic
18
Tufstin Calcitonin 19
gastrin inhibition fagocyte stimulation Ca-metabolism reg.
analgetic anorexigenic
The importance of the synthesis of analogs is obvious. To give
only one example, in our laboratory about forty new TRH
analogs have been prepared to attain higher selectivity, i.e. to separate the hormonal effect from CNS activities. It has turned out that replacemert of the central His in the molecule by an aliphatic amino acid results in the practical abolishment of the hormonal effect, while certain CNS tests show enhanced activity as compared with the parent compound, /b/ Refinement of the methods used for conformational analysis led to a new field, to the investigation of the relationship between conformation and biological activity /CAR/. If we accept that certain peptides have different receptors where different effects are elicited, it can be assumed that the conformation of the same hormone will also change. Thus, the analysis of conformational properties offers a possibility to design new, more selective analogs. Summarizing, it seems that the horizon of peptide research is becoming wider and wider and the realization of developing new peptides with high therapeutical value is drawing near. References 1.
Kayesseh,L. et al. : Lancet 198o 844 ; Scrip 5_31 13 /198o/.
2.
Koch,H.: Pharmacy Internat. 1981 99.
3.
Ondetti,M.A. et al.: Science 196 441 /1977 / ; Scrip 568 13 /1981 / .
548 4.
Brown,M.R.: Life Sci. 28 1789 /1981/; Miyamoto,M. et al.: Life Sci. 28 861 /1981/; Metcalf,G. et al.: Regulatory Peptides 3 193 /1982/; Rastogi,R.B. et al.: Res.Comm.Chem. Pathol.Pharmacol. 32 187 /1981/; Drugs of the Future 7 167 /19 8 2/ ; Scrip 642 12 /1981/.
5.
Coy,D.H. et al.: Endocrinology llo 1445 /1982/; Rabin,D. et al.: New England J.of Med. 3o5 663 /1981 / ; Scrip 555 15 /1981 / ; £28 15 /1981/; £58 15 /1982/; £82 15 /1982 / .
6.
Condon,M.E. et al.: J.Med.Chem. 25 25o /1982/; Ondetti, M.A. et al.: J.Med.Chem. 24 355 /1981 /; Patchett, A .A. et al.:Nature 288 28o /198o/; Gauras,H.: Lancet II. 543 /1981 / ; 628 15 /1981/; 65o 11 /1981 /; Too 14 /19 8 2/ ; 7oo 13 /1982/.
7.
Goldstein,A. et al.: Rec.Prog.Hormone Res. 3J_ 369 /1981/; Scrip 6ol 19 /1981 / ; 614 15 /1981/; 633 11 /1982/;
673 15
/1982/. 8. Khosla,M.C. et al.: Biochem.Pharmacol. 28_ 2867 /i979/;Drugs of the Future 5 295 /1981/; 6 159 /1981/ ; Scrip 648 15 /1981 / . 9.
Veber,D.F.:Nature 292 55 /19 81 / ; Szabo,S. et al.:Experientia 38 254 /1982/; Drugs of the Future 6 491 and 515 /1981/; Scrip 531_ 13 /198o/; 6o7 16 /1981/; Freidinger,R. G. et al.: Science 21o 656 /198o/.
10. Morley,J.S.: Ann.Rev. Pharmacol.Toxicol. 2o 81 /198o/. 11. De Wied,D.: Life Sci. 2o. 195 /1977/. 12. Frederickson,R.C.A. et al.: Science 21o 6ol /1981/; Weingartner, H. et al.: Science 211 6ol /1981/; Berkovitz, B.A. et al.: J. Pharm.Exp.Ther. 22o 329 /1982/; Manning,M. et al.: J.Med.Chem.
2o
/1982/.
13. Drugs of the Future 6 2o /1981/. 14. Branconnier,R.J. et al.: Psychopharmacology £1 161 /1979 / ; Greven,H.M.,de Wied,D.: in Perspectives in Peptide Chemistry /eds.A.Eberle, R.Geiger,T.Wieland/
S.Karger,
Basel, 1981, p.356; van Wimersma Greidanns,Tj.B.:Peptides 3 7 /1982/; Drugs of the Future 7 319 /1982/; Scrip 641 15 /1981 / .
549
15. 81st Ann.Meet.Am.Soc.Microbiol./Dallas/ 1981 Abs. E63, E64 ; Japan J.Bacterid. 36. 1 4 6
/1981/.
16. Roques,P. et al.: Nature 288 286 /198o/; Scrip 545 12 /198o/. 17. Morley, J.E. et al.: Life Sci. 3o 479 /1982/ ; Zetler,G.: Eur.J.Pharm. 65 297 /198o/; Scrip 599 14 /198o/; 61o 15 /1981/:Staaher, et al.: Peptides 1 133 /1982/. 18. Herman,Z.S. et al.: Experientia 37 76 /1981/; Nishioka,K. et al.: Life Sci. 28 lo81 /1981/. 19. Morley,J.E. et al.: Peptides 3 167 /1982/.
THE SYNTHESIS AND GONADOTROPIC ACTIVITY OF /D-Tle 6 , Pro-NH-Et 9 /LRF
Martin Flegel Leciva - Pharmaceuticals, Laboratory of Peptides, 143 10 Prague k, Czechoslovakia
Clan Pospisek Institute of Organic Chemistry and Biochemistry, Czechoslovak Academy of Sciences 166 10 Prague, Czechoslovakia
Josef Picha, Drahomira Pichova Institute of Animals Production, 251 610 Prague, Czechoslovakia
Introduction
The study of "superactive" analogues of LRF has pointed to their possible use in human and veterinary medicine. In low dose it may serve in therapy of ovarian disturbancies and in induction of ovulation for control of reproductory cycle in milk-cow. In high dose it may be used for interruption of estrous cycle in fattened cattle, as contraceptive (1, 2) and in therapy of some endocrinedependent tumors (3). We were interested in the influence of substitution of Gly^in LRF by the bulky D-tert-leucine on the secretion of LH and FSH. The activity of /D- T l e 6 , Pro-NH-Et 9 /LRF (I) and /D-Tle 6 , Arg(Tos) 8 , Pro-NH-Et 9 /LRF (II) was studied in 10 and 200 ,ug dose stimulating secretion of LH and FH.
Synthesis
The synthesis was performed by fragment condensation in solution. The guanido group of arginine was protected with tosyl residue. Benzyloxycarbonyl group was used for N-alpha protection.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
552 Fig. 1. The scheme of the synthesis of /D-Tle^, Pro-NH-Et 9 /LRF pGlu
His
Trp
Ser
Tyr
D-Tle
Leu Z-
DCHA Z(HC1).
OMe
DCHA Z-
Z
OMe
OMe OMe N2H3
Z
N 2 h 3 HZ
Arg Tos
Pro ^
^-Tos --Tos ^Tos -Tos ^-Tos 'Tos xTos
Leu-Ard(Tos)-Pro-NH-Et was synthetized by pivaloylchloride method and p-Glu-His-OHe a Z-Ser-Tyr-OMe were prepared in the same way. Fragments were condensed by azide method. The coupling of Z-Tle accomplished by DCCI condensation catalyzed with N-hydroxybenztriazole in dichloromethane was slow but nevertheless yieled 82% of product. Deblocking of Z was performed either with hydrogen bromide solution (20°C, 20 min ) or in case of tetrapeptide 6 and hexapeptide^_ 9 by hydrogenolysis on palladium. The tosyl group was split off at the end of the synthesis with 5« TFMSA in TFA (60 min , 0°C) in the presence of thioglycolic acid and the analog was purified by liquid chromatography on a colum of Separon S i c 1 8 (2.5x30 cm), mobile phase 60% of methanol and 40% of 0.2% aqueous TFA, flow rate 400 ml/h
250 mg of crude ana-
logue I yielded 125 mg of HPLC-pure product (the content was 96%). Amino acid analysis: Glu 1.03, His 0.94, Trp 0.80, Ser 0.95, Tyr 0.96, Tie 0.90, Leu 0.90, Arg 1.06, Pro l.Ol./tf 2°-45.5° (c=0.1, 1M acetic acid).
553 Materials and methods Products were characterized by amino acid analyses, liquid chromatography and thin layer chromatography. Samples for RIA estimation were measured on PRIAS automatic device (H. Packard). The biological activity was tested on ovariectomized heifers (4). Analogues were administered in 10 and 200 ^ug doses pro animal. RIA- estimation was performed in the homologous system of double antibodies (5). As standard for iodination served NIH-LER -1716-2 bovine. The RIA sensitivity was from 100 ^ug. LH antiserum showed 1% cross reaction with FSH and prolactin.
Table 1. Concentrations of LH and FSH after administration of 200 ^ug LRF and analogs.
Compound
C
FSH a max (min )
effect duration (min)
blanc
average conc. ng/ml 31.2+ 1.9
LRF I
40+11.5
100+26.7
108.4+16.1
40+ 6.0
230+32.1
110.9+11.7
II
26.7+ 3.8
43+20.4
72.4+10.9
III
73.3+13.9
C
LH 6 max (min)
146+28
effect duration (min)
blanc
88.4+ 7.98
average conc. ng/ml 0.26+0.04
LRF
53.3+13.9
I
53.3+19.2
II
46.6+15.4
86.7+10.7
3.88+1.3
III
70.0+23.3
186.7+8.3
8.03+1.25
12.3+ 5.0 236.7+10
7.43+1.6 11.24+1.59
a,b the time at which maximum concentration of the hormone is attained.
554 Results and discussion Tert-leucine with tert-buty.1 group in the side chain markedly influences tne whole conformation and lipophilicity of peptides (6). It was therefore used for the synthesis of model peptides ? analogues of TRF and neurohypophysal hormones (7). We synthetized an analogue of LRF with D-Tle in position 6. Analogues of LRF with D-amino acid hawing bulky lipophilic or aromatic side chain possess high activity (1, 2, 8, 9). The activity of newly synthetized analogues on LH and FSH secretion is described in tab. 1. The tosylated product retaines about 50 to 70% activity of natural LRF. /D-Tle , 9 Pro-NH-Et /LRF in both doses (10; 200 ,ug) was very active, more active 6 9 than /D-Ala , Pro-NH-Et /LRF III, which was tested for comparison. Replacement of Gly by Tie has caused a marked increase and protraction of activity, noticeable even at 10 ^ug dosis pro animal. This fact confirms an important influence of substitution in position 6 on the conformation of the peptide, which markedly overrode the negative influence of the change in position 8. Natural LRF protected in the same way was essentially inactive.
References 1. Skubiszewski, B., Przekop, B., Wolinska, F., Stupnicka, E.:Anim. Reprod. Sci. 269-275 (1981). 2. Bergquist, C., Nillius, C., Wide, L.: Lancet 215-217 (1979). 3. Danguy, A.: Eur. 3. Cancer 13, 1089-92 (1977). k. Pichova, D.: Zav. Zprava VU^329-32 (1977). 5. Stupnicki, R., Madej, A.: Endokrinologie 68,6-10
(1976)
6. Smolikova, 3., Pospisek, 3., Blaha, K.: Coll. Czech. Commun. kG, 772 (1981) 7. Lebl, M., Pospisek, 3., Hlavacek, 3., Barth, T., Malon, P., Servitova, L., Hauser, K., 3ost, K.: Coll. Czech. Chem. Commun. ¿¡7, 689, (1982) 8. Nestor, 3.3., Ho, T.L., Simpson, R.A., Horner, B.L., 3ones, G.H., McRae, G.I., Vickery, B.H.: Proc. 7th Amer. Pept. Symp. 109-11 (1981). 9. Ying, S., Cuillemin, R.: Nature 280, 593-5 (1979).
THE ROLE OF N-ACYL GROUPS IN THE INHIBITORY ACTIVITY OF LH-RH ANALOGUES Imre Mezo, Jànos Seprodi, Judit Érchegyi, Istvàn Teplàn 1 st Institute of Biochemistry, Semmelweis University Medical School, Budapest, Hungary Magdolna Kovàcs, Béla Flerkó Institute of Anatomy, University Medical School, Hungary
Pécs,
The molecular factors increasing the agonistic or antagonistic properties of luteinizing hormone-releasing hormone /LH-RH/ have been investigated for many years. Position one seems to be very important for the antiovulatory potency of inhibitory analogues of LH-RH. The introducing of D-amino acids at position one of an LH-RH antagonist was prompted by the finding that D-Phe"*" /1 / yields better inhibitors than the D-Glp"*" / 2 / modification. Glp-Pro
/4/, Ac-Ala"*" / 5 / and Ac-Gly
Ac-Pro"*"
/3/ ,
/ 6/ analogues signifi-
cantly inhibit the ovulation at low dosages suggesting that neither a D nor an L configurational residue is essential for high antiovulatory activity. Moreover, an antiovulatory potency of one order of magnitude greater has been found in some series of analogues with N-acetyl termini as compared with the corresponding analogues having free N-termini /7/. Other, position one substituted inhibitory analogues in this series have also been reported /8/ and these studies lead to the D-Ala
synthesis of
[Ac-D-Trp 1 ,D-p-Cl-Phe 2 ,D-Trp 3 ,D-Phe 6 ,
-LH-RH showing a significant blockade of ovulation
in rats at lo ug dose. More recently we reported /7/ that some acyl groups,
different in size and polarity, yielded
inhibitory analogues also with a high level of activity.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
556
In order to find out more about the nature of the N-acyl group we synthesized and tested new inhibitory analogues of LH-RH /see Table I./. The peptides were synthesized by solid phase method /9/, purified on Sephadex G25 and followed by purification on a Silica Gel 60 column. To test the analogues rat antiovulatory assay was used /8/. Our aim was to study the lipophilic character of the Nterminal substituents of LH-RH inhibitors, which appears to improve the antiovulatory potency. With the expectation that not only the acetyl but also other acyl-type.substitution at the N-terminus may increase the antiovulatory potency, we prepared [H-D-Trp1,D-p-Cl-Phe2,D-Trp3,D-Phe6,D-Alalc> ] LH-RH /VI/ having a mild potency in rat antiovulatory assay. All acyl groups used were found to strongly increase the antiovulatory potency as compared with the corresponding analogues having free N-termini, but none of them showed any improvement over the N-acetyl analogue in lo ug dose. The N-formyl analogue /I/ was the only one which proved to be equipotent with the N-acetylated compound /II/. Our biological data clearly demonstrate that an increase in the hydrophobic nature of the acyl group on the N-terminus involves a gradual decrease in potency, which is mostly expressed in the case of the diacetyl-tartaryl peptide /V/. The relatively high antiovulatory potency of the tartaryl peptide /III/ suggests that not only the size but also the polarity of the acyl group increases or restores the potency well over that of the apolar N-valeryl /IV/ and N-diacetyltartaryl /V/ peptides. For the further elucidation of the importance of position one some new analogues are to be synthesized.
BG « I S3 J I
I n c r e a s i n g
a n t i o v u l a t o r y
p o t e n c y
H
1 -M •H
a
o in
4H o
•i-l
a) x: +>
o O
a)
O •H -P 3 P -H -P 0) XI 3 w
a SH EH i Q I T—I >1 e >H O En
a n Eh I Q I •P aj o
1 M nJ +> M nS
EH
J
I
CM ^ EH
I a i rH >1 a) rH m >
CM M EH I
a
i rH >1 >1 nJ
a M EH I Q I an
558 References
1.
Coy, D.H., Mezö, I., Pedroza, E., Nekola, M.V., Vilchez, J., Piyachaturawat, P., Schally, A.V., Seprodi, J., Teplän, I.: Peptides, Proc. 6th American Peptide Symp. pp. 775-779, Gross, E. and Meienhofer, J., eds., Pierce Chem. Co., Rockford, /1979/.
2.
Rivier, J.E., Vale, W.W.: Life Sei. 23, 869-876 /1978/.
3.
Humphries, J., Wasiak, T., Wan, Y.P., Folkers, K., Bowers, C.Y.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 8^5, 7o9-713 /1978/. Wasiak, T., Humphries, J., Folkers, K., Bowers, C.Y.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 86^, 843-848 /19 79 / -
4. 5.
Erchegyi, J., Coy, D.H., Nekola, M.V., Pedroza, E., Coy, E.J., Mezo, I., Schally, A.V.: Peptides 2, 251-253 /19 81/.
6.
Spatola, A.F., Agarwal, N.S.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 97, 1571-1574 /198o/.
7.
Mezo, I., Seprodi, J., Erchegyi, J., Teplän, I., Coy, D.H. Schally, A.V.: Drugs, Biochem. Metab. suppl. pp. 1-4, Klebovich, I., Laszlovszky, I., Rosdy, B., eds., Biochemical Section of the Hungarian Chemical Society, Budapest, /1981/.
8.
Erchegyi, J., Coy, D.H., Nekola, M.V., Coy, E.J. Schally, A.V., Mezo, I., Teplän, I.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 100, 915-92o /1981/.
9.
Coy, D.H., Coy, E.J., Arimura, A., Schally, A.V.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 5_4, 1267-1273 /1973 / .
GONADOTROPIN RELEASING HORMONE AND ITS ANALOGS DESENSITIZE PITUITARY GNRH ACTION
Gyorgy Keri, Karoly Nikolics and Istvan Teplan 1st Institute of Biochemistry, Semmelweis University Medical School, 1444 Budapest, P.O.Box 260, Hungary
Introduction Desensitization is an important mechanism by which hormones can regulate the sensitivity of their own target cells /Reviewed in 1/. In earlier reports desensitization was considered to be a receptor down-regulation. It was demonstrated in the case of LH /2/, hCG /3/ and insulin /4/ that receptor down-regulation alone can not be responsible for the observed desentization. In the case of ACTH, desensitization of steroid production could be observed without a decrease in receptor number /5/. Gonadotropin releasing hormone and its superactive agonists in high doses cause a very significant desensitization of LH and FSH release when chronically administered to rats in vivo
¡6,1,8/. This mechanism promises to become an effective
method of contraception by superactive Gn-RH analogues. We have investigated the in vitro mechanism of this
desensi-
tization .
Results Cultured pituitary cells were preincubated with various concentrations of GnRH. LH release during the reincubation period significantly decreased as compared to control cells. -9 Submaximal dose of Gn-RH /10 M/ caused already a small but
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
560 significant desensitization of subsequent Gn-RH induced LH release and the rate of desensitization strongly increased with the preincubating concentration of Gn-RH. The rate of desensitization was also dependent on the preincubation time reaching maximum after four hours incubation. In order to elucidate the relationship between receptor affinity and desensitization, superactive and inhibitory analogs of Gn-RH were used. The superactive analog D-Phe -Gn-RH and D-Phe -Gn-RH /1-9/-ethylamide almost completely desensitized the cells under 4 hours preincubation, while the inhibitory analog Formyl-D-Trp1, D-Cpa 2 , D-Trp 3 , D-Phe 6 , D-Alalo-Gn-RH did not cause real desensitization, as shown in Fig.l.
-log [M] GnRH
561
Fig.1. Effect of preincubation of cultured pituitary cells with GnRH and its analogs. Cells were preincubated for 4 hours with the hormone or its analogs than washed and reincubated with lo~lo, lo~9 and lo-®M GnRH for 1 hour. LH released into the medium was measured by RIA. The decreased LH production at lower concentrations of Gn-RH, after preincubation with the inhibitory analog is probably due to the fact that the competitive inhibitory analog remains bound to the receptor even after medium change and washing. This effect can be overcome by increasing the concentration of Gn-RH used for reincubation. As a consequence, this effect is not desensitization but merely a long term competitive inhibition. These data on the other hand suggest that the desensitizing potency of Gn-RH is related to the biological activity of the hormone and does not correlate with its affinity to the receptor. Investigating whether the well-known LH releasing potency of high K + concentration can desensitize LH production of the cultured pituitary cells, we found that 59mM K + desensitises LH production with about 20%, which is significantly smaller than Gn-RH induced desensitization. It is.known from previous findings /9/ that K + induces LH release through a Gn-RH independent way by depolarizing the plasma membrane. Thus it can be concluded from these and the previous results that desensitization of LH production in the pituitary cells may occur in at least two ways. One is coupled to the LH releasing process while the other is probably coupled to a second phase of LH production. The fact that the extent of high K + induced LH production was the same as that of Gn-RH while the rate of desensitization was much smaller excludes the possibility that desensitization is a simple depletion of the LH pool in the pituitary cells.
It can also be concluded from these
results that although there are reports about internalization and receptor down-regulation of Gn-RH /10, 11/, this effect can not be only responsible for the Gn-RH induced desensi-
562 tization. Further investigations should be carried out to localize the possible intracellular steps in Gn-RH induced desensitization of the pituitary gonadotroph cells.
References 1. 2.
Catt, K.J., Harwood, J.P., Aguilera, G., Dufau, M.L.: Nature 280, 109-116 /1979/. Tsuruhara, T., Dufau, M.L., Cigorraga, S., Catt, K.J.: J.Biol.Chem. 252, 9002-9009 /1977/.
3.
Conti, M., Harwood, J.P., Dufau, M.L., Catt, K.J.: J.Biol.Chem. 252^, 8869-8874 /1977/.
4.
Marshall, S., Olefsky, J.W.: J.Clin. Invest. 66, 763-772 /1980/. Sheela Rani, C.S., Keri, Gy., Ramachandran, J.: Endocrinology in press Belchetz, P.P., Plant, T.M., Nakoi, T., Keogh, E.J., Knobil, E., Science 202, 631-633 /1978/.
5. 6. 7.
Rivier, C., Rivier, J., Vale, W.: Endocrinology 105, 119l-12ol /1979/.
8.
Fraser, H.M., Laird, N.C. Blakeley, D.M., Endocrinology 106, 452-457 /1980/.
9.
Khar, A., Jutisz, M.: Mol.Cell.Endocrinol. _17,85-93 /1980/.
10.
Naor, Z., Atlas, D., Clayton, R.N., Forman, D.S., Amsterdam, A., Catt, K.J.: J.Biol.Chem. 256, 3049-3052 /1981/.
11.
Conn, P.M., Smith, R.G., Rogers D.C.: J.Biol.Chem. 256, 1098-1100 /1981/.
DSIP: NOVEL DEVELOPMENTS IN STRUCTURE-FUNCTIONAL STUDIES
Inessa Mikhaleva, Asmic Sargsyan, Vadim Ivanov Shemyakin Institute of Bioorganic Chemistry, USSR Academy of Sciences, 117988 Moscow, USSR
Introduction At the previous meeting of this series physicochemical and biological properties of 6-sleep inducing peptide [DSIP, (I)] (1) and a number of its analogs were discussed (2). Fluorescence, Laser Raman and NMR as well as theoretical calculations (3) concertedly pointed to considerable flexibility of DSIP spatial structure with a tendency to assume folded quasicyclic conformation(s) (1, 4).
Results In order to probe the significance of folded structures in biological action of DSIP we have synthesized a cyclic analog in which the N and C termini were joined by a Gly moiety (II). TrpAlaGlyGlyAspAlaSerGlyGlu (I), DSIP ^-GlyTrpAlaGlyGlyAspAlaSerGlyGlu^ (II), cyclo-(Gly-DSIP) The scheme for synthesis was chosen so as to activate the C-terminal Gly residues both during segment condensation in the course of preparing the linear decapeptide precursor and cyclization (Fig. 1). All the functional side chains were ct blocked by benzyl type protective groups. For N -function Boc or Z protection was employed. C-terminal carboxyls were converted to tert -butyl esters or remained unprotected. The
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
564
protected pentapeptides prepared as shown in Figure 1 were coupled by mixed anhydride procedure. The resultant decapeptide pentachlorophenyl ester was purified by HPLC on Zorbax Sil in
dimethyIformamide. Cyclization was achieved under high
dilution
(40°, 72 h , 1 equiv. Et 3 N). The initial attempts to
cyclize the N,C-deprotected decapeptide by means of complex F, the Woodward reagent, DCC/HOBt or mixed anhydride procedures were unsuccessful. The protected cyclic decapeptide was purified by size exclusion HPLC on Zorbax Sil, hydrogenated and subjected to ion exchange chromatography on DEAE-sephadex A-25 in NH^OAc buffer (0,2-0,3M). Of the fractions obtained only one did not respond to dansyl amino terminal analysis. This fraction was further purified by reversed phase HPLC on Zorbax ODS.
4 Gly
5
7
8
9
Ser
Gly
Glu
6
Asp A l a
1 Gly
Trp
2 Ala
3 Gly
Z'0NSuH"0H Bzl 'ONSu H OBu Bzl
OH EtOAc 185%) Z^ONSuH OH
Z UOU CHCU(87%) Etj0(80%) Z -+0NSU H Boc NSu HkBZ' I OBu' Z bL_loBu* Boc ' tBzl 20(83%) OBzl Et0Ac/Et,0(9S%) OBzl EtOAc/E K 0Ho .- 'ONp H Boc " ^Su H OBzl LbzI ,0Bzl OH Boc OBzl aOAc(78-/.) Boc CHCI3/Et20l70%] Bz| ,0Bzl DCC/pcoSH ' OHj Boc +°NPH OBzl B ^ /B buto O ^ T o b CIFq IC^ OOHS/C,HCIq OH H Boc ' E t O A c ( 8 3 % ) JBzl Boc ' . HPLC DMF (60%) OBzl ,Bzl CF3COOH/CHCI3 90% hoBzl 1. Et^N/DMF, 72 hrs;40° 2.H,/Pd I I Q_ —
Boc
L
Fig. 1.
OH OH OH OH OH OPcp OPcp OPcp OPcp
Cyclo-(Gly-DSIP)
1. DEAE -scphadex A-25 2 HPLC Zorbax ODS (11%)
Scheme for the synthesis of cyclo-(Gly-DSIP).
565 The final product isolated with 11% yield gave correct amino acid ratio and "'"H-NMR (300 MHz) spectrum (see below). Testing* of cyclo-(Gly-DSIP) on identified neurons of snail Helix lucorum L. isolated nervous system showed that in this g
system it is as active as DSIP itself. At 5-10
M dose the
peptide (II) caused the same effects as DSIP (5); increasing the resting potential and inhibiting the spontaneous firing _g (Fig. 2 ); the cyclic analog was also active at 10
M concent-
ration. None of the linear analogs studied earlier were nearby as potent as this cyclic analog. The result obtained confirm our earlier statement (1) that folded structure might be involved in biological action of DSIP. Comparison of the CD spectra (Fig. 3) of (I) and (II) does not show any obvious similarity. On the contrary opposite signs of
Fig. 2. Frequency of spontaneous firing of neuron V 17, % from control. Arrow indicates beginning and the end of peptide application. the chiroptic effects in aqueous ethanol both at 20° and -80° rather point to a conformational transition accompanying cyclization which is not surprizing if one takes into account the
* Biological study of (I) and (II) on snail neurons was performed by DR. P.M.Balaban from Institute of Biological Testing of Chemicals, Ministry of Medical Industry, USSR.
566
2 0 -2
-4
Fig. 3. CD spectra of DSIP (I) and cyclo-(Gly-DSIP) in Et0H-H 2 0 (19:1). 20°C, -o -80°C. Table 1.
(II)
NMR parameters of NH protons in DSIP and cyclo-(GlyDSIP) ( H O , pH 4.4, 32°; 300 MHz)
Amino acid residue
Trp Ala
1 2
Ó
NH(ppm)
DSIP
-
cycl0 " cyclo' (Glv-D£ (Gly-DSIP)
7 . 85
J
Aó/ATxlO
NHCaH(Hz)
DSIP
-
cyclo(Gly-DSIP) 6.4
ppm/°C
cyclo(Gly-DSIP)
ù
4 .3
-
8 52
8.27
6. 5
„ 5 Asp
8 25
8 .15
7 .8
7. 3
5. 3
3 .3
Ala 6
8 30
8.17
6. 4
6.2
6. 4
6 .0
Ser 7 Q Glu'
8 25
8.23
7 .1
7.4
5 .3
4 .8
7 82
8.27
8. 4
Gly Gly Gly
-
3
4
Gly 8
7 65
8.02 8.10
-
12 2
~ 5 ( ~ 8) 6 4
~ 8 ( ~ 5 ) 4. 2 -
-
4.7(2 .7)
2.7(4 .7) 6. 0
-
5. 1
8 26
8.27
12 5
-
5. 1
8 11
8.36
12 0
-
5. 5
3 .3
N H j . C H . P . (OMe), + Z . N H . C H . C O , H II * 0 DCCI
Fig. 1
Me I 2 N H . C H . CO . N H . C H . P . (OMe), II 0 ^e
Me
Me
1
I HjN . CH . CO . NH . CH .
^ O H P ^ II ^ O H 0
The typical phosphonodipeptide alafosfalin (alternative name alaphosphin) [L-Ala-L-Ala(P)] was prepared by the route shown in Fig.l.
Antibacterial properties of di- to hexa-phosphono-
peptides of alanine and other amino acids have been investigated (Fig.2)(5,7,8). The action of alafosfalin (and combinations with 0-lactams for synergy) against experimental infections in the mouse reflects the results, in vitro.
In human volunteer studies (4,5) it is
well tolerated, has a %-life of approximately one hour and in efficacy investigations has demonstrated encouraging results for infantile enterocolitis, shigellosis, urinary tract infection and salmonellosis.
It appears to offer most promise
in the management of gram-ve infections in man, particularly those associated with gastro-intestinal disturbances. Antibacterial
activity
ol
Organisms
phosphono-oligopeptides
Y-(L-X)nL-Ala(P)
A n t i b a c t e r i a l a c t i v i t y . M I C in pg/ml N - t e r m m a l a m m o a c i d or p e p t i d e i n Y-(L-X) n L-Ata(P)
V-
s
50 /ig
1
0.08
5 0.02 o
i—i
S-acm porcine toxin
/ control (no toxin) : 1
2
3
4
5
50 Mg
2
500 ng
3
50 ng
4 5
685 IV)
Protection : sera of animals immunized with conjugated S-acm were able, when mixed with natural human ST toxin, to neutralize its biological activity
(fig.2) fig. 2 5 mouse units human ST toxin
0.1
were mixed with 20 yul of anti ST-TT mouse serum (total volume
o
100 yul) incubated for 2 hours at
o
room temperature and then tested 0.05
s i
by the suckling mouse test. Dilutions of serum : 1 : 1/50 ; 2 : 1/200 ; 3 : 1/400 ;
o
5 : 1/1600 ; 6 : 1/3200. 6
5
4
3
2
1
Dilutions of serum
A B C
A : control, no toxin B : control, ST toxin 5 mouse units plus 20 JJ.1 of mouse non-immune serum diluted to 1/50 C : control. ST toxin 5 mouse units
DISCUSSION :
The synthetic antigenes can be usefull to set up a radioimmunoassay or an antigenlinked immunoadsorbent to detect directly ST toxins Furthermore, being non-toxic, a possible immunization of humans or animals can be envisaged. These results also indicate the possibility, using S-protected analogs of developping sequence-dependent antibodies which will crossreact with the parent structure, even in the case of highly disulfidebridged peptides. This approach can thus be used with other natural
686 products when, as is often the case, the amino-acid sequence is know but the exact•location of disulfide bridges is not available.
REFERENCES : 1.
So, M., Mc Carthy, B. : Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. USA 77,4011 (1980)
2.
Chan, S.K., Giannella, R.A. : J. Biol. Chem. 256,7744 (1981)
3.
Staples, S.J., Asher, S.E., Giannella, R.A.:J. Biol. Chem 255,4716 (1980)
4.
Giannella, R.A., Drake, K.W., Luttrel, M.: Infect, and Immunity 33,186 (1981)
5.
Merrifield, R.B. : J. Am. Chem. Soc. 85,2149 (1963)
6.
Veber, D.F., Milkowski, J.D., Vargas, S.L., Denkewalter, R.G., Hirschman,R. : J. Am. Chem. Soc. 94,5456 (1972)
7.
Frantz, J.C., Robertson, D.C. : Infect, and Immunity 33,186 (1981)
8.
Voller, A., Bidwell, D.E., Bartlett, A.: Enzyme linked immunosorbent assay Dynatech, Europe. Guernesey (1979)
9.
Kauffman, P.E.: Applied and Environmental Microbiology 42,611 (1981)
PREPARATION AND ANTIGENICITY OF THE C-TERMINAL FRAGMENTS OF HUMAN LEUKOCYTE INTERFERONS a2 AND al *
*
+
Motonori OHNO , Fred WIDMER , Mark E. SMITH , Heinz ARNHEITER^, and Kathryn C. ZOON§ *Laboratory
of Chemical Biology, NIADDK, NIH, tLaboratory of Chemoprevention, NCI, NIH, ^Laboratory of Molecular Genetics, NINCDS, NIH, Bethesda, 6 Maryland 20205, USA, and Bureau of Biologies, Food and Drug Administration, Bethesda, Maryland
20205, USA
Introduction The availability of complete amino acid sequences of hurpn leukocyte interferons (IFN)^ ^ would make chanical synthesis of fragments a useful tool for structural analysis of antigenic determinants, receptor binding region, etc., of IFN molecules. At this time the main focus is on the C-terminal sequence of the molecule where the greatest horology is observed throughout the entire human leukocyte IFN family"^. We synthesized a number of peptides which are composed of segments of the C-terminal sequence 113-166 of IFN a2 and al taking into account, in part, the last 10-13 C-terminal 4 5 residues which are not essential for activity ' . We report here the antigenicity of peptides and the competitive binding of C-terminal hexadecapeptide and native IFN to monoclonal antibody. Materials and Methods Synthesis. When solid phase synthesis was snployed, tert-butoxycarbonylaminoacyl-4-(oxymethyl)phenylacetamidcmethyl-resin was prepared as a supr
port and 7 elongation of the chain was carried out by a double coupling procedure . When peptides were built up by solution synthesis, suitable fragg
ments were condensed by the Honzl-Rudinger azide method . In solution synthesis, hydrogen chloride in formic acid wasgused for deprotection of Boc group for tryptophan containing peptides . The synthesized peptides were cleaved and deprotected in liquid HF for 90 min at 0°C. Trifluoroacetyl group for lysine was removed with 0.2-0.5 M piperidine. The peptides were purified by HPLC. Anti-IFN. Polyclonal antibody was produced by immunizing sheep with human
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
688
lymphoblastoid IFN as described"*"^. Monoclonal antibody was produced against a synthetic peptide ocmprising 111-166 sequence of IFN ctl and purified as described"'""'". Radioimmunoadsorption assay. Peptides dissolved in phosphate buffered saline (PBS), pH 7.4, in five different concentrations were adsorbed to polyvinyl chloride microtiter wells. The wells were washed 3 times with BSA/PBS and then incubated with sheep anti-IFN, rabbit anti-sheep y125 globulin, and I-protein A in this order. Each well was cut and bound 125 I was counted. When ccmpetition assay was made, inhibitory peptide was mixed with sheep anti-IFN at 4 different concentrations while concentrations of peptide on the plate were kept constant. Results and Discussion At first we arployed solid phase synthesis for C-terminal fragments ctl (151-166, SLSFSTNLQKRLRRKD• 5HC1) and a2 (142-156, EWRAEIMRSFSLST• 3HC1) which were to be used as anchor peptides for extension of the chains by solution methodology. The peptide 142-156, however, was highly insoluble and inappropriate for solution synthesis. For this reason, synthesis has been made by solution method, starting fron residue 156. Figure 1 shews a synthetic scheme for peptide 124-156 (a2) by fragment condensation. 124-130
BOC-FQR(TOS)ITLY-NHNH 2
131-135 B o c - L K ( T f a ) E K ( T f a ) K ( T f a ) - N H N H 2 136-141 142
Boc-YSPC(Acm)AW-NHNH2 Boc-E(OBzl)-ONp
143-146
B oc-V V R (Tos) A - N HN H 2
147-149
Boc-E(OBzl)IM-NHNH2
150-151
Boc-R (Tos)S-NHNH 2
152-156
Boc-FSLS(Bzl)T(Bzl)-OBzl
FQRITLYLKEKKYSPC ( A c m ) A W E V V R A E I M R S F S L S T 7HCI IFN a l 124-156
Fig. 1. Synthetic schane for peptide 124-156 of IFN a2. Acm denotes acetamidanethyl.
689 The peptides, mostly frcm a2 sequence, were tested for antigenic determinant using solid phase radioimraunoadsorption assay with sheep anti-IFN. Figure 2 shows reactivities of the peptides tested. The short peptide fragments frcm the C-terminal tail, 152-156, 150-156, and 162-166 were unreactive. However, peptides 147-156 and 152-161, which involve extra 3-5 residues to the above peptides, were highly reactive and antigenic.
(-)
^
\
130 FQRITLY
140 LKEKK
YSPCAW
150 EVVR A EIM
RS
160 FSLST
Fig. 2 Reactivity of peptides against anti-IFN. and 147-156 are not ccmpetitive.
NLQES
LRSKE
*
Peptides 131-145
These results indicate that the peptides shorter than heptapeptide would be different in conformation frcm the corresponding segments in native molecule and that at least one antigenic determinant exists in the sequence between 152 and 162. The ccmpetitive binding experiment (Fig. 3) shewed
0 i z o £ m x z
5°
10°-8
-7-6
-5-4
-3
-2
LOG [I] (Ml
Fig. 3. Ccmpetitive binding of peptides 136-145, 131-145, and 136156 against peptide 136-145 attached to the plate (radioimtnunoadsorption assay).
690
that peptides 136-145, 131-145, and 136-156 were competitive and the binding strengths increased in this order. However, peptides 131-145 and 147-156 were not competitive (Fig. 2). It could be concluded that different antigenic determinants exist before and after Ala 146. No reactivity of peptide 124-135 shows the absence of antigenic site in this sequence which may be inferred not to be exposed on the molecular surface. Monoclonal antibody produced against a synthetic peptide 111-166 (al) can bind to IFNs al and a2 but does not inhibit the binding of IFN to receptor on bovine kidney cell"'""'". The peptide 151-166 (al) effectively inhibited the binding of monoclonal antibody to IFN (Fig. 4). The results show that monoclonal antibody was produced against an antigenic site of the Cterminal tail (151-166) and that the C-terminal region of IFN molecule does not participate in receptor binding.
LOG [I] (M) Fig. 4. Competitive binding of peptides to monoclonal antibody against IFN a2 (radioimnunoadsorption assay). IFN a2 was first attached to wells and incubated with monoclonal antibody solution containing each peptide in several concentrations. None of the synthetic peptides showed anti-viral activity.
691
References 1. Nagata, S., Taixa, H., Hall, A., Johnsrud, L., Streuli, M., Ecsodi, J., Boll, W., Cantell, K., Weissmann, C.: Nature 284, 316 (1980). 2. Streuli, M., Nagata, S., Weissmann, C.: Science 209, 1343 (1980). 3. Goeddel, D.Y., Leung, D.W., Dull, T.J., Gross, M., Lawn, R.M., McCandliss, R., Seeburg, P.H., Ullrich, A., Yelverton, E., Gray, P.W.: Nature 290, 20 (1981). 4. Levy, W.P., Rubinstein, M., Shively, J., Valle, U.D., Lai, C.-Y., Moschera, J., Brink, L., Gerber, L., Stein, S., Pestka, S.: Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. USA 78, 6186 (1981). 5. Wetzel, R., Levine, H.L., Estell, D.A., Shire, S., Finer-Moore, J., Stroud, R.M., Bewley, P. (1982) Structure-function studies on human alfa interferon in Chsnistry and Biology of Interferons: Relations to Therapeutics, Merigan, T., Friedman, R.M., and Fox, C.F., eds., Academic Press, New York. 6. Mitchell, A.R., Kent, S.B.H., Englehard, M., Merrifield, R.B.: J. Org. Chem. 43, 2845 (1978). 7. Wong, T.W., Merrifield, R.B.: Biochemistry 19, 3233 (1980). 8. Honzl, J., Rudinger, J.: Coll. Czecho. Chan. Conmun. 26, 2333 (1961). 9. Ohno, M., Tsukamoto, S., Sato, S., Izumiya, N.: Bull. Chan. Soc. Japan 46, 3280 (1973). 10. Smith, M.E. in Mathods in Enzymology, Pestka, S., eds., 79 (1981) p. 567, Acadanic Press, New York. 11. Arnheiter, H., Thorns, R.M., Leist, T., Fountoulakis, M., Gutte, B.: Nature 294, 278 (1981). 12. Arnheiter, H., Zoon, K.C., Ohno, M., Smith, M.E., Gutte, B.: Cell, in press.
IMMUNOLOGICAL PROPERTIES OF HAPTEN-PEPTIDE CONJUGATES: THE EFFECT OF SIZE, LIPOPHILIC SUBSTITUENTS AND HAPTENIC DISTANCE ON TOLEROGENICITY AND ANAPHYLACTOGENICITY
IMMANUEL F. LUESCHER and CONRAD H. SCHNEIDER UNIVERSITY OF BERN, INSTITUTE FOR CLINICAL IMMUNOLOGY INSELSPITAL, CH-3 010 BERN
The induction of long lasting, hapten-specifid immunological tolerance by injection into mice of polymeric, macromolecular, multihaptenic conjugates has been successful in a number of instances (1). This effect is thought to be the result of a direct inactivating interaction of the conjugates with specific B-lymphocytes. Since it was found (2), that considerable tolerogenic effects are also possible with haptenic conjugates of less than 10000 daltons, we set out to prepare by stepwise synthesis a selection of defined, relatively small, homomeric and heteromeric lysine peptides carrying one, two or a multitude of haptenic groups. In most of the work thus far, the benzylpenicilloyl (Bpo) residue, a main determinant in penicillin allergy, has been used as haptenic group. The conjugates were evaluated as tolerogens in mice, which were immunized to give relatively high IgE antibody titers against the hapten. In addition, anaphylactogenicity, using passive cutaneous anaphylaxis (PCA), was assessed, since in view of practical applications, conjugates with high tolerogenic effectiveness and low anaphylactogenicity are to be sought.
EXPERIMENTAL
Abbreviations are according to the IUPAC-IUB Commission on Biochemical Nomenclature. Sue denotes the substituent after
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
694
succinylation, i.e. 3-carboxylatopropionyl.- The carrier peptides were synthesized essentially according to the two-phase purification method (3,4). The starting C-terminal lysine derivative carried the p-oxymethylbenzylcholestan-3 (i-yl succinate (OSuco) group. Side chain protection generally was by the Boc group and temporary N-terminal protection was by the Nps group which was cleaved with rhodanide in the presence of 2-methylindol-l-yl-acetic acid. Nps-Lys(Boc)- ^Lys(Boc)J^-Lys(Boc)OSuco, n=0-8, were thus prepared and used for obtaining derivatives and, by condensation, larger units. Deprotected carriers were reacted with benzylpenicillin in alkali to Bpo-conjugates. Purification involved silica gel chromatography of the protected carrier peptides and gel permeation chromatography of the final conjugates. The conjugates showed the expected molar penamaldate values (5) and were generally homogeneous upon thin layer chromatography and high voltage electrophoresis. - Tolerogenicity was tested in female BALB/c mice which were immunized and tolerized according to different schedules. In schedule AB the tolerogen was given before sensitization, in schedule CD many weeks after sensitization and a number of booster injections. In schedule E, the tolerogen was given 20 days after sensitization but shortly before the first boost. All animals received regular boosts after sensitization in 2030 days intervals. For sensitization and boosts each animal received by intraperitoneal injection, 10 yug benzylpenicilloylated ascaris suum protein and 2 mg Al(OH)^ suspended in 0.2 ml saline. Sensitizations also comprised the injection of unpenicilloylated ascaris suum protein (10 /ig and 2 mg A1(OH) suspended in 0.2 ml saline). This procedure led to high antiBpo IgE titers in untolerized control mice. IgE titers were measured by rat PCA using highly benzylpenicilloylated polyL-lysine (6). Anaphylactogenicity was tested in guinea pigs after passive sensitization with anti-Bpo antiserum mainly by using the i.d.-i.d. technique as exemplified e.g. in (7).
695 RESULTS
Table are
AND
DISCUSSION
1 shows
that
all
anaphylactogenic.
phylactogen aqueous
since
solution
(8). C o n j u g a t e jugates are
with
still
Table 1.
X
compounds The
stable due
to
seems
longer
except
monovalent multivalent
the
presence
weakly
IX
associates of
the
All
distances
injections
is
are
VIII
an
but
(data of
ana-
formed
cholestanol
anaphylactogenic
interhaptenic
anaphylactogenic.
the monovalent
conjugate
moiety
divalent not
these
PVm /Bpoa)
Nr.
BPO-Lys (BPO) -¡Lys (BPO^-Lys (BPO) -0~-7 Na +
conjugates
s.Katn. .. b) PCA c)
I
16000
32
BPO-Sac-Lys (BPO) -{Lys (BPOïJ^-Lys (BPO) -OSuco 6 -Na+ II
16500
14
III
16200
24
+++
IV
15900
18
V
16900
41
+++ +++
VI
16900
32
BPO-Lys (BPO) -{Lys (BPojjg-Lys (BPO) -0~•12 Na + BPO-Lys(BPO)-£ys(BPO^g-Lys(BPO)-OSuco-11 Na + BPO-Lys(BPO) -£ys(BPoJlfl-Lys(BPO)-o"•22 Na + BP0-Lys(BP0)-£,ys(BP0|18-Lys(BP0)-0Suco-21 Na CO
+
1
CO
++ ++
+++
BPO-Lys-jLys (BPoj^-Lys (BPO) -OSuco -20 Na +
+++ VII
15500
13
21600
60.5
BPO-Lys-^ys (BPO)[8-Lys (BPO) -OSuco
Suc-Lys(BP0)-|Lys(Suc]8-Lys(Suc)-0 -12 Na Suc-Lys (BPO) -{Lys (Suc^-Lys (Suc) -OSuco • 11 Na
VIII
neg.
IX
21500
41 (0 )
X
22700
47
d
++
Suc-Lys (Bpo) -f-ys ( Suc j|8 -Lys ( Suc ) -NH- (CH2 ) fi Suc-Lys(Bpo) -^ys(Suc^g-Lys(suc)-NH a
1
-22 Na +
+
'Molar penamaldate value (S) divided by the theoretical number of Bpo groups per molecule. The value for monovalent Bpo-compounds is expectedly above 20000 and contrasts with PVra/Bpo for multivalent Bpo-conjugates.
k'cathodic movement in mm of compound within 40 min. upon electrophoresis (40 Volts/cm) on cellulose plates in 0.05 M phosphate buffered saline pH 7.4. c) Anaphylactogenicity assessed by PCA as outlined in "Experimental". d)
Trace at start.
con-
shown)
Some parameters of synthetic Bpo-oligolysine conjugates
Conjugate
|
in
696
into specifically sensitized animals requires therefore special care and eventually pharmacological protection against anaphylactic shock. The tolerogenic effects shown in table 2 are Bpo-specific since responses to ascaris protein (data not shown) were not affected The effects on anti-Bpo IgE responses are less marked than those noted previously (2) with similar conjugates (their carriers having been prepared by polymerization) in C3H mice exhibiting high IgG responses. It is evident that only conjugates carrying the OSuco group are effective tolerogens during the primary response, with the doubly OSuco-substituted conjugate VII showing quite promising effects. On the other hand ongoing IgE responses are only slightly suppressed and OSuco-bearing conjugates are not more effective than OSuco-deficient derivatives when tested according to schedule CD. It is therefore remarkable that the monohaptenic compound IX, affecting only
Table 2.
Tolerogenicity of Bpo-oligolysine
Conjugate Nr.
Tolerogenic effect primary response total dose per animal
(sched. AB)
route of s injection
TE
conjugates (TE)
*
during
ongoing responses total dose per animal
(sched. CD)
route of fi injection 8
TE
I
3 mg
i,• V .
100
6 mg
i.V.
100
II
3 mg
i.• V .
25
6 mg
i.V.
100
III
1 mg
i,• p-
80
6 mg
i.V.
70
IV
3 mg
i.• V .
6
6 mg
i.V.
30
V
1 mg
i • p.
80
6 mg
i.V.
20
VI
1 mg
i • p.
5
0 .75 mg
i.p.
50
VII
3 mg
i•V .
1
e
i.V.
22
VIII
1 mg
i •p.
50
6 rag
i.V.
100
IX
1 mg
i •p.
25
6 mg
I.V.
70
2 .5 mg
i.V.
*
mg
5 sched. E!
Anti-Bpo IgE titer in % of titer obtained at the same time from non-tolerlzed control animals. Values are averages taken from measurements 45, 75 and 90 days after tolerogen application.
S *i.v.: intravenous;
i.p.: intraperitoneal.
697
slightly either the primary or ongoing responses,becomes quite potent when schedule E is employed. This schedule is thought to involve the raise of specific suppressor T-lymphocytes (9). It is also evident from this and the previous study (2), that the pentalysine conjugates are below the size required for adequate potency whereas decalysine conjugates may be quite effective and as potent as larger conjugates, depending on the schedules of application. This work was supported by the Swiss National Science Foundation (grant 3 .725-0 .80) .
REFERENCES 1. Ishizaka, K.: Behring Inst. Mitt. 68^ 7-18 (1981). 2. Otz, U., Schneider, C.H., de Week, A.L., Gruden, E., Gill, T.J.: Eur. J. Immunol. 8_, 406-410 (1978). 3. Schneider, C.H., Rolli, H., Blaser, K.: Int. J. Peptide Protein Res. 15, 411-419 (1980). 4. Rolli, H., Schneider, C.H.: Chimia 3_5, 403-405 (1981). 5. Schneider, C.H., de Week, A.L. : Helv. Chim. Acta £9, 16891694 (1966) . 6. Watanabe, N., Ovary,Z.: J. Immun. Meth. L4, 381-390 (1977). 7. Schneider, C.H., Toffler, O., Guenin, R., Kings, M.: Immunology 46^ 221-229 (1982) . 8. Liischer, I.F., Schneider, C.H.: to be published. 9. Lee, W.Y., Sehon, A.H.: J. Immunol. 126, 414-418 (1981).
CONFORMATIONAL
FEATURES
OF A L T E R N A T I N G L,D
Alfonso Bavoso, Ettore Benedetti, Vincenzo Pavone, Carlo Pedone Laboratorio
Laboratorio Napoli Gian Paolo
B e n e d e t t o Di
Chimica Generale.Università
Vincenzo Barone,
PEPTIDES
Gennaro Esposito,
di
Biasio,
Napoli
Francesco
Struttura e dinamica molecolare.
Lelj Università
di
Lorenzi
Technish-Chemishes
Laboratorium,
ETH-Zentrum
Zürich
Introduction
Theoretical
investigation carried out on regularly
L,D p o l y p e p t i d e s
(1, 2, 3) p r e d i c t e d
nds have propension
that this type of
to g i v e f o l d e d o r c y c l i c
c t e r i z e d b y p o l a r c a v i t y o r c h a n n e l . We h a v e X-ray diffraction
the s t r u c t u r e
ndary
structures.
The
of e x i s t e n c e
chara-
investigated
of l i n e a r a l t e r n a t i n g
the p o s s i b i l i t y
compou-
structures
w i t h d i f f e r e n t n u m b e r a n d t y p e o f r e s i d u e s w i t h the of i n v e s t i g a t i n g
alternating
peptides
purpose
of s p e c i f i c
r o l e p l a y e d b y the n a t u r e of the
seco-
side
c h a i n in i n f l u e n c i n g
the c o n f o r m a t i o n o f the p o l y p e p t i d e
i n s o m e c a s e s c a n be
established.
Peptides 1982 © 1983 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
by
chain,
700
> •o c 3 O a E O o
0) E r CL 1 i a -—
O
i
£
0 (0
J
o
w 41 •o •rH P a 0) a -j a
oo c 4-1
o l/l
o X
c\
E O 1 T
(0 c o 00
1 œ o o i m a
>
«
Í4 0
•a
DO 0) T3 C
^ 1—1
11 o
« 3 E Le 0 (M
E D p
m
>,
ffli—im rH LI
3 O 01
0 E
«
p w
>, u
o
a 3 0 u 00 u u al a c/i
p •H e 3 ^ m m i-H 3 O V rH 0 E N
-—>
« Í
o
-
701
Results
In table 1 the c r y s t a l l o g r a p h i c
p a r a m e t e r s of the five
n d s i n v e s t i g a t e d are r e p o r t e d . The crystal
compou-
s t r u c t u r e s of c o m -
p o u n d s I to IV were fully u n r a v a l e d and refined, w h i l e
for
c o m p o u n d V, the linear o c t a p e p t i d e of the p h e n y l a l a n i n e , r e s o l u t i o n of the s t r u c t u r e
is still
in p r o g r e s s .
the
In Figure 1
are r e p o r t e d the ip a n d ^ a n g l e s for the p e p t i d e r e s i d u e s in a Ramachandran's
plot.
Dipeptides.
P e p t i d e s I and II p r e s e n t an U - s h a p e
with
t o r s i o n a n g l e s f a l l i n g in the c a l c u l a t e d
(p and
energy regions
structure minimum
( r e g i o n s B a n d E for the L - r e s i d u e s a n d F*
a n d D* for D - r e s i d u e s , a c c o r d i n g
to the l e t t e r code
by Z i m m e r m a n et al.
angle of the C - t e r m i n a l
(4)
). The
introduced L-Leu
a n d D - a l l e r e f e r to the t o r s i o n angle N - C - C ' - 0 ' w e r e the 0' a t o m is the e s t e r i f i e d o x y g e n . The c o n f o r m a t i o n of the side ^ 1 2 1 2 2 chain ( torsion angles X , X ' anci X ' ) is g ( tg ) for L - L e u and g"*" ( tg conformations g 12 2 X
'
and
X
) for D - L e u w h i l e for L - I l e a n d D - a l l e , t, t and t, g +
the 11 , t are f o u n d for the X ' ,
torsion angles respectively.
These
conformations
c o m p a r e w e l l w i t h the more p o p u l a t e d c o n f o r m e r s of these dues statistically tides
f o u n d in the crystal
resi-
s t r u c t u r e of small
pep-
(5) .
Hexapeptide.
A b r i e f c o m m u n i c a t i o n on the s t r u c t u r e of
nd III h a s b e e n r e c e n t l y p u b l i s h e d
compou-
(6). The m o l e c u l e a d o p t s
a
f o l d e d shape b e c a u s e of the f o r m a t i o n of a type II (3-turn, f u s e d w i t h an CX-turn b o t h i n c l u d e d in a C „ m e m b e r e d i n t r a m o 17 l e c u l a r y h y d r o g e n b e n d e d ring s t r u c t u r e . T h i s scheme of m o l e c u l a r h y d r o g e n b o n d s n e v e r f o u n d b e f o r e in l i n e a r is h o w e v e r p r e s e n t in some c y c l i c p e p t i d e s . T h e
intra-
peptides,
observed
confor-
702
rrr / *** ,
180
1 20
3 ,3 • H 2
«
60
i
P • .i •